BACKGROUND
[0001] The present teachings relate generally to mobility devices, and more specifically
to control systems for vehicles that have heightened requirements for safety and reliability.
[0002] A wide range of devices and methods are known for transporting human subjects experiencing
physical incapacitation. The design of these devices has generally required certain
compromises to accommodate the physical limitations of the users. When stability is
deemed essential, relative ease of locomotion can be compromised. When transporting
a physically disabled or other person up and down stairs is deemed essential, convenient
locomotion along regions that do not include stairs can be compromised. Devices that
achieve features that could be useful to a disabled user can be complex, heavy, and
difficult for ordinary locomotion.
[0003] Some systems provide for travel in upright positions, while others provide for ascending
or descending stairs. Some systems can provide fault detection and operation after
a fault has been detected, while others provide for transporting a user over irregular
terrain.
[0004] The control system for an actively stable personal vehicle or mobility device can
maintain the stability of the mobility device by continuously sensing the orientation
of the mobility device, determining the corrective action to maintain stability, and
commanding the wheel motors to make the corrective action. Currently, if the mobility
device loses the ability to maintain stability, such as through the failure of a component,
the user may experience, among other things, discomfort at the sudden loss of balance.
Further, the user may desire enhanced safety features and further control over the
reaction of the mobility device to unstable situations.
[0005] What is needed is a reliable, lightweight, and stable mobility device that includes
an automatic response capability to situations that are commonly encountered by a
disabled user such as, for example, but not limited to positional obstacles, slippery
surfaces, tipping conditions, and component failure. What is further needed is a mobility
device having long-lived redundant batteries, ergonomically positioned and shock buffered
caster wheel assemblies, and ride management bumpers. What is still further needed
is a mobility device that includes automatic mode transitions, improved performance
over other mobility vehicles, remote control, and a vehicle locking mechanism. The
mobility device should also include foreign substance sealing and sloping management,
a cabled charging port, and accommodations for an increased payload over the prior
art.
SUMMARY
[0006] The powered balancing mobility device of the present teachings can include, but is
not limited to including a powerbase assembly processing movement commands for the
mobility device, and at least one cluster assembly operably coupled to the powerbase
assembly, the at least one cluster assembly being operably coupled to a plurality
of wheels, the plurality of wheels supporting the powerbase assembly, the plurality
of wheels and the at least one cluster assembly moving the mobility device based at
least on the processed movement commands. The mobility device can include an active
stabilization processor estimating the center of gravity of the mobility device, the
active stabilization processor estimating at least one value associated with the mobility
device required to maintain balance of the mobility device based on the estimated
center of gravity. The powerbase processor can actively balance the mobility device
on at least two of the plurality of wheels based at least on the at least one value.
The powerbase assembly can optionally include redundant motors moving the at least
one cluster assembly and the plurality of wheels, redundant sensors sensing sensor
data from the redundant motors and the at least one cluster assembly, redundant processors
executing within the powerbase assembly, the redundant processors selecting information
from the sensor data, the selecting being based on agreement of the sensor data among
the redundant processors, the redundant processors processing the movement commands
based at least on the selected information.
[0007] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include an anti-tipping controller
stabilizing the mobility device based on stabilization factors, the anti-tipping controller
executing commands including computing a stabilization metric, computing a stabilization
factor, determining movement commands information required to process the movement
commands, and processing the movement commands based on the movement command information
and the stabilization factor if the stabilization metric indicates that stabilization
is required. The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a stair-climbing
failsafe means forcing the mobility device to fall safely if stability is lost during
stair climbing. The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a caster
wheel assembly operably coupled with the powerbase assembly, a linear acceleration
processor computing mobility device acceleration of the mobility device based at least
on the speed of the wheels, the linear acceleration processor computing the inertial
sensor acceleration of an inertial sensor mounted upon the mobility device based at
least on sensor data from the inertial sensor, a traction control processor computing
the difference between the mobility device acceleration and the inertial sensor acceleration,
the traction control processor comparing the difference to a pre-selected threshold,
and a wheel/cluster command processor commanding the at least one cluster assembly
to drop at least one of the plurality of wheels and the caster assembly to the ground
based at least on the comparison.
[0008] The powerbase processor can optionally use field weakening to provide bursts of speed
to motors associated with the at least one cluster assembly and the plurality of wheels.
The powerbase processor can optionally estimate the center of gravity of the mobility
device by (1) measuring data including a pitch angle required to maintain balance
of the mobility device at a pre-selected position of the at least one wheel cluster
and a pre-selected position of the seat, (2) moving the mobility device/user pair
to a plurality of points, repeats step (1) at each of the plurality of points, (3)
verifying that the measured data fall within pre-selected limits, and (4) generating
a set of calibration coefficients to establish the center of gravity during operation
of the mobility device, the calibration coefficients based at least on the verified
measured data. The powerbase processor can optionally include a closed loop controller
maintaining stability of the mobility device, the closed loop controller automatically
decelerating forward motion and accelerating backward motion under pre-selected circumstances,
the pre-selected circumstances being based on the pitch angle of the mobility device
and the center of gravity of the mobility device.
[0009] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include an all-terrain wheel
pair including an inner wheel having at least one locking means accessible by an operator
of the mobility device while the mobility device is operating, the inner wheel having
at least one retaining means, the all-terrain wheel pair including an outer wheel
having an attachment base, the attachment base accommodating the at least one locking
means and the at least one retaining means, the at least one retaining means operable
by the operator while the mobility device is in operation to connect the inner wheel
to the outer wheel.
[0010] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a powerbase processor
board including at least one inertial sensor, the at least one inertial sensor being
mounted on an inertial sensor board, the at least one inertial sensor board being
flexibly coupled with the powerbase processor board, the at least one inertial sensor
board being separate from the powerbase processor board, the at least one inertial
sensor being calibrated in isolation from the powerbase processor board. The powered
balancing mobility device can optionally include at least one inertial sensor including
a gyro and an accelerometer.
[0011] The powerbase processor can optionally include a mobility device wireless processor
enabling communications with an external application electronically remote from the
mobility device, the mobility device wireless processor receiving and decoding incoming
messages from a wireless radio, the powerbase processor controlling the mobility device
based at least one the decoded incoming messages. The powerbase processor can optionally
include a secure wireless communications system including data obfuscation and challenge-response
authentication.
[0012] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include an indirect heat dissipation
path between the powerbase processor board and the chassis of the mobility device.
The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a seat support assembly
enabling connection of a plurality of seat types to the powerbase assembly, the powerbase
assembly having seat position sensors, the seat position sensors providing seat position
data to the powerbase processor. The seat support assembly can optionally include
seat lift arms lifting the seat, a shaft operably coupled with the seat lift arms,
the shaft rotation being measured by the seat position sensors, the shaft rotating
through < 90°, the shaft being couple to the seat position sensor by a one-stage gear
train causing the seat position sensor to rotate > 180°, the combination doubling
the sensitivity of the seat position data.
[0013] The powerbase assembly can optionally include a plurality of sensors fully enclosed
within the powerbase assembly, the plurality of sensors including co-located sensor
groups sensing substantially similar characteristics of the mobility device. The powerbase
assembly can optionally include a manual brake including internal components, the
internal components including a hard stop and a damper, the manual brake including
a brake release lever replaceable separately from the internal components.
[0014] The powerbase processor can optionally include user-configurable drive options limiting
speed and acceleration of the mobility device based on pre-selected circumstances.
The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a user control device
including a thumbwheel, the thumbwheel modifying at least one speed range for the
mobility device.
[0015] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a drive lock element
enabling operable coupling between the powerbase assembly and a docking station, and
a skid plate having a pop-out cavity accommodating the drive lock element, the skid
plate enabling retention of oil escaping from the powerbase assembly.
[0016] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a seat, wherein the
powerbase processor receiving an indication that the mobility device is encountering
a ramp between the ground and a vehicle, the powerbase processor directing the clusters
of wheels to maintain contact with the ground, the powerbase processor changing the
orientation of the at least one cluster assembly according to the indication to maintain
the center of gravity of the mobility device based on the position of the plurality
of wheels, the powerbase processor dynamically adjusting the distance between the
seat and the at least one cluster assembly to prevent contact between the seat and
the plurality of wheels while maintaining the seat as close to the ground as possible.
[0017] The powerbase processor can optionally include an obstacle system including receiving
obstacle data, automatically identifying the at least one obstacle within the obstacle
data, automatically determining at least one situation identifier, automatically maintaining
a distance between the mobility device and the at least one obstacle based on the
at least one situation identifier, automatically accessing at least one allowed command
related to the distance, the at least one obstacle, and the at least one situation
identifier, automatically accessing at least one automatic response to at least one
movement command, receiving at least one movement command, automatically mapping the
at least one movement command with one of the at least one allowed commands, and automatically
moving the mobility device based on the at least one movement command and the at least
one automatic response associated with the mapped allowed command.
[0018] The powerbase processor can optionally include a stair processor including receiving
at least one stair command, receiving sensor data from sensors mounted on the mobility
device, automatically locating, based on the sensor data, at least one staircase within
the sensor data, receiving a selection of a selected staircase of the at least one
staircase, automatically measuring at least one characteristic of the selected staircase,
automatically locating, based on the sensor data, obstacles, if any, on the selected
staircase, automatically locating, based on the sensor data, a last stair of the selected
staircase, and automatically navigating the mobility device on the selected staircase
based on the measured at least one characteristic, the last stair, and the obstacles,
if any.
[0019] The powerbase processor can optionally include a rest room processor including automatically
locating a rest room stall door, automatically moving the mobility device through
the rest room stall door into the rest room stall, automatically positioning the mobility
device relative to rest room fixtures, automatically locating the rest room stall
door, and automatically moving the mobility device through the rest room stall door
exiting the rest room stall.
[0020] The powerbase processor can optionally include a door processor including receiving
sensor data from sensors mounted on the mobility device, automatically identifying
the door within the sensor data, automatically measuring the door, automatically determining
the door swing, automatically moving the mobility device forward through the doorway,
the mobility device opening the door and maintaining the door in an open position,
if the door swing is away from the mobility device, and automatically positioning
the mobility device for access to a handle of the door, moving the mobility device
away from the door, as the door opens, by a distance based on the width of the door,
and moving the mobility device forward though the doorway, the mobility device maintaining
the door in an open position, if the door swing is towards the mobility device.
[0021] The powerbase processor can optionally include a door processor including receiving
sensor data from sensors mounted on the mobility device, automatically identifying
the door within the sensor data, automatically measuring the door, including the width
of the door, automatically generating an alert if the door is smaller than the a pre-selected
size related to the size of the mobility device, automatically positioning the mobility
device for access to the door, the positioning being based on the width of the door,
automatically generating a signal for opening the door, and automatically moving the
mobility device though the doorway.
[0022] The powerbase processor can optionally include a docking processor including automatically
locating a transfer point at which a patient transfers out of the mobility device,
automatically positioning the mobility device in the vicinity of the transfer point,
automatically determining when the patients transfers out of the mobility device,
automatically locating a docking station, automatically positioning the mobility device
at the docking station, and operably connecting the mobility device to the docking
station.
[0023] The method of the present teachings for controlling the speed of a mobility device,
where the mobility device can include a plurality of wheels and a plurality of sensors,
the method can include, but is not limited to including receiving terrain and obstacle
detection data from the plurality of sensors, mapping terrain and obstacles, if any,
in real time based at least on the terrain and obstacle detection data, computing
collision possible areas, if any, based at least on the mapped data, computing slow-down
areas if any based at least on the mapped data and the speed of the mobility device,
receiving user preferences, if any, with respect to the slow-down areas and desired
direction and speed of motion, computing wheel commands to command the plurality of
wheels based at least on the collision possible areas, the slow-down areas, and the
user preferences, and providing the wheel commands to the plurality of wheels.
[0024] The method of the present teachings for moving a balancing mobility device on relatively
steep terrain, where the mobility device including clusters of wheels and a seat,
and the clusters of wheels and the seat are separated by a distance, and the distance
varies based on pre-selected characteristics, the method can include, but is not limited
to including, receiving an indication that the mobility device will encounter the
steep terrain, directing the clusters of wheels to maintain contact with the ground,
and dynamically adjusting the distance between the seat and the clusters of wheels
based on maintaining the balance of the mobility device and the indication.
[0025] The mobility device of the present teachings includes a reliable, lightweight, stable
mobility device that includes a powerbase operably coupled with a user controller.
The powerbase can include a powerbase controller, a power source controller, wheel
cluster assemblies, all-terrain wheels, caster arms, and casters. The powerbase can
include long-lived redundant batteries having, for example, on-board battery management
systems, ergonomically positioned and shock buffered caster wheel assemblies, a docking
capability, generic seat attachment hardware, and ride management bumpers. The powerbase
and the user controller can communicate with an external device that can, for example,
monitor and control the mobility device. The mobility device can be protected from
foreign substance entry and tipping hazards, and can accommodate an increased payload
over the prior art.
[0026] The powerbase controller can include, but is not limited to including, at least two
redundant processors controlling the mobility device. The at least one user controller
can receive desired actions for the mobility device and can, along with the powerbase
controller, process the desired actions. The at least two processors can each include
at least one controller processing task. The at least one controller processing task
can receive sensor data and motor data associated with sensors and motors that can
be operably coupled with the mobility device. The mobility device can include at least
one inertial measurement unit (IMU) board that can be operably coupled with the powerbase
controller. The at least one IMU can be mounted on a daughter board, and can be calibrated
remotely from the mobility device. The coupling of the daughter board with the powerbase
controller can enable shock-resistance in the IMU.
[0027] In addition to redundant processors, the mobility device of the present teachings
can include reliability features such as, for example, redundant motors and sensors,
such as, for example, IMU sensors. Eliminating data that could be incorrect from the
redundant components can improve the safety and reliability of the mobility device.
The method of the present teachings, referred to herein as "voting", for resolving
which value to use from redundant of the at least one processor of the present teachings
can include, but is not limited to including, initializing a counter, averaging values,
for example, but not limited to, sensor or command values, from each processor (referred
to herein as processor values), computing the absolute value difference between each
processor value and the average, and discarding the highest difference. The method
can further include computing differences between the remaining processor values and
each other. If there are any differences greater than a preselected threshold, the
method can include comparing the values that have the highest difference between them
to the remaining value, voting out the value with the highest difference from the
remaining value, comparing the voted out values to the remaining values, and voting
out any difference above the pre-selected threshold and selecting one of the remaining
processor values or an average of the processor values. If there are no differences
greater than the pre-selected threshold, the method can compare the voted out value
to the remaining values. If there are any differences greater than the pre-selected
threshold, the method can include voting out the value voted out in the compare step,
and selecting one of the remaining processor values or an average of the remaining
processor values. If there are no differences greater than the pre-selected threshold,
the method can include selecting one of the remaining processor values or an average
of the remaining processor values. If a processor value is voted out a pre-selected
number of times, the method can include raising an alarm. If the voting scheme fails
to find a processor value that satisfies the selection criteria, the method can include
incrementing the counter. If the counter has not exceeded a pre-selected number, the
method can include discarding the frame having no remaining processor values and selecting
a previous frame having at least one processor value that meets the selection criteria.
If the frame counter is greater than the pre-selected number, the method can include
moving the mobility device to a failsafe mode. The mobility device of the present
teachings can include a filter to fuse gyro and accelerometer data to produce an accurate
estimate of a gravity vector, and the gravity vector can be used to define the orientation
and inertial rotation rates of the mobility device. The orientation and inertial rotation
rates of the mobility device can be shared and combined across redundant processors
of the present teachings.
[0028] To facilitate a beneficial user experience, the mobility device can operate in several
functional modes including, but not limited to, standard, 4-Wheel, stair, balance,
remote, utility, calibration, and, optionally, docking modes, all described herein.
When first powered, the mobility device can include a pre-determined start-up process.
The mobility device can perform self diagnostics to check the integrity of features
of the mobility device that are not readily testable during normal operation. Power
off requests can be detected and qualified by the mobility device to determine whether
to grant the request or not. Prior to powering off, the mobility device position can
be secured and all state information and logged information can be stored.
[0029] In some configurations, the mobility device of the present teachings can accommodate
users of varying levels of physical ability and device acumen. In particular, users
can adjust the response of the mobility device to joystick commands. In some configurations,
the mobility device of the present teachings can allow user configurable drive options
in the form of joystick command shaping and thumbwheel control that can allow individual
users to configure the mobility device, including the user controller of the present
teachings, for driving preferences. The mobility device of the present teachings can
accommodate speed sensitive steering that can adjust the turn behavior of the mobility
device as a function of the speed of the mobility device, making the mobility device
responsive at high speeds and less jerky at low speeds.
[0030] In some configurations, the mobility device of the present teachings can still further
accommodate adaptive speed control to assist users in avoiding potentially dangerous
conditions while driving. Adaptive speed control can reduce required driver concentration
by using sensors to detect obstacles, and can help users negotiate difficult terrain
or situations. The method of the present teachings for adaptive speed control of the
mobility device can include, but is not limited to including, receiving terrain and
obstacle detection data, and mapping terrain and obstacles, if any, in real time based
at least on the terrain and obstacle detection data. The method can optionally include
computing virtual valleys, if any, based at least on the mapped data. The method can
still further include computing collision possible areas, if any, based at least on
the mapped data, and computing slow-down areas if any based at least on the mapped
data and the speed of the mobility device. The method can also include receiving user
preferences, if any, with respect to the slow-down areas and desired direction and
speed of motion. The method can still further include computing at least one wheel
command based at least on the collision possible areas, the slow-down areas, and the
user preferences and optionally the virtual valleys, and providing the at least one
wheel command to the wheel motor drives.
[0031] The method for obstacle processing of the present teachings can include, but is not
limited to including, receiving and segmenting PCL data, identifying at least one
plane within the segmented PCL data, and identifying at least one obstacle within
the at least one plane. The method for obstacle processing can further include determining
at least one situation identifier based at least on the obstacles, user information,
and movement commands, and determining the distance between the mobility device and
the obstacles based at least on the situation identifier. The method for obstacle
processing can also include accessing at least one allowed command related to the
distance, the obstacle, and the situation identifier. The method for obstacle processing
can still further include accessing an automatic response to the allowed command,
receiving a movement command, mapping the movement command with one of the allowed
commands, and providing the movement command and the automatic response associated
with the mapped allowed command to the mode-dependent processors.
[0032] The obstacles can be stationary or moving. The distance can include a fixed amount
and/or can be a dynamically-varying amount. The movement command can include a follow
command, a pass-the-obstacle command, a travel-beside-the-obstacle command, and a
do-not-follow-the- obstacle command. The obstacle data can be stored and retrieved
locally and/or in a cloud-based storage area, for example. The method for obstacle
processing can include collecting sensor data from a time-of-flight camera mounted
on the mobility device, analyzing the sensor data using a point cloud library (PCL),
tracking the moving object using SLAM based on the location of the mobility device,
identifying a plane within the obstacle data using, and providing the automatic response
associated with the mapped allowed command to the mode-dependent processors. The method
for obstacle processing can receive a resume command, and provide, following the resume
command, a movement command and the automatic response associated with the mapped
allowed command to the mode-dependent processors. The automatic response can include
a speed control command.
[0033] The obstacle processor of the present teachings can include, but is not limited to
including, a nav /PCL data processor. The nav /PCL processor can receive and segment
PCL data from a PCL processor, identify a plane within the segmented PCL data, and
identify obstacles within the plane. The obstacle processor can include a distance
processor. The distance processor can determine a situation identifier based user
information, the movement command, and the obstacles. The distance processor can determine
the distance between the mobility device and the obstacles based at least on the situation
identifier. The moving object processor and/or the stationary object processor can
access the allowed command related to the distance, the obstacles, and the situation
identifier. The moving object processor and/or the stationary object processor can
access an automatic response from an automatic response list associated with the allowed
command. The moving object processor and/or the stationary object processor can access
the movement command and map the movement command with one of the allowed commands.
The moving object processor and/or stationary object processor can provide movement
commands and the automatic response associated with the mapped allowed command to
the mode-dependent processors. The movement command can include a follow command,
a pass command, a travel-beside command, a move-to-position command, and a do-not-follow
command. The nav /PCL processor can store obstacles in local storage and/or on storage
cloud, and can allow access to the stored obstacles by systems external to the mobility
device.
[0034] In some configurations, the mobility device of the present teachings can include
weight sensitive controllers that can accommodate the needs of a variety of users.
Further, the weight sensitive controllers can detect an abrupt change in weight, for
example, but not limited to, when the user exits the mobility device. The weight and
center of gravity location of the user can be significant contributors to the system
dynamics. By sensing the user weight and adjusting the controllers, improved active
response and stability of the mobility device can be achieved.
[0035] The method of the present teachings for stabilizing the mobility device can include,
but is not limited to including, estimating the weight and/or change in weight of
a load on the mobility device, choosing a default value or values for the center of
gravity of the mobility device and load combination, computing controller gains based
at least on the weight and/or change in weight and the center of gravity values, and
applying the controller gains to control the mobility device. The method of the present
teachings for computing the weight of a load on the mobility device can include, but
is not limited to including, receiving the position of the load on the mobility device,
receiving the setting of the mobility device to standard mode, measuring the motor
current required to move the mobility device to enhanced mode at least once, computing
a torque based at least on the motor current, computing a weight of the load based
at least on the torque, and adjusting controller gains based at least on the computed
weight to stabilize the mobility device.
[0036] In some configurations, the mobility device of the present teachings can include
traction control that can adjust the torque applied to the wheels to affect directional
and acceleration control. In some configurations, traction control can be assisted
by rotating the cluster so that four wheels contact the ground when braking above
a certain threshold is requested. The method of the present teachings for controlling
traction of the mobility device can include, but is not limited to including, computing
the linear acceleration of the mobility device, and receiving the IMU measured acceleration
of the mobility device. If the difference between an expected linear acceleration
and a measured linear acceleration of the mobility device is greater than or equal
to a preselected threshold, adjusting the torque to the cluster/wheel motor drives.
If the difference between an expected linear acceleration and a measured linear acceleration
of the mobility device is less than a preselected threshold, the method can continue
testing for loss of traction.
[0037] The mobility device of the present teachings can include a user controller (UC) assist
that can assist a user in avoiding obstacles, traversing doors, traversing stairs,
traveling on elevators, and parking/transporting the mobility device. The UC assist
can receive user input and/or input from components of the mobility device, and can
enable the invocation of a processing mode that has been automatically or manually
selected. A command processor can enable the invoked mode by generating movement commands
based at least on previous movement commands, data from the user, and data from sensors.
The command processor can receive user data that can include signals from a joystick
that can provide an indication of a desired movement direction and speed of the mobility
device. User data can also include mode selections into which the mobility device
could be transitioned. Modes such as door mode, rest room mode, enhanced stair mode,
elevator mode, mobile storage mode, and static storage/charging mode can be selected.
Any of these modes can include a move-to-position mode, or the user can direct the
mobility device to move to a certain position. UC assist can generate commands such
as movement commands that can include, but are not limited to including, speed and
direction, and the movement commands can be provided to wheel motor drives and cluster
motor drives.
[0038] Sensor data can be collected by sensor-handling processors that can include, but
are not limited to including, a geometry processor, a point cloud library (PCL) processor,
a simultaneous location and mapping (SLAM) processor, and an obstacle processor. The
movement commands can also be provided to the sensor handling processors. The sensors
can provide environmental information that can include, for example, but not limited
to, obstacles and geometric information about the mobility device. The sensors can
include at least one time-of-flight sensor that can be mounted anywhere on the mobility
device. There can be multiple sensors mounted on the mobility device. The PCL processor
can gather and process environmental information, and can produce PCL data that can
be processed by a PCL library.
[0039] The geometry processor of the present teachings can receive geometry information
from the sensors, can perform any processing necessary to prepare the geometry information
for use by the mode-dependent processors, and can provide the processed of geometry
information to mode-dependent processors. The geometry of the mobility device can
be used for automatically determining whether or not the mobility device can fit in
and/or through a space such as, for example, a stairway and a door. The SLAM processor
can determine navigation information based on, for example, but not limited to, user
information, environmental information, and movement commands. The mobility device
can travel in a path at least in part set out by navigation information. An obstacle
processor can locate obstacles and distances to the obstacles. Obstacles can include,
but are not limited to including, doors, stairs, automobiles, and miscellaneous features
in the vicinity of the path of the mobility device.
[0040] The method of the present teachings for navigating stairs can include, but is not
limited to including, receiving a stair command, and receiving environmental information
from the obstacle processor. The method for navigating stairs can include locating,
based on the environmental information, staircases within environmental information,
and receiving a selection of one of the staircases located by the obstacle processor.
The method for navigating stairs can also include measuring the characteristics of
the selected staircase, and locating, based on the environmental information, obstacles,
if any, on the selected staircase. The method for navigating stairs can also include
locating, based on the environmental information, a last stair of the selected staircase,
and providing movement commands to move the mobility device on the selected staircase
based on the measured characteristics, the last stair, and the obstacles, if any.
The method for navigating stairs can continue providing movement commands until the
last stair is reached. The characteristics can include, but are not limited to including,
the height of the stair riser of the selected staircase, the surface texture of the
riser, and the surface temperature of the riser. Alerts can be generated if the surface
temperature falls outside of a threshold range and the surface texture falls outside
of a traction set.
[0041] The navigating stair processor of the present teachings can include, but is not limited
to including, a staircase processor receiving at least one stair command included
in user information, and a staircase locator receiving, through, for example, the
obstacle processor, environmental information from sensors mounted on the mobility
device. The staircase locator can locate, based on environmental information, the
staircases within the environmental information, and can receive the choice of a selected
staircase. The stair characteristics processor can measure the characteristics of
the selected staircase, and can locate, based on environmental information, obstacles,
if any, on the selected staircase. The stair movement processor can locate, based
on environmental information, a last stair of the selected staircase, and can provide
to movement processor movement commands to instruct the mobility device to move on
the selected staircase based on the characteristics, the last stair, and the obstacles,
if any. The staircase locator can locate staircases based on GPS data, and can build
and save a map of the selected staircase. The map can be saved for use locally and/or
by other devices unrelated to the mobility device. The staircase processor can access
the geometry of the mobility device, compare the geometry to the characteristics of
the selected staircase, and modify the navigation of the mobility device based on
the comparison. The staircase processor can optionally generate an alert if the surface
temperature of the risers of the selected staircase falls outside of a threshold range
and the surface texture of selected staircase falls outside of a traction set. The
stair movement processor can determine, based on the environmental information, the
topography of an area surrounding the selected staircase, and can generate an alert
if the topography is not flat. The stair movement processor can access a set of extreme
circumstances that can be used to modify the movement commands generated by the stair
movement processor.
[0042] When the mobility device traverses the threshold of a door, where the door can include
a door swing, a hinge location, and a doorway, the method of the present teachings
for navigating a door can include receiving and segmenting environmental information
from sensors mounted on the mobility device. The environmental information can include
the geometry of the mobility device. The method can include identifying a plane within
the segmented sensor data, and identifying the door within the plane. The method for
navigating a door can include measuring the door, and providing movement commands
that can move the mobility device away from the door if the door measurements are
smaller than the mobility device. The method for navigating a door can include determining
the door swing and providing movement commands to move the mobility device for access
to a handle of the door. The method for navigating a door can include providing movement
commands to move the mobility device away from the door as the door opens by a distance
based on the door measurements. The method for navigating a door can include providing
movement commands to move the mobility device forward though the doorway. The mobility
device can maintain the door in an open position if the door swing is towards the
mobility device.
[0043] The method of the present teachings for processing sensor data can determine, through
information from the sensors, the hinge side of the door, the direction and angle
of the door, and the distance to the door. The movement processor of the present teachings
can generate commands to the MD such as start/stop turning left, start/stop turning
right, start/stop moving forward, start/stop moving backwards, and can facilitate
door mode by stopping the mobility device, cancelling the goal that the mobility device
can be aiming to complete, and centering the joystick. The door processor of the present
teachings can determine whether the door is, for example, a push to open, a pull to
open, or a slider. The door processor can determine the width of the door based on
the current position and orientation of the mobility device, and can determine the
x/y/z location of the door pivot point. If the door processor determines that the
number of valid points in the image of the door derived from the set of obstacles
and/or PCL data is greater than a threshold, the door processor can determine the
distance from the mobility device to the door. The door processor can determine if
the door is moving based on successive samples of PCL data from the sensor processor.
In some configurations, the door processor can assume that a side of the mobility
device is even with the handle side of the door, and can use that assumption, along
with the position of the door pivot point, to determine the width of the door. The
door processor can generate commands to move the mobility device through the door
based on the swing and the width of the door. The mobility device itself can maintain
the door in an open state while the mobility device traverses the threshold of the
door.
[0044] In some configurations, the mobility device can automatically negotiate the use of
rest room facilities. The doors to the rest room and to the rest room stall can be
located as discussed herein, and the mobility device can be moved to locations with
respect to the doors as discussed herein. Fixtures in the rest room can be located
as obstacles as discussed herein, and the mobility device can be automatically positioned
in the vicinity of the fixtures to provide the user with access to, for example, the
toilet, the sink, and the changing table. The mobility device can be automatically
navigated to exit the rest room stall and the rest room through door and obstacle
processing discussed herein. The mobility device can automatically traverse the threshold
of the door based on the geometry of the mobility device.
[0045] The method of the present teachings for automatically storing the mobility device
in a vehicle, such as, for example, but not limited to, an accessible van, can assist
a user in independent use of the vehicle. When the user exits the mobility device
and enters the vehicle, possibly as the vehicle's driver, the mobility device can
remain parked outside of the vehicle. If the mobility device is to accompany the user
in the vehicle for later use, the mobile park mode of the present teachings can provide
movement commands to the mobility device to cause the mobility device to store itself
either automatically or upon command, and to be recalled to the door of the vehicle
as well. The mobility device can be commanded to store itself through commands received
from external applications, for example. In some configurations, a computer-driven
device such as a cell phone, laptop, and/or tablet can be used to execute one or more
external applications and generate information that could ultimately control the mobility
device. In some configurations, the mobility device can automatically proceed to mobile
park mode after the user exits the mobility device. Movement commands can include
commands to locate the door of the vehicle at which the mobility device will enter
to be stored, and commands to direct the mobility device to the vehicle door. Mobile
park mode can determine error conditions such as, for example, but not limited to,
if the vehicle door is too small for the mobility device to enter, and mobile park
mode can alert the user of the error condition through, for example, but not limited
to, an audio alert through audio interface and/or a message to one or more external
applications. If the vehicle door is wide enough for the mobility device to enter,
mobile park mode can provide vehicle control commands to command the vehicle to open
the vehicle door. Mobile park mode can determine when the vehicle door is open and
whether or not there is space for the mobility device to be stored. Mobile park mode
can invoke the method for obstacle processing to assist in determining the status
of the vehicle door and if there is room in the vehicle to store the mobility device.
If there is enough room for the mobility device, mobile park mode can provide movement
commands to move the mobility device into the storage space in the vehicle. Vehicle
control commands can be provided to command the vehicle to lock the mobility device
into place, and to close the vehicle door. When the mobility device is again needed,
one or more external applications, for example, can be used to bring the mobility
device back to the user. The status of the mobility device can be recalled, and vehicle
control commands can command the vehicle to unlock the mobility device and open the
door of the vehicle. The vehicle door can be located and the mobility device can be
moved through the vehicle door and to the passenger door to which it had been summoned
by, for example, one or more external applications. In some configurations, the vehicle
can be tagged in places such as, for example, the vehicle entry door where the mobility
device can be stored.
[0046] The method of the present teachings for storing/recharging the mobility device can
assist the user in storing and possibly recharging the mobility device, possibly when
the user is sleeping. After the user exits the mobility device, commands can be initiated
by one or more external applications, to move the perhaps riderless mobility device
to a storage/docking area. In some configurations, a mode selection by the user while
the user occupies the mobility device can initiate automatic storage/docking functions
after the user has exited the mobility device. When the mobility device is again needed,
commands can be initiated by one or more external applications to recall the mobility
device to the user. The method for storing/recharging the mobility device can include,
but is not limited to including, locating at least one storage/charging area, and
providing at least one movement command to move the mobility device from a first location
to the storage/charging area. The method for storing/recharging the mobility device
can include locating a charging dock in the storage/charging area and providing at
least one movement command to couple the mobility device with the charging dock. The
method for storing/recharging the mobility device can optionally include providing
at least one movement command to move the mobility device to the first location when
the mobility device receives an invocation command. If there is no storage/charging
area, or if there is no charging dock, or if the mobility device cannot couple with
the charging dock, the method for storing/recharging the mobility device can optionally
include providing at least one alert to the user, and providing at least one movement
command to move the mobility device to the first location.
[0047] The method of the present teachings for negotiating an elevator while maneuvering
the mobility device can enable a user to get on and off the elevator while seated
in the mobility device. When the elevator is, for example, automatically located,
and when the user selects the desired elevator direction, and when the elevator arrives
and the door opens, movement commands can be provided to move the mobility device
into the elevator. The geometry of the elevator can be determined and movement commands
can be provided to move the mobility device into a location that makes it possible
for the user to select a desired activity from the elevator selection panel. The location
of the mobility device can also be appropriate for exiting the elevator. When the
elevator door opens, movement commands can be provided to move the mobility device
to fully exit the elevator.
[0048] The powered balancing mobility device of the present teachings can include, but is
not limited to including, a powerbase assembly including a powerbase controller and
a power source controller. The power source controller can supply power to the powerbase
controller, and the powerbase assembly can process movement commands for the mobility
device. The powered balancing mobility device can include cluster assemblies operably
coupled to the powerbase assembly. The cluster assemblies can include operable coupling
with a plurality of wheels. The wheels can support the powerbase assembly and can
move based on the processed movement commands. The powerbase assembly and the cluster
assembly can enable balance of the mobility device on two of the plurality of wheels.
[0049] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include caster arms that can
be operably coupled to the powerbase assembly. The caster arms can include operable
coupling to the caster wheels, and the caster wheels can support the powerbase assembly.
The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a seat support assembly
that can enable connection of a seat to the powerbase assembly. The powerbase assembly
can include seat position sensors, and the seat position sensors can provide seat
position data to the powerbase assembly. The powered balancing mobility device can
optionally include terrain wheels that can include a means for user-detachability.
The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a powerbase controller
board including the powerbase controller and at least one inertial measurement unit
(IMU). The at least one IMU can be mounted upon an IMU board, and the IMU can include
flexibly coupling with the powerbase controller board. The IMU board can be separate
from the powerbase controller board, and the at least one IMU can be calibrated in
isolation from the powerbase controller board.
[0050] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include at least one field-effect
transistor (FET) positioned on the powerbase controller board, and at least one heat
spreader plate receiving heat from the FET. The at least one heat spreader plate can
transfer the heat to the chassis of the mobility device. The powered balancing mobility
device can optionally include at least one motor being thermally pressed into at least
one housing of the mobility device, and at least one thermistor associated with the
at least one motor, the at least one thermistor enabling reduced power usage when
the associated at least one motor exceeds a heat threshold. The powered balancing
mobility device can optionally include a plurality of batteries that can power the
mobility device. The plurality of batteries can be mounted with mounting gaps between
each pair of the batteries. The batteries can be connected to the powerbase assembly
through environmentally-isolated seals. The powered balancing mobility device can
optionally include a powerbase controller board that can include redundant processors.
The redundant processors can be physically separated from each other, and can enable
fault tolerance based on a voting process.
[0051] The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a drive lock element
that can enable operable coupling between the powerbase assembly and a docking station.
The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a skid plate having a
pop-out cavity that can accommodate the drive lock element. The skid plate can enable
retention of oil escaping from the powerbase assembly. The powered balancing mobility
device can optionally include an anti-tipping process that can reduce the likelihood
of the mobility device tipping over. The powered balancing mobility device can optionally
include a field weakening process that can enable management of abnormal circumstances
by the mobility device by supplying relatively short bursts of relatively high motor
speed. The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include a stair-climbing
failsafe means that can force the mobility device to fall backwards if stability is
lost during stair climbing. The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include
at least one magnet mounted within the cluster assembly. The at least one magnet can
attract particles within the cluster assembly. The powered balancing mobility device
can optionally include at least one seal between sections of the cluster assembly.
The powered balancing mobility device can optionally include electrical connectors
that can include printed circuit boards (PCBs) having electromagnetic (EM) energy
shielding. The PCBs can disable transmission of EM energy along cables associated
with the electrical connectors.
[0052] The mobility device of the present teachings can include, but is not limited to including,
a seat and a cluster. The mobility device can include a fully internal and redundant
sensor system, and the sensor system can include a plurality of sensors. The plurality
of sensors can include a plurality of absolute position sensors that can enable new
location reports if the seat and/or cluster move during a power off of the mobility
device. The plurality of sensors can include a plurality of seat sensors and a plurality
of cluster sensors operating during power on. The sensor system can enable fail-over
from a failing one of the plurality of sensors to another of the plurality of the
sensors. The plurality of sensors can include co-located sensor groups that can sense
substantially similar characteristics of the mobility device. The mobility device
can include an environmentally isolated gearbox. The contents of the gearbox being
can be shielded from physical contaminants and electromagnetic transmissions. The
gearbox can be oiled by an oil port in a housing of the mobility device. The mobility
device can include a manual brake that can include a hard stop and a damper. The manual
brake can include a brake release lever isolated from the contents of the gearbox.
The manual brake can include a mechanically isolated sensor reporting when the manual
brake is engaged, and the isolated sensor can include a flux shield.
[0053] The method of the present teachings for establishing the center of gravity for a
mobility device/user pair, where the mobility device can include a balancing mode
that can include a balance of the mobility device/user pair, and where the mobility
device can include at least one wheel cluster and a seat, can include, but is not
limited to including, (1) entering the balancing mode, (2) measuring data including
a pitch angle required to maintain the balance at a pre-selected position of the at
least one wheel cluster and a pre-selected position of the seat, (3) moving the mobility
device/user pair to a plurality of pre-selected points, (4) repeating step (2) at
each of the plurality of pre-selected points, (5) verifying that the measured data
fall within pre-selected limits, and (6) generating a set of calibration coefficients
to establish the center of gravity during operation of the mobility device. The calibration
coefficients can be based at least on the verified measured data. The method can optionally
include storing the verified measured data in non-volatile memory.
[0054] The method of the present teachings for filtering parameters associated with the
movement of a mobility device having an IMU, where the IMU includes a gyro, and the
gyro includes a gyro bias and gyro data, can include, but is not limited to including,
(1) subtracting the gyro bias from gyro data to correct the gyro data, (2) integrating
a filtered gravity rate over time to produce a filtered gravity vector, (3) computing
a gravity rate vector and a projected gravity rate estimate based at least on filtered
body rates and the filtered gravity vector, (4) subtracting the product of a first
gain K1 and a gravity vector error from the gravity rate vector, the gravity vector
error being based at least on the filtered gravity vector and a measured gravity vector,
(5) computing a pitch rate, a roll rate, a yaw rate, a pitch, and a roll of the mobility
device based on a filtered gravity rate vector and the filtered body rates, (6) subtracting
a differential wheel speed between wheels of the mobility device from the projected
gravity rate estimate to produce a projected rate error and the gyro bias, (7) computing
the cross product of gravity vector error and the filtered gravity vector, and adding
the cross product to the dot product of the filtered gravity vector and a projected
gravity rate estimate error to produce a body rate error, (8) applying a second gain
to an integration overtime of the body rate error to produce the gyro bias, and (9)
looping through steps (1) - (8) to continually modify the gyro data.
[0055] The method of the present teachings for making an all-terrain wheel pair can include,
but is not limited to including, constructing an inner wheel having at least one locking
pin receiver, the inner wheel having a retaining lip accommodating twist-lock attachment,
and constructing an outer wheel having an attachment base. The attachment base can
include a locking pin cavity, and the locking pin cavity can accommodate a locking
pin. The locking pin cavity can include at least one retaining tang that can accommodate
twist-lock attachment. The method can include attaching the outer wheel to the inner
wheel by mating the locking pin with one of the at least one locking pin receivers
and mating the retaining lip with the at least one retaining tang.
[0056] The method of the present teachings for traveling over rough terrain in a mobility
device can include, but is not limited to including, attaching an inner wheel having
at least one locking pin receiver. The inner wheel can include a retaining lip accommodating
twist-lock attachment. The method can include attaching an outer wheel having at least
one retaining tang and an attachment base having a locking pin cavity to the inner
wheel by threading a locking pin into the locking pin cavity and mating the locking
pin with one of the at least one locking pin receivers, and mating the retaining lip
with the at least one retaining tang.
[0057] The all-terrain wheel pair of the present teachings can include, but is not limited
to including, an inner wheel having at least one locking pin receiver. The inner wheel
can include a retaining lip accommodating twist-lock attachment. The wheel pair can
include an outer wheel having an attachment base. The attachment base can include
a locking pin cavity, and the locking pin cavity can accommodate a locking pin. The
locking pin cavity can include at least one retaining tang that can accommodate twist-lock
attachment. The outer wheel can be attached to the inner wheel by mating the locking
pin with one of the at least one locking pin receivers and mating the retaining lip
with the at least one retaining tang.
[0058] The user controller for a mobility device of the present teachings can include, but
is not limited to including, a thumbwheel that can modify at least one speed range
for the mobility device. The thumbwheel can generate signals during movement of the
thumbwheel, and the signals can be provided to the user controller. The user controller
can maintain environmental isolation from the thumbwheel while receiving the signals.
The user controller can optionally include a casing first part including mounting
features for at least one speaker, at least one circuit board, and at least one control
device. The control device can enable selection of at least one option for the mobility
device. The user controller can optionally include at least one first environmental
isolation device, and a casing second part that can include mounting features for
at least one display, at least one selection device, and at least one antenna. The
casing second part and the casing first part can be operably coupled around the at
least one first environmental isolation device. The at least one display can enable
monitoring of the status of the mobility device, and the at least one display can
present the at least one option. The at least one selection device can enable selection
of the at least one option. The user controller can optionally include a power/data
cable enabling power to flow from the mobility device to the user controller. The
power/data cable can enable data exchange between the user controller and the mobility
device. The user controller can optionally include a toggle platform first part including
toggles. The toggles can enable selection of the at least one option. The user controller
can optionally include at least one second environmental isolation device, and a toggle
platform second part that can including mobility device mounting features. The toggle
platform second part and the toggle platform first part can be operably coupled around
the at least one second environmental isolation device. The mobility device mounting
features can enable mounting of the user controller on the mobility device. The user
controller can optionally include 2-way shortcut toggles, 4-way shortcut toggles,
and at least one integration device integrating the 2-way shortcut toggles with the
4-way shortcut toggles.
[0059] The at least one option can include desired speed, desired direction, speed mode,
mobility device mode, seat height, seat tilt, and maximum speed. The control device
can include at least one joystick and at least one thumbwheel. The at least one joystick
can enable receiving the desired speed and the desired direction, and the at least
one thumbwheel can enable receiving the maximum speed. The at least one toggle can
include at least one toggle switch and at least one toggle lever. The at least one
display can include at least one battery status indicator, a power switch, at least
one audible alert and mute capability, and at least one antenna receiving wireless
signals.
[0060] The thumbwheel for a user controller of the present teachings can include, but is
not limited to including, a full rotation selector that can enable movement of the
thumbwheel to produce movement data throughout a full rotation of the thumbwheel.
The movement data can be dynamically associated with at least one user controller
characteristic. The thumbwheel can include a thumbwheel position, at least one sensor
receiving the movement data, and memory that can retain the thumbwheel position and
the at least one user controller characteristic across a power down state. The at
least one user controller characteristic can include maximum speed. The at least one
sensor can be environmentally isolated from the user controller. The at least one
sensor can include a Hall-effect sensor.
[0061] The method of the present teachings for controlling the speed of a mobility device
that includes a non-stop thumbwheel and a joystick, where the thumbwheel includes
a persistently stored position, can include, but is not limited to including, (a)
accessing a relationship between a change in the rotational position of the thumbwheel
and a multiplier for a maximum speed of the personal transport device, (b) receiving
a change in the persistently stored position of the non-stop thumbwheel, (c) determining
the multiplier based on the change and the relationship, (d) persistently storing
the changed position, (e) receiving a speed signal from the joystick, (f) adjusting
the speed signal based on the multiplier, and (g) repeating steps (a) through (f)
while the mobility device is active. The method can optionally include receiving an
indication of the sensitivity of the thumbwheel, and adjusting the relationship based
on the indication. The multiplier can be < 1.
[0062] The mobility device of the present teachings can overcome the limitations of the
prior art by including redundancy, a lightweight housing, an inertial measurement
system, advanced heat management strategy, wheel and cluster gear trains specifically
designed with the wheelchair user in mind, lightweight, long-lived redundant batteries,
ergonomically positioned and shock buffered caster wheel assemblies, and ride management
bumpers. Other improvements can include, but are not limited to including, automatic
mode transitions, anti-tipping, improved performance, remote control, a generic mounting
for a vehicle locking mechanism and the locking mechanism itself, foreign substance
sealing, slope management, and a cabled charging port. Because of the reduction in
weight of the mobility device, the mobility device can accommodate increased payload
over the prior art.
BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
[0063] The present teachings will be more readily understood by reference to the following
description, taken with the accompanying drawings, in which:
FIG. 1A is a perspective schematic diagram of a front views the mobility device base
of the present teachings;
FIG. 1B is a perspective schematic diagram of side views the wheelchair base of the
present teachings;
FIG. 1C is a perspective schematic diagram of the wheelchair base of the present teachings
including batteries;
FIG. 1D is a perspective schematic diagram of the wheelchair base of the present teachings
illustrating removable batteries;
FIG. 1E is a perspective schematic diagram of an exploded side view of the battery
pack of the present teachings;
FIG. 1F is a perspective schematic diagram of the gearbox of the present teachings;
FIG. 1G is a perspective diagram of the e-box lid of the present teachings;
FIG. 1H is a perspective diagram of the top cap of the present teachings;
FIGs. 1I and 1J are perspective schematic diagrams of the sections of the gearbox
of the present teachings;
FIG. 1J-1 is a detailed perspective view of the spring pins of the present teachings;
FIG. 1K is a cross section diagram of the sector gear cross shaft of the present teachings;
FIG. 1L is a plan diagram of the sealing bead location of the present teachings;
FIG. 1M is a perspective schematic diagram of the oil port of the gearbox of the present
teachings;
FIG. 1N is a perspective schematic diagram of the drive lock kingpin of the present
teachings;
FIG. 1O is a perspective schematic diagram of the rear securement loop of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 1P, 1Q, and 1R are perspective schematic diagrams of the skid plate and drive
lock kingpin of the present teachings;
FIG. 2A is a perspective diagram of the gears within the gearbox of the present teachings;
FIGs. 2B-2E are perspective diagrams and plan views of the detail of the gears and
cluster cross shaft of the present teachings;
FIG. 2F is a perspective diagram of the cluster cross shaft and the sector gear cross
shaft of the present teachings;
FIG. 2G is a perspective diagram of detail of the gears and the sector gear cross
shaft of the present teachings;
FIG. 2H is a perspective diagram of detail of the gears and pinion height actuator
stage 1 of the present teachings;
FIGs. 2I and 2J are plan views of detail of the gears and pinion height actuator stage
1 of the present teachings;
FIG. 2K is a perspective diagram of the gears and cluster cross shaft of the present
teachings;
FIG. 2L is a perspective diagram of the pinion-gear height actuator stage 2 pinion
with retaining ring of the present teachings;
FIG. 2M is a perspective diagram of the shaft pinion cluster rotation stage 1 with
inner ring of the present teachings;
FIG. 2N is a perspective diagram of the pinion height actuator shaft stage 1 of the
present teachings;
FIGs. 2O and 2P are perspective diagrams of the cluster rotate pinion-gear stage 2
pinion of the present teachings;
FIG. 2Q is a perspective diagram of the cluster rotate pinion-gear stage 3 pinion
of the present teachings;
FIG. 2R is a perspective diagram of the cluster rotate gear-pinion cross-shaft stage
3 of the present teachings;
FIG. 2S is a perspective diagram of the sector gear cross shaft of the present teachings;
FIG. 2T is a perspective diagram of the pinion-gear height actuator stage 3 pinion
of the present teachings;
FIG. 2U is a perspective diagram of the pinion-gear height actuator stage 4 of the
present teachings;
FIG. 2V is a perspective diagram of the second configuration of the pinion-gear height
actuator stage 4 of the present teachings;
FIG. 3A is a perspective diagram of the motors and sector gear cross shaft of the
present teachings;
FIG. 3B is a perspective diagram of the cluster and seat position sensor of the present
teachings;
FIG. 3C is a perspective diagram of the motors and sensors of the present teachings;
FIG. 3D is a perspective diagram of the seat/cluster motor of the present teachings;
FIG. 3E is an exploded perspective diagram of the seat/cluster motor of the present
teachings;
FIG. 3F is a perspective diagram of the wheel motor of the present teachings;
FIG. 3G is an exploded perspective diagram of the wheel motor of the present teachings;
FIG. 3H is a perspective diagram of the brake without brake lever of the present teachings;
FIG. 3I is a perspective diagram of the brake with brake lever of the present teachings;
FIG. 3J is a perspective diagram of the mating notch on the gear clamp of the present
teachings;
FIG. 3K is a perspective diagram of the seat position sensor gear teeth clamp with
mating notch of the present teachings;
FIG. 3K-1 is a perspective diagram of a second configuration of the seat position
sensor gear teeth clamp with mating notch of the present teachings;
FIG. 3L is a perspective diagram of the mating notch of the seat position sensor of
the present teachings;
FIG. 3M is an exploded perspective diagram of the seat position sensor of the present
teachings;
FIG. 3N is a plan view of the seat position sensor of the present teachings;
FIG. 3O is an exploded perspective diagram of the cluster position sensor of the present
teachings;
FIG. 3P is a plan view of the cluster position sensor of the present teachings;
FIG. 4 is a perspective diagram of the caster arm of the caster of the present teachings;
FIG. 5A is a perspective diagram of the linkage arms and seat support structure of
the gearbox of the present teachings;
FIG. 5B is a perspective diagram of the connective features of the seat support structure
of the present teachings;
FIG. 5C is a perspective diagram of the seat height linkage stabilizer link of the
present teachings;
FIG. 5D is a perspective diagram of a first view of the seat height linkage lift arm
of the present teachings;
FIG. 5E is a perspective diagram of a second view of the seat height linkage lift
arm of the present teachings;
FIG. 6A is a perspective diagram of a the cluster assembly of the present teachings;
FIG. 6B is a perspective diagram of the cluster motor assembly of the present teachings;
FIG. 6C is a perspective diagram of the cluster motor assembly with splines of the
present teachings;
FIG. 6D is a perspective diagram of the gear-pinion cluster rotate stage 3 cross shaft
and pinion shaft cluster rotate stage 4 of the present teachings;
FIG. 6E is a perspective diagram of views of the pinion shaft cluster rotate stage
4 and cluster position sensor tooth cluster cross shaft gear of the present teachings;
FIG. 6F is a perspective diagram of the gear-pinion cluster rotate stage 3 cross shaft
of the present teachings;
FIG. 6G is a cross section perspective diagram of the cross shaft cluster rotate of
the present teachings;
FIG. 6H is a perspective diagram of the cluster plate interface of the present teachings;
FIG. 6I is a perspective diagram of the second configuration cluster plate interface
of the present teachings;
FIG. 6J is a perspective diagram of the ring gear of the present teachings;
FIG. 6K is a perspective diagram of the cluster housings and gears of the present
teachings;
FIG. 6L is a perspective diagram of the wheel drive intermediate stage of the present
teachings;
FIG. 6M is a plan view of the cluster housing of the present teachings including a
sealing bead;
FIG. 7A is a perspective diagram of the tire of the present teachings;
FIG. 7B is a perspective diagram of the tire assembly of the present teachings;
FIG. 7C is a perspective diagram of the dual tire assembly of the present teachings;
FIG. 7D is a perspective diagram of the tire of the present teachings;
FIG. 7E is a perspective diagram of the wheel of the present teachings;
FIG. 7F is a perspective diagram of the attachment base of the present teachings;
FIG. 7G is a perspective diagram of the inner split rim of the present teachings;
FIG. 7H is a perspective diagram of the hubcap of the present teachings;
FIG. 7I is a perspective diagram of the locking pin spring of the present teachings;
FIG. 7J is a perspective diagram of the fastener housing of the present teachings;
FIG. 7K is a perspective diagram of the locking pin of the present teachings;
FIG. 7L is a perspective cross section diagram of the dual tire assembly with locking
pin partially inserted;
FIG. 7M is a perspective cross section diagram of the dual tire assembly with locking
pin fully inserted;
FIG. 8 is a pictorial representation of a configuration of the positioning of sensors
of the mobility device of the present teachings;
FIG. 9A is a perspective diagram of an exploded view of the manual brake assembly
of the present teachings;
FIG. 9B is a perspective diagram of the damper of the manual brake assembly of the
present teachings;
FIG. 9C is a perspective diagram of the damper in motion of the manual brake assembly
of the present teachings;
FIG. 9D is a perspective diagram of the manual brake release shaft of the present
teachings;
FIG. 9E is a perspective diagram of the manual brake release bracket of the present
teachings;
FIG. 9F is a perspective diagram of the manual brake release pivot interface of the
present teachings;
FIG. 9G is a perspective diagram of the manual brake release spring arm of the present
teachings;
FIG. 9H is a perspective diagram of the manual brake release shaft arm of the present
teachings;
FIG. 9I is a perspective diagram of the brake release lever of the present teachings;
FIG. 9J is a perspective diagram of the manual brake release assembly of the present
teachings;
FIG. 9K is a perspective diagram of the manual brake lever hard travel of the present
teachings;
FIG. 9L is an exploded perspective diagram of the manual brake lever travel stop of
the present teachings;
FIG. 9M is an exploded perspective diagram of the manual brake lever travel stop of
the present teachings;
FIG. 9N is an exploded plan view of the manual brake lever travel stop of the present
teachings;
FIG. 10A is a perspective diagram of the cable ports of the present teachings;
FIG. 10B is an exploded perspective diagram of the harnesses of the present teachings;
FIG. 10C is a perspective diagram of the UC port harness of the present teachings;
FIG. 10D is a perspective diagram of the charge input port harness of the present
teachings;
FIG. 10E is a perspective diagram of the accessory port harness of the present teachings;
FIGs. 11A-11D are schematic block diagrams of various wiring configurations of the
present teachings;
FIG. 11E is a perspective diagram of the power off request switch of the present teachings;
FIGs. 12A and 12B are perspective diagrams of the first configuration of the UC of
the present teachings;
FIGs. 12C and 12D are perspective diagrams of the second configuration of the UC of
the present teachings;
FIGs. 12E and 12F are perspective diagrams of the third configuration of the UC of
the present teachings;
FIG. 12G is a perspective diagram of the forward-facing components of the second configuration
of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 12H is a perspective diagram of the joystick of the UC of the present teachings;
FIGs. 121 and 12K are exploded perspective diagrams of the first configuration of
the UC of the present teachings;
FIGs. 12L and 12M are perspective diagrams of the upper and lower housings of the
first configuration of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 12N is an exploded perspective diagram of the thumbwheel components of the lower
housing of the third configuration of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 120 is a cross section diagram of the thumbwheel sensor environmental isolation
of the lower housing of the third configuration of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 12P is a perspective diagram of the display coverglass of the UC of the present
teachings;
FIG. 12Q is a perspective diagram of the joystick backer ring of the UC of the present
teachings;
FIG. 12R is a perspective diagram of the toggle housing of the UC of the present teachings;
FIGs. 12S and 12T are perspective diagrams of the toggle housing of the UC of the
present teachings;
FIGs. 12U and 12V are perspective diagrams of the undercap of the UC of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 12W and 12X are cross section and exploded perspective diagrams of the EMI suppression
ferrite of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 12Y is a perspective diagram of the UC mounting device of the present teachings;
FIG. 12Z is a perspective diagram of the mounting cleat of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 12AA is a perspective diagram of the grommet of the UC of the present teachings;
FIGs. 12BB and 12CC are perspective diagrams of the button assembly of the UC of the
present teachings;
FIGs. 12DD and 12EE are perspective diagrams of the toggle module of the UC of the
present teachings;
FIGs. 13A and 13B are perspective diagrams of the fourth configuration the UC of the
present teachings;
FIG. 13C is a perspective diagram of the UC assist holder of the UC of the present
teachings;
FIG. 14A is a perspective diagram of the UC circuit board of the UC of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 14B and 14C are schematic block diagrams of the layout of the UC circuit board
of the UC of the present teachings;
FIG. 15A is a perspective diagram of the electronics component boards of the present
teachings;
FIG. 15B is an exploded perspective diagram of the circuit boards of the present teachings;
FIGs. 15C-15D are perspective diagrams of the IMU assembly of the present teachings;
FIG. 15E is a perspective diagram of a first view of the IMU board and the EMF shield
of the present teachings;
FIG. 15F is a perspective diagram of a second view of the IMU board and the EMF shield
of the present teachings;
FIG. 15G is a perspective diagram of the first configuration of the power source controller
board of the present teachings;
FIG. 15H is a perspective diagram of the second configuration of the power source
controller board of the present teachings;
FIGs. 15I-15J are schematic block diagrams of the power source controller board of
the present teachings;
FIG. 16A is a schematic block diagram of an overview of the system of the present
teachings;
FIG. 16B is a schematic block diagram of the electronic components of the mobility
device of the present teachings;
FIG. 17A is a schematic block diagram of a powerbase controller of the present teachings;
FIGs. 17B-17C are message flow diagrams of the powerbase controller of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 18A-18D are schematic block diagrams of the processors of the present teachings;
FIG. 19A is a schematic block diagram of the inertial measurement unit filter of the
present teachings;
FIG. 19B is a flowchart of the method of the present teachings for filtering gyro
and acceleration data;
FIG. 20 is a flowchart of the method of the present teachings for field weakening;
FIG. 21A is a schematic block diagram of the voting processor of the present teachings;
FIGs. 21B and 21C are flowcharts of the method of the present teachings for 4-way
voting;
FIGs. 21D and 21G are tabular representations of voting examples of the present teachings;
FIG. 22A is a schematic block diagram of allowed mode transitions in one configuration
of the present teachings;
FIGs. 22B-22D are schematic block diagrams of the control structure with respect to
modes of the system of the present teachings;
FIGs. 23A-23K are flow diagrams of the operational use of the mobility device of the
present teachings;
FIGs. 23L-23X are flow diagrams of a second configuration of the operational use of
the mobility device of the present teachings;
FIGs. 23Y-23KK are flow diagrams of a third configuration of the operational use of
the mobility device of the present teachings;
FIGs. 23LL-23VV are flow diagrams of a fourth configuration of the operational use
of the mobility device of the present teachings;
FIGs. 24A and 24B are representations of the graphical user interface of the home
screen display of the present teachings;
FIGs. 24C and 24D are representations of the graphical user interface of the main
menu display of the present teachings;
FIGs. 24E-24H are representations of the graphical user interface of the selection
screen display of the present teachings;
FIGs. 241 and 24J are representations of the graphical user interface of the transition
screen display of the present teachings;
FIGs. 24K and 24L are representations of the graphical user interface of the forced
power off display of the present teachings;
FIGs. 24M and 24N are representations of the CG fit screen of the present teachings;
FIG. 25A is a schematic block diagram of the components of the speed processor of
the present teachings;
FIG. 25B is a flowchart of the method of speed processing of the present teachings;
FIG. 25C is a graph of the manual interface response template of the present teachings;
FIGs. 25D, 25D-1, 25D-2, and 25D-3 are graphs of interface responses of the present
teachings based on speed categories;
FIGs. 25E and 25F are graphical representations of joystick control profiles of the
present teachings;
FIG. 25G is a schematic block diagram of the components of the adaptive speed control
processor of the present teachings;
FIG. 25H is a flowchart of the method of adaptive speed processing of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 25I-25K are pictorial descriptions of exemplary uses of the adaptive speed control
of the present teachings;
FIG. 26A is a schematic block diagram of the components of the traction control processor
of the present teachings;
FIG. 26B is a flowchart of the method of traction control processing of the present
teachings;
FIG. 27A is a pictorial representation of a comparison of a mobility device of the
present teachings tipping versus a mobility device of the present teachings traversing
an incline;
FIG. 27B is a flowchart of the method of anti-tipping processing of the present teachings;
FIG. 27C is a schematic block diagram of an anti-tipping controller of the present
teachings;
FIG. 27D is a schematic block diagram of the CG fit processor of the present teachings;
FIG. 27E is a flowchart of the method of CG fit processing of the present teachings;
FIG. 28A is a schematic block diagram of the weight processor of the present teachings;
FIG. 28B is a flowchart of the method of weight processing of the present teachings;
FIG. 28C is a schematic block diagram of the weight-current processor of the present
teachings;
FIG. 28D is a flowchart of the method of weight-current processing of the present
teachings;
FIG. 29A is a schematic block diagram of the components of the UCP assist of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 29B-29C are flowcharts of the method of obstacle detection of the present teachings;
FIG. 29D is a schematic block diagram of the components of the obstacle detection
of the present teachings;
FIGs. 29E-29H are computer-generated representations of the mobility device configured
with a sensor;
FIG. 291 is a flowchart of the method of enhanced stair climbing of the present teachings;
FIG. 29J is a schematic block diagram of the components of the enhanced stair climbing
of the present teachings;
FIGs. 29K-29L are flowcharts of the method of door traversal of the present teachings;
FIG. 29M is a schematic block diagram of the components of the door traversal of the
present teachings;
FIG. 29N is a flowchart of the method of rest room navigation of the present teachings;
FIG. 29O is a schematic block diagram of the components of the rest room navigation
of the present teachings;
FIGs. 29P-29Q are flowcharts of the method of mobile storage of the present teachings;
FIG. 29R is a schematic block diagram of the components of the mobile storage of the
present teachings;
FIG. 29S is a flowchart of the method of storage/charging of the present teachings;
FIG. 29T is a schematic block diagram of the components of the storage/charging of
the present teachings;
FIG. 29U is a flowchart of the method of elevator navigation of the present teachings;
FIG. 29V is a schematic block diagram of the components of the elevator navigation
of the present teachings.
FIG. 30A is a table of communications packets exchanged in the MD of the present teachings;
FIGs. 30B-30E are tables of communication packet contents of the present teachings;
FIG. 31A is a schematic block diagram of remote communications interfaces of the present
teachings;
FIGs. 31B and 31C are packet formats for exemplary protocols of the present teachings;
FIG. 31D is a schematic block diagram of the wireless communications system of the
present teachings;
FIGs. 31E and 31F are bubble format diagrams for wireless communications state transitions
of the present teachings;
FIGs. 31G and 31H are message communications diagrams for wireless communications
of the present teachings;
FIG. 32A is a threat/solution block diagram of possible threats to the MD of the present
teachings;
FIG. 32B is a flowchart of the method for obfuscating plain text of the present teachings;
FIG. 32C is a flowchart of the method for de-obfuscating plain text of the present
teachings;
FIG. 32D is a transmitter/receiver communications block diagram of the method for
challenge/response of the present teachings; and
FIG. 33 is a schematic block diagram of event processing of the present teachings.
DETAILED DESCRIPTION
[0064] The mobility device (MD) of the present teachings can include a small, lightweight,
powered vehicle which can provide the user the ability to navigate environments of
daily living including the ability to maneuver in confined spaces and to climb curbs,
stairs, and other obstacles. The MD can improve the quality of life for individuals
who have mobility impairments by allowing for traversing aggressive and difficult
terrain and by operating at elevated seat heights. The elevated seat heights can offer
benefits in activities of daily living (e.g., accessing higher shelves) and interaction
with other people at "eye level" - while either stationary or moving.
[0065] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 1A and 1B, the mobility device (MD) of the present
teachings can include powerbase assembly 21513 that can include central gearbox 21514,
power mechanisms, and wheel cluster assembly 21100/21201 (FIG. 6A). Central gearbox
21514 can control the rotation of assembly 21100/21201 (FIG. 6A), can limit backlash,
and can provide structural integrity to the MD. In some configurations, central gearbox
21514 can be constructed of highly durable materials that can be lightweight, thereby
increasing the possible payload that the MD can accommodate, and improving the operational
range of the MD. Central gearbox 21514 can include the drive transmissions for the
cluster drive and seat height transmissions, and can provide structural mounting interfaces
for the electronics, two caster assemblies, two wheel cluster assemblies, two sets
of seat height arms, and motors and brakes for two wheel drives. Other components
and the seat can be attached to powerbase assembly 21513, for example, by use of rail
30081. Moving transmission parts can be contained internal to powerbase assembly 21513
and sealed to protect from contamination. Central gearbox 21514 can include gear trains
that can provide power to rotate the wheel clusters and drive the seat height actuator.
Powerbase assembly 21513 can provide the structure and mounting points for the elements
of the four-bar linkage, two drive arms (one on each side of central gearbox 21514),
two stabilizer arms (one on each side of central gearbox 21514), and seat brackets
24001. Powerbase assembly 21513 can provide the electrical and mechanical power to
the drive the wheels and clusters, and provide seat height actuation. Central gearbox
21514 can house the cluster transmission, the seat height actuator transmissions,
and the electronics. Two wheel cluster assemblies 21100 (FIG. 6A) can be attached
to central gearbox 21514. The seat support structure, casters, batteries, and optional
docking bracket can also attach to central gearbox 21514. Central gearbox 21514 can
be constructed to provide EM shielding to the parts housed within central gearbox
21514. Central gearbox 21514 can be constructed to block electromagnetic energy transmission,
and can be sealed at its joints by a material that can provide EM shielding, such
as, for example, but not limited to, NUSIL
® RTV silicone.
[0066] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 1A and 1B, the MD can accommodate seating through connection
of a seating option to lifting and stabilizing arms. The MD can provide power, communication
and structural interface for optional features, such as lights and seating control
options such as, for example, but not limited to, power seating. Materials that can
be used to construct the MD can include, but are not limited to including, aluminum,
delrin, magnesium, plywood, medium carbon steel, and stainless steel. Active stabilization
of the MD can be accomplished by incorporating, into the MD, sensors that can detect
the orientation and rate of change in orientation of the MD, motors that can produce
high power and high-speed servo operation, and controllers that can assimilate information
from the sensors and motors, and can compute appropriate motor commands to achieve
active stability and implement the user's commands. The left and right wheel motors
can drive the main wheels on the either side of the device. The front and back wheels
can be coupled to drive together, so the two left wheels can drive together and the
two right wheels can drive together. Turning can be accomplished by driving the left
and right motors at different rates. The cluster motor can rotate the wheel base in
the fore/aft direction. This can allow the MD to remain level while the front wheels
become higher or lower than the rear wheels. The cluster motor can be used to keep
the device level when climbing up and down curbs, and it can be used to rotate the
wheel base repeatedly to climb up and down stairs. The seat can be automatically raised
and lowered.
[0067] Referring now to FIGs. 1C and 1D, battery packs 70001 can generate heat when charging
and discharging. Positioning battery packs 70001 atop the central housing 21514, and
including air gaps 70001-1 between battery packs 70001 can allow air flow that can
assist with heat dissipation. Battery packs 70001 can operably couple with gearbox
lid 21524 at fastener port 70001-4.
[0068] Referring now to FIG. 1E, batteries 70001 can serve as the main energy source for
the MD. Multiple separate, identical batteries 70001 can provide a redundant energy
supply to the device. Each battery 70001 can supply a separate power bus, from which
other components can draw power. Each battery 70001 can provide power to sensors,
controllers, and motors, through switching power converters. Batteries 70001 can also
accept regeneration power from the motors. Batteries 70001 can be changeable and can
be removable with or without tools. Each battery 70001 can connect to the MD via,
for example, but not limited to, a blind-mate connector. During battery installation,
the power terminals of the connector can mate before the battery signal terminals
to prevent damage to the battery circuit. The connector can enable correct connection,
and can discourage and/or prevent incorrect connection. Each battery 70001 can include
relatively high energy density and relatively low weight cells 29, such as, for example,
but not limited to, rechargeable lithium ion (Li-ION) cells, for example, but not
limited to, cylindrical 18650 cells in a 16s2p arrangement, providing a nominal voltage
of about 58V and about 5Ah capacity. Each battery can operate within the range about
50-100V.
[0069] Continuing to refer to FIG. 1E, in some configurations, at least two batteries 70001
must be combined in parallel. These combined packs can form a battery bank. In some
fail-operative configurations, there can be two independent battery banks ("Bank A"
and "Bank B"). In some configurations, there can be an optional third battery in each
battery bank. In some configurations, the load can be shared equally across all packs.
In some configurations, up to six battery packs can be used on the system at one time.
In some configurations, a minimum of four battery packs is needed for operation. An
additional two batteries can be added for extended range. In some configurations,
the energy storage level for these battery packs can be the same as standard computer
batteries, enabling transport by commercial aircraft possible. Placement of empty
of battery packs 70001 can protect the unused battery connection port on the MD and
can provide a uniform and complete appearance for the MD. In some configurations,
empty battery packs slots can be replaced with a storage compartment (not shown) that
can store, for example, a battery charger or other items. The storage container can
seal off the empty battery openings to the electronics to prevent environmental contamination
of the central housing. The battery packs can be protected from damage by walls 21524A.
[0070] Continuing to refer to FIG. 1E, information from a fuel gauge such as, for example,
but not limited to, TI bq34z100-G1 wide range fuel gauge, can be provided to PSC board
50002 (FIG. 15G) over an I2C bus connection. Battery pack 70001 can communicate with
PSC board 50002 (FIG. 15G) and therefore with PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15G). Battery
packs 70001 can be mounted in pairs to maintain redundancy. One battery pack 70001
of the pair can be connected to processors A1/A2 43A/43B (FIG. 18C) and one can be
connected to processors B1/B2 43C/43D (FIG. 18D). Therefore, if one of the pair of
battery packs 70001 fails to function, the other of the pair can remain operational.
Further, if both of battery packs 70001 in a pair fail to function, one or more other
pairs of battery packs 70001 can remain operational.
[0071] Continuing to refer to FIG. 1E, a battery controller that can execute on processor
401 (FIG. 15J) can include, but is not limited to including, commands to initialize
each battery, run each battery task if the battery is connected, average the results
of the tasks from each battery, obtain the bus battery voltage that will be seen by
processors A/B 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D), obtain the voltage from an ADC channel for the
battery that is currently in use, obtain the battery voltage from fuel gauge data,
compare the voltage from the fuel gauge data to the voltage from the ADC channel,
obtain the number of connected batteries, connect batteries 70001 to a bus to power
the MD, monitor the batteries, and check the battery temperature. The temperature
thresholds that can be reported can include, but are not limited to including, cold,
warm, and hot battery states. The battery controller can check the charge of batteries
70001, compare the charge to thresholds, and issue warning levels under low charge
conditions. In some configurations, there can be four thresholds - low charge, low
charge alert, low charge with restrictions, and minimum charge. The battery controller
can check to make sure that batteries 70001 can be charged. In some configurations,
batteries 70001 must be a least a certain voltage, for example, but not limited to,
about 30V, and must be communicating with PSC 50002 (FIG. 15G) in order to be charged.
The battery controller can recover batteries 70001 by, for example, pre-charging batteries
70001 if, for example, batteries 70001 have been discharged to the point at which
a battery protection circuit has been enabled. DC power for charging batteries 70001
can be supplied by an external AC/DC power supply. A user can be isolated from potential
shock hazards by isolating the user from batteries 70001.
[0072] Referring now primarily to FIG. 1F, central gearbox 21514 can include e-box lid 21524
(FIG. 1G), brake lever 30070 (FIG. 1A), power off request switch 60006 (FIG. 1A),
fastening port 257, lift arm control port 255, caster arm port 225, cluster port 261,
and bumper housing 263. Power off request switch 60006 (FIG. 11E) can be mounted on
the front of gearbox 21514 (FIG. 1A) and can be wired to PBC board 50001 (FIG. 11A).
At least one battery pack 70001 (FIG. 1C) can be mounted upon e-box lid 21524. Cleats
21534 can enable positioning and securing of battery packs 70001 (FIG. 1C) at battery
pack lip 70001-2 (FIG. 1E). Connector cavities 21524-1 can include a snout that can
protrude from lid 21524. Connector cavities 21524-1 can include a gasket (not shown),
for example, but not limited to, an elastomeric gasket, around the base of the snout.
Battery connectors 50010 (FIG. 1E) can operably couple batteries 70001 (FIG. 1C) to
the electronics of the MD though connector cavities 21524-1, and the pressure of batteries
70001 (FIG. 1C) enabled by fasteners mounted in fastening cavity 70001-4 (FIG. 1D)
can seal against the gaskets in connector cavities 21524-1, protecting the gears and
electronics of the MD from environmental contamination.
[0073] Referring now to FIG. 1G, an electronics enclosure can house the primary stabilization
sensors and decision-making systems for the MD. The electronics enclosure can protect
the contents from electro-magnetic interference while containing emissions. The electronics
enclosure can inhibit foreign matter ingress while dissipating the excess heat generated
within the enclosure. The enclosure can be sealed with a cover and environmental gaskets.
Components within the enclosure that can generate significant amounts of heat can
be physically connected to the enclosure frame via heat conductive materials. E-box
lid 21524 can include battery connector openings 201, a form-in-place gasket (not
shown), and mounting cleat attachment points 205 to accommodate mounting of battery
packs 70001 (FIG. 1E) on e-box lid 21524. Battery connector openings 201 can include
slim rectangles that can include planar gaskets. Batteries can compress against the
planar gaskets during assembly, and these gaskets can form an environmental seal between
the batteries and chassis of the MD. A form-in-place gasket (not shown) can seal the
part of central gearbox 21514 that can include gears, motors, and electronics from
intrusion of foreign substances including fluids. In some configurations, harnesses
60007 (FIG. 10C), 60008 (FIG. 10D), and 60009 (FIG. 10E) can connect to sealed, panel-mounted
connectors to maintain environmental and EMC protection. Harnesses 60007 (FIG. 10C),
60008 (FIG. 10D), and 60009 (FIG. 10E) can be surrounded by glands and/or panel-mounted
connectors that incorporate planar gaskets or o-rings that can be impervious to foreign
substances. Surfaces within central gearbox 21514 can be sloped such that environmental
contamination, if present, can be channeled away from sensitive parts of the MD. Central
gearbox top cap housing 30025 (FIG. 1H) can include hinge 30025-1 (FIG. 1H) and cable
routing guide 30025-2 (FIG. 1H). Cables can be routed between UC 130 (FIG. 12A) and
central gearbox 21514 through routing guide 30025-2, for example, that can avoid entanglement
of the cables with a seat, especially as the seat moves up and down. A hinged cable
housing (not shown) can be operably attached to hinge 30025-1 (FIG. 1H). The hinged
cable housing (not shown) can further restrain cables to avoid entanglement.
[0074] Referring now to FIGs. 1I and 1J, central gearbox 21514 can include of first section
enclosure 30020, second section enclosure 30021, third section enclosure 30022, and
fourth section enclosure 30023 that can be bonded together to form an enclosure for
the seat and cluster gear trains and an enclosure for the electronics of the MD. The
sections can be bound together by, for example, but not limited to, an elastomeric
bonding material. The bonding material can be applied to the edge of each of the sections,
and the sections can be fastened together with edges meeting to form the enclosures.
[0075] Referring now to FIG. 1K, sector gear cross shaft 21504 can be supported on glass
filled plastic bushings 21504-1, 21504-2, 21504-3, and 21504-4. Each bushing can be
supported by one of first section enclosure 30020, second section enclosure 30021,
third section enclosure 30022, and fourth section enclosure 30023. Redundant shaft
support can efficiently share the load among first section enclosure 30020, second
section enclosure 30021, third section enclosure 30022, and fourth section enclosure
30023, and can reduce the load on any single of first section enclosure 30020, second
section enclosure 30021, third section enclosure 30022, and fourth section enclosure
30023, enabling the housing structures to be lighter.
[0076] Referring now to FIG. 1L, prior to mating one of sections 30020-30023 with each other,
a sealant bead having such characteristics as high temperature resistance, acid and
alkali resistance, and aging resistance, such as, for example, but not limited to,
a room temperature vulcanization silicon bead, can be applied to perimeter 30023-1,
for example.
[0077] Referring now to FIG. 1M, oil port 40056-1, stopped by bolt 40056, can be used to
add oil to the gear train enclosure. Each shaft that penetrates the housings can be
surrounded by an elastomeric lip and/or o-ring seals. Electrical cable harness housings
30116A, 30116B, and 30116C that exit the central housing do so through leak proof
connectors that can seal to the housings with o-rings. The electronics enclosure is
closed off by lid 21524 (FIG. 1F) that can include a seal around the perimeter that
is clamped to the central housings. The electronics enclosure can provide shielding
from the transmission of electromagnetic energy into or out of the enclosure. In some
configurations, the sealing material that can bond the housings together and the gaskets
coupling e-box lid 21524 (FIG. 1G) and the central housing can be manufactured from
electrically conductive materials, improving the ability of the enclosure to shield
against electromagnetic energy transmission. Electrical connectors that exit the central
housing can include printed circuit boards having electromagnetic energy shielding
circuits, stopping the transmission of electromagnetic energy along the cables that
can be held in place by cable clamps 30116. Each of central housings 30020/30021/30022/30023
(FIGs. 1I and 1J) can be aligned to adjacent housings by spring pins 40008 (FIG. 1J-1)
pressed into the adjacent housing.
[0078] Referring now to FIGs. 1N-1R, skid plate 30026 (FIG. 1R) can protect the underside
of the housings from impacts and scrapes. Skid plate 30026 (FIG. 1R) can accommodate
optional drive lock kingpin 30070-4 (FIGs. 1N and 1P) when installed. In some configurations,
skid plate 30026 (FIG. 1R) can be manufactured of a fracture resistant plastic that
can be tinted to limit the visibility of scrapes and scratches. Skid plate 30026 (FIG.
1R) can provide a barrier to oil if the oil drips from central gearbox 21514. When
equipped with optional docking attachments, the MD can be secured for transport in
conjunction with a vehicle-mounted user-actuated restraint system that can, for example,
be commercially available. The docking attachments can include, but are not limited
to including, docking weldment 30700 (FIG. 1P) and rear stabilizer loop 20700 (FIG.
1O). Docking weldment 30700 (FIG. 1P) can be mounted to the main chassis of the MD.
Docking weldment 30700 (FIG. 1P) can engage with a vehicle mounted restraint system,
can provide anchorage for the MD, and can limit its movement in the event of an accident.
The restraint system of the MD can enable a user to remain seated in the MD for transport
in a vehicle. Docking weldment 30700 (FIG. 1P) can include, but is not limited to
including, drive lock kingpin 30700-4 (FIGs. 1N and 1P), drive lock plate base 30700-2
(FIG. 1P), and drive lock plate front 30700-3 (FIG. 1P). Docking weldment 30700 (FIG.
1P) can be optionally included with the MD and can be attached to central gearbox
21514 (FIG. 1N) at drive lock plate front 30700-3 (FIG. 1P). Drive lock base 30700-2
(FIG. 1P) can include drive lock base first side 297 (FIG. 1P) that can include drive
lock kingpin 30700-4 (FIG. 1P), and drive lock base second side 299 (FIG. 1Q) that
can oppose drive lock base first side 297 (FIG. 1Q) and can be mounted flush with
central gearbox 21514 (FIG. 1N). Drive lock plate base 30700-2 (FIG. 1P) can optionally
include at least one cavity 295 (FIG. 1Q) that can, for example, enable weight management
of the MD, and reduce weight and materials costs. Drive lock kingpin 30700-4 can protrude
from drive lock base first side 297, and can interlock with a female connector (not
shown) in, for example, a vehicle. Drive lock kingpin 30700-4 can protrude from the
underside of the MD to provide enough clearance to interlock with the female connector
(not shown), and also to provide enough clearance from the ground to avoid any operational
interruptions. In some configurations, drive lock kingpin 30700-4 can clear the ground
by, for example, 1.5 inches. In some configurations, the rear securement loop 20700
(FIG. 1O) can engage a hook (not shown) in, for example, a vehicle, at the same time
or before or after drive lock kingpin 30700-4 (FIG. 1R) interlocks with a female connector.
The hook that engages with rear securement loop 20070 (FIG. 1O) can include a sensor
that can report, for example, to the vehicle if rear securement loop 20070 (FIG. 1O)
is engaged. If rear securement loop 20070 (FIG. 1O) is not engaged, the vehicle can
provide a warning to the user, or may not allow the vehicle to move until engagement
is reported. In some configurations, drive lock base plate 30700-2 (FIG. 1P) can include
a removable punch-out 30026-1 (FIG. 1R) that can be used to insert and remove drive
lock kingpin 30700-4 at any time. For example, the MD could be equipped with drive
lock base plate 30700-2 (FIG. 1P) with the removable punch-out 30026-1 (FIG. 1R).
Various types of drive lock kingpins 30700-4 can be accommodated to enable mounting
flexibility.
[0079] Referring now to FIG. 2A, central gearbox wet section can include, but is not limited
to including, central gearbox housing left outer 30020 (FIG. 2A), central gearbox
housing left inner 30021 (FIG. 2A), and right inner housing 30022 (FIG. 2A) that can
include seat and cluster gears and shafts, and position sensors.
[0080] Referring now to FIGs. 2B-2E, gear trains for cluster and seat are shown. The cluster
drive gear train can include four stages with two outputs. The shaft on the third
stage gear can span the powerbase. The final stage gear on each side can provide the
mounting surface for the wheel cluster assembly. Central gearbox wet section can include
the cluster drive gear set that can include shaft pinion stage one cluster rotate
21518 (FIG. 2M), that itself can drive pinion-gear cluster rotate stage 2 pinion 21535
(FIGs. 2O, 2P, 2B), that can drive cluster rotate pinion-gear stage 3 pinion 21536
(FIGs. 2Q, 2B), that itself can drive cluster rotate gear-pinion cross-shaft stage
3 21537 (FIG. 2R, 2B) that is connected to the left and right cluster cross shafts
30888 and 30888-1 (FIGs. 6D, 2D, and 2E), that can drive the cluster rotate stage
4 ring gears 30891 (FIG. 6D). The left and right cluster ring gears 30891 (FIG. 6D)
can be operably coupled with wheel cluster housings 21100 (FIG. 6A). The cluster drive
gear train can include pinion shaft stage 1 30617 (FIG. 2D), that can drive gear cluster
stage 1 30629 (FIG. 2D) and pinion shaft stage 2 30628 (FIG. 2D), that can in turn
drive gear cluster stage 2 30627 (FIG. 2D) and pinion shaft 30626 (FIG. 2D), that
can drive gear cluster rotate stage 3 30766 (FIG. 2D) and cross shaft cluster rotate
30765 (FIG. 2D). The input shaft of the wheel cluster assembly can engage two gear
trains, placed symmetrically with respect to the input shaft. There are two stages
of gear reduction to transmit power from the input shaft to the output shafts, on
which wheel assemblies 21203 (FIG. 1A) can be mounted. The two wheel cluster assemblies
can be identical.
[0081] Referring now to FIGs. 2F-2V, the seat drive transmission gear train can include
four stages with two outputs. The shaft on the final stage gear can span the powerbase
and can provide interfaces to the drive arms. Central gearbox wet section can also
include the seat drive gear train that can include the pinion height actuator shaft
stage 1 30618 (FIG. 2G, 2N) that can drive pinion-gear height actuator stage 2 21500
(FIG. 2H), that can drive gear height actuator stage 2 30633 (FIG. 2T), that can drive
gear height actuator stage 3 30625 (FIG. 2U) and pinion height actuator shaft stage
4 30877 (FIG. 2U). Gear height actuator stage 3 30625 (FIG. 2U) can drive pinion height
actuator shaft stage 3 30632 (FIG. 2T). Stage four pinion-gear height actuator 21502
(FIG. 2U) can drive the cross shaft sector gear stage four height actuator 30922 (FIG.
2S) that is mounted upon cross shaft sector gear height actuator stage 4 30909 (FIG.
2S), that is operably coupled at 255 to the left and right lifting arms 30065 (FIG.
5A). Seat absolute position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3L) can be associated with cross shaft
sector gear height actuator 30909 (FIG. 2S).
[0082] Referring now to FIGs. 3A and 3B, seat motors assemblies 21582 (FIG. 3A) and cluster
motor assemblies 21583 can be securely positioned within housings 30020, 30021, and
30022. Seat height absolute position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3B) can be operably coupled
with gear teeth rear clamp 30135 (FIG. 3J) operably coupled with rear half gear clamp
30135 (FIG. 3J) and mounted upon sector gear cross shaft 30909 (FIG. 3B).
[0083] Referring now primarily to FIG. 3C, central gearbox housings 21515 can include mounting
areas for seat/cluster brakes, motors, and sensors. Each drive transmission can include
a motor, brake, and gear transmission. The brake can be disengaged when electrical
power is applied, and can be engaged when electrical power is removed. A seat/cluster
motor mounting area can house motor mount bottom 30126 (FIGs. 3D and 3E) and motor
mount top 30127 (FIGs. 3D and 3E), seat/cluster motor assembly 21582 (FIGs. 3D and
3E), DC motor 70707 (FIG. 3D) and brake without manual release 70708-2 (FIG. 3H).
A wheel motor mounting area can house wheel motor assembly 21583 (FIGs. 3F and 3G),
motor mount top 30125, and brake without manual release 70708-2 (FIG. 3H). In some
configurations, seat and cluster cross shafts, motors, brakes, and motor couplings
can include the same or similar parts. Motors can provide the primary types of motion
on the MD: wheel, cluster and seat. Wheel motors 21583 (FIG. 3F) can drive each wheel
transmission. Cluster motor 21582 (FIG. 3D) can drive the cluster transmission. Device
safety and reliability requirements can suggest a dual redundant, load sharing motor
configuration. Each motor can have two sets of stator windings, mounted in a common
housing. Two separate motor drives can be used to power the two sets of stator windings.
The power supply for each drive can be a separate battery. This configuration can
minimize the effects of any single point failure in the path from battery 70001 (FIG.
1E) to motor output. Each set of stator windings, together with its corresponding
segment of the rotor (referred to as a motor half) can contribute approximately equal
torque during normal operation. One motor half can be capable of providing the required
torque for device operation. Each motor half can include a set of rotor position feedback
sensors for commutation. Seat/cluster motors 21582 (FIG. 3D) and wheel motors 21583
(FIG. 3F) can include, but are not limited to including, a single shaft and a dual
(redundant) stator BLDC motor operating at up to 66 VDC with a sine drive (voltage
range 50 - 66 VDC). The motors can include two 12-V relays mounted on an interface
board. One relay can govern the activity of the motor. In some configurations, there
can be three sensor outputs per motor half, each sensor being 60° offset from the
next. Sensors can include, for example, but not limited to, Hall sensors. The sensors
can be used for commutation and can provide position information for further feedback.
The motors can include a dual motor winding, drive, and brake coil configuration.
That is, two separate sets of motor windings and two separate motor drives can be
utilized in driving one shaft. Similarly, the brake drives can be used to drive two
coils to disengage the brake for one shaft. This configuration can allow the system
to respond to a single point failure of the electronics by continuing to operate its
motors and brakes until a safe state can be achieved. The seat and cluster motor shafts
are aligned with the seat and cluster drive train input shafts by the motor couplings
as the motors are installed. The motor shafts are secured in this correct alignment
by motor mount fasteners.
[0084] Continuing to refer to FIG. 3C, the mechanical package of each seat sensor 21578
(FIG. 3M) and cluster sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) can house two independent electronic
sensors that can relay information to PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15B). Seat position sensor
processor A (FIG. 18C) and cluster position sensor processor A (FIG. 18C) can receive
position information into A-side electronics, and seat position sensor processor B
(FIG. 18D) and cluster position sensor processor B (FIG. 18D) receive position information
into the B-side electronics, providing redundant electronics that can enable full
system operation even if one side of the electronics has issues. Seat sensors and
cluster sensors that feed A- and B-side electronics can be co-located to enable measurement
of similar mechanical movement. Co-location can enable results comparison and fault
detection. The absolute seat and cluster position sensors can report the position
of the seat and cluster, and can be referenced each time the MD is powered up, and
as a backup position reference when the MD is powered. While the MD is powered, position
sensors built into seat and cluster motors can be used to determine seat and cluster
position. Seat position sensor upper/lower housings 30138/30137 (FIG. 3M) can house
the electronic sensors, shaft, and gear of the single stage gear train that connects
the sensors to sector gear cross shaft assembly 21504 (FIG. 3J) and the cluster cross
shaft 30765 (FIG. 6D) respectively. The shaft and gear can be molded as a single part,
for example, from a plastic such as, for example, a lubricous plastic that can enable
molding with no additional bearing material or lubricant.
[0085] Referring now to FIGs. 3D-3G, seat/cluster motor 21583 (FIG. 3F) and wheel motors
21582 (FIG. 3D) can each include at least one thermistor 70025 that can be thermally
connected to the motors. At least one thermistor 70025 can report temperature data
to the A-side and B-side electronics. The temperature data can be used, for example,
but not limited to, for reducing power usage when the motors reach a pre-selected
threshold temperature to avoid damage to the motors. In some configurations, each
motor can include two thermistors 70025 - one for each redundant half of the motor.
Thermistor 70025 can be affixed to a sleeve that can be operably coupled with the
laminations that make up the motor body. Thermistor 70025 can enable an indirect estimate
of the motor winding temperature. The temperature data for a particular motor can
be routed to the processor associated with the motor. In some configurations, the
temperature data can be quantized by the analog/digital converter on the processor,
if necessary, and the quantized values can be fed into a temperature estimator algorithm.
The algorithm can include a model of the heat transfer path, empirically derived for
each motor, that can account for the electrical power delivered to the windings, the
heat flux through the windings and housing (where thermistor 70025 makes its measurement),
and from the housing to the chassis the motor is mounted to. A thermal estimator algorithm
can use the electrical current going to the motor as well as the motor housing (thermistor)
temperature to provide an estimate of motor winding temperature and other variables
such as, but not limited to, motor speed. If the motor is spinning quickly, there
can be greater heating due to, for example, eddy current losses. If the motor is stalled,
the current can be concentrated in one phase and can increase the rate of heating
in that winding. The thermistor signal can be transmitted along the cable between
the motor and PBC 50001 (FIG. 15B). At PBC 50001 (FIG. 15B), each motor cable can
break into two connectors: (1) first connector 50001-1A (FIG. 15B) including pins
for three motor phase wires, and second connector 50001-1B (FIG. 15B) for Hall sensors,
phase relay, brake, and thermistors 70025. In some configurations, first connector
50001-1A (FIG. 15B) can include, but is not limited to including, a 4-pin Molex Mega-Fit
connector. In some configurations, second connector 50001-1B (FIG. 15B) can include,
but is not limited to including, a 10-pin Molex Micro-Fit connector. The motors of
the MD can be thermally pressed into the housings of the MD that are fastened to the
central housing. The thermal pressing can provide a thermal conduction path from the
motors to the central housing.
[0086] Referring now to FIGs. 3H and 31, separate electromagnetic holding brakes can be
coupled to each motor. The electromagnetic holding brakes can include two electrically
isolated coils, and each can be energized by a brake drive in each of the motor drives.
The brake can disengage when both of its coils are energized, and can be disengaged
when only one of its coils is energized. The brakes can be designed to automatically
engage when the unit is off or in the case of a total power loss, therefore holding
position and/or failing safe. The electromagnetic brakes can be used to hold the MD
in place when the wheels are not in motion and similar brakes can hold the cluster
and seat in place when not in motion. The brakes can be controlled by commands from
the powerbase processors. When the MD is powered down, the brakes can automatically
engage to prevent the MD from rolling. If the automatic brakes are manually disengaged
at power on, the motor drives can activate to hold the MD in position and the system
can report to the user that the wheel brakes have been disengaged. If a brake lever
is disengaged after power is on, power off requests can be blocked, under some circumstances,
to avoid unintentional rolling of the MD after it has powered down. Disengaging the
automatic brakes can be used to manually push the MD when it is powered off. Each
of the four motors that drive the right wheels, left wheels, cluster and seat can
be coupled to a holding brake. Each brake can be a spring-applied, electromagnetically
released brake, with dual redundant coils. In some configurations, the motor brakes
can include a manual release lever. Brake without brake lever 70708-2 (FIG. 3H) can
include, but is not limited to including, motor interface 590 and mounting interface
591. In some configurations, motor interface 590 can include a hexagonal profile that
can mate with a hexagonal motor shaft. Brake with brake lever 70708-1 (FIG. 31) can
include mounting interface 591A that can include hexagonal profile 590A. Brake with
brake lever 70708-1 can include manual brake release lever 592A that can operably
couple with brake release spring arms 30000 (FIG. 9G) that can operably couple with
spring 40037 (FIG. 9J).
[0087] Referring now to FIGs. 3J-3L, central gearbox housings 21515 can include at least
one absolute seat position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) that can be operably coupled with
seat position sensor gear teeth clamp 30135 (FIG. 3K). Seat position sensor gear teeth
clamp 30135 (FIG. 3K) can include embossing 273 (FIG. 3K) to assist in aligning and
orientation of seat position sensor gear teeth clamp 30135 (FIG. 3K) around cross
shaft stage 4 sector gear 21504, and fastened to rear half gear clamp 30136. Seat
position sensor tooth gear 30134 (FIG. 3M) of absolute seat position sensor 21578
(FIG. 3M) can interlock seat position sensor tooth gears 30134 (FIG. 3M) with position
sensor gear teeth clamp 30135 (FIG. 3K) as cross shaft sector gear height actuator
30909 (FIG. 21A-3) moves. Sector cross shaft 30909 (FIG. 3L) can include a hollow
shaft that can operably couple the seat drive train to the seat lifting arms on the
left and right side of the central housing. The fourth stage seat height sector gear
is clamped onto the shaft and restrained from rotating about the shaft by a key connection
between the shaft and gear. The left and right lifting arms are needed to be aligned
with each other to assure the seat will be lifted symmetrically. The left and right
lifting arms are connected by pins and bolts in an asymmetric pattern that can only
be assembled in the correct orientation. This forces the lifting arms to always be
aligned. Seat absolute position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) can measure the rotation of
sector gear cross shaft 30909 (FIG. 3L) that connects to and lifts the seat lifting
drive arms 21301 (FIG. 5D) on the left and right side of central gearbox 21514 (FIG.
1A). Sector gear cross shaft 30909 (FIG. 3J) can rotate through less than 90° of rotation,
and can be coupled to seat position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) through a one-stage gear
train that can cause seat position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) to rotate more than 180°,
thereby doubling the sensitivity of the position measurement of the seat. Seat position
sensor gear clamp 30136 (FIG. 3J) can matingly interlock with seat position sensor
gear teeth clamp 30135 (FIG. 3K) around sector gear cross shaft 30909 (FIG. 3J). The
interlocked combination can provide geared interaction with seat absolute position
sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M). Seat absolute position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) can include,
but is not limited to including, seat position sensor tooth gear 30139 (FIG. 3M),
Hall sensor 70020 (FIG. 3M), magnet 70019 (FIG. 3M), seat position sensor upper plate
30138 (FIG. 3M), and seat position sensor lower plate 30137 (FIG. 3M). Magnet 70019
(FIG. 3M) can be mounted on upper plate 30138 (FIG. 3M). Upper plate 30138 (FIG. 3M)
can be securely mounted upon lower plate 30137 (FIG. 3M).
[0088] Referring now to FIG. 3O, at least one absolute cluster position sensor 21579 (FIG.
3O) can include Hall sensor 70020 (FIG. 3O), cluster position sensor cluster cross-shaft
gear 30145 (FIG. 6E) and cluster position tooth gear 30147 (FIG. 3O). Cluster rotate
stage three cross shaft 21537 (FIG. 2R) can be geared to interface with absolute cluster
position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) through cluster position sensor tooth gear 30147 (FIG.
3O). Seat absolute position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) can determine the location of the
seat support bracket 24001 (FIG. 8B) relative to central gearbox 21514 (FIG. 9). Cluster
position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) can determine the position of wheel cluster housing
21100 (FIG. 6A) relative to central gearbox 21514 (FIG. 9). Seat absolute position
sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) and cluster position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) can together determine
the position of the seat with respect to the wheel cluster assembly 21100 (FIG. 6A).
Seat position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) and cluster position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) can
sense absolute position. Absolute seat position sensor 21578 (FIG. 3M) can sense that
the seat has moved since a previous power off/on. If the MD is powered off and the
seat or cluster drive train move, the seat and cluster sensors can sense the new location
of the seat and cluster relative to central gearbox 21514 (FIG. 9) when the MD is
powered back on. The fully internal sensor system of the MD can provide protection
to the sensors with respect to mechanical impact, debris, and water damage.
[0089] Referring now primarily to FIG. 4, caster wheels 21001 can be attached to central
gearbox 21514 for use when the seat height is at its lowest position, supporting a
portion of the MD when the MD is in standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A). Caster wheels
21001 can swivel about a vertical axis allowing changes in direction. Caster wheels
21001 can allow maneuverability and obstacle traversal. Caster assembly 21000 can
include caster arm 30031 that can be operably connected, at a first end, to caster
wheel 21001. Caster arm 30031 can include caster arm shaft 229 that can enable operable
connection between caster arm 30031 and central gearbox 21514 at caster arm port 225.
Caster arms 30031 can be secured in pockets 225 to prevent sliding out while enabling
rotation. Pockets 225 can be lined with plastic bushings to enable caster arms 30031
to rotate. Caster spring plate 30044 can be operably connected to central gearbox
21514. Compression spring 40038 can enable shock absorption, stability, and continued
operation when caster assembly 21000 encounters obstacles. Compression spring 40038
can provide suspension to the system when caster wheels 21001 are in operation. Caster
assembly 21000 can rest upon compression spring 40038 that can itself rest upon caster
spring plate 30044. Compression spring 40038 can be attached to caster spring plate
30044 by spring cap 30037, sleeve bushing 40023, and o-ring 40027. In some configurations,
o-ring 40027-3 can be used as a rebound bumper. Compression spring 40038 can restrict
the range of rotation of caster arms 30031 to maintain caster wheel 21001 in an acceptable
location.
[0090] Referring now primarily to FIG. 5A, the vertical position of the user can be changed
through the seat drive mechanism, consisting of a transmission and a four-bar linkage
attaching the seat assembly to central gearbox 21514. The elements of the four-bar
linkage can include, but are not limited to including, central gearbox 21514, two
drive arms 30065 (one on each side of the central gearbox), two stabilizer arms 30066
(one on each side), and seat brackets 30068. The seat drive transmission can include
a significant reduction to provide torque to both drive arm links for lifting the
user and seat assembly relative to central gearbox 21514. Because central gearbox
21514 acts as an element of the four-bar linkage driving the seat, central gearbox
21514 can rotate relative to the ground to maintain the seat angle during a seat transition.
Thus, the cluster drive and seat drive can act in concert during a seat transition.
The rotation of central gearbox 21514 can move caster assemblies 21000, the movement
of which can avoid obstacles such as, for example, but not limited to, curbs. A seat
of any kind can be used with the MD by attaching the seat to seat brackets 30068.
Lift arm 21301 (FIGs. 5D/5E) can operably couple with seat brackets 30068 at lift
arm first end 243. Lift arm 21301 (FIGs. 5D/5E) can be operably coupled with central
gearbox 21514 at lift arm second end 245. The movement of lift arm 21301 (FIGs. 5D/5E)
can be controlled with signals transmitted from electronics housed in central gearbox
21514 through control port 255 to lift arm 21301 (FIGs. 5D/5E). Lift arm 21301 (FIGs.
5D/5E) can include tie-down 233 (FIG. 5E) that can enable a secure placement of the
MD in, for example, but not limited to, a vehicle. Stabilizer arm 21302 (5C) can operably
couple with seat brackets 30068 at link first end 239 (5C). Stabilizer arm 21302 (5C)
can be operably coupled with central gearbox 21514 at link second end 241 (5C). The
movement of stabilizer arm 21302 (5C) can be controlled by the movement of lift arm
21301 (FIGs. 5D/5E). Stabilizer link rest bumper 30055 can smooth the ride for the
user of the MD, and can reduce wear on gears within central gearbox with electronics
21514. In some configurations, bumper 30055 can rest in bumper housing 263, and can
be secured in place by stabilizer link rest end cap 30073. The linkage assembly that
is formed by lift arm 21301 and stabilizer ink 21302 (5C) can rest on bumper 30055
when the MD is in standard mode. The absolute position of the motor, determined by
an absolute position sensor associated with the motor, can determine when the linkage
assembly should be resting on bumper 30055. The motor current required to move the
linkage can be monitored to determine when the linkage assembly is resting on the
bumper 30055. When the linkage assembly is resting on bumper 30055, the gear train
may not be exposed to impacts that can result from, for example, obstacles encountered
by the MD and/or obstacles and vehicle motion encountered by a vehicle transporting
the MD.
[0091] Referring now to FIG. 5B, vehicle tie-downs 30069 can be operably coupled with seat
brackets 30068 to allow the MD to be secured in a motor vehicle. The restraint system
of the MD can be designed to allow a user to remain seated in the MD for transport
in a vehicle. Seat brackets 30068 can include, but are not limited to including, seat
support bracket plate 30068A that can provide an interface between seat support bracket
30068 and central gearbox 21514 (FIG. 5A). Seat attachment rail 30081 can be sized
according to the seat chosen for use. Seat brackets 30068 can be customized to attach
each type of seat to lifting arms 21301 (FIG. 5D) and stabilizer arms 21302 (5C).
Seat brackets 30068 can enable the seat to quickly and easily be removed for changing
the seat and for enabling transport and storage, for example.
[0092] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 6A and 6B, cluster assembly can include cluster
housing 30010/30011 (FIG. 6K), cluster interface pin 30160 (FIG. 6A), and o-ring 40027-6
(FIG. 6A) that can environmentally isolate the interior of central gearbox 21514 at
the cluster connection. Each cluster assembly can include a two-stage gear train replicated
on both left and right sides of central gearbox 21514 to drive each cluster assembly
simultaneously. Each cluster assembly can independently operate the set of two wheels
21203 (FIG. 6A) on wheel cluster 21100 (FIG. 6A), thereby providing forward, reverse
and rotary motion of the MD, upon command. The cluster assembly can provide the structural
support for wheel clusters 21100 (FIG. 6A) and the power transmission for the wheels
21203 (FIG. 6A). The cluster assembly can include, but is not limited to including,
ring gear nut 30016 (FIG. 6B), ring gear 21591 (6J), ring gear seal 30155 (FIG. 6B),
cluster interface cover 21510 (FIG. 6C), first configuration cluster plate interface
30014 (FIG. 61), cluster interface gasket 40027-14 (FIG. 6B), cluster rotate stage
four pinion shaft 30888 (FIG. 31A4), brake with manual release 70708 (FIG. 31), brushless
DC servomotor 2-inch stack 21583 (FIG. 3D), and motor adapter 30124 (FIG. 6B). Second
configuration cluster interface plate 30014A (FIG. 6H) can alternatively provide the
functionality of first configuration cluster interface plate 30014 (FIG. 61). The
cluster interface assembly can drive cluster wheel drive assembly 21100 (FIG. 6A)
under the control of powerbase processors on powerbase controller board 50001 (FIG.
15B). The cluster interface assembly can provide the mechanical power to rotate wheel
drive assemblies 21100 (FIG. 6A) together, allowing for functions dependent on cluster
assembly rotation, for example, but not limited to, stair and curb climbing, uneven
terrain, seat lean adjustments, and balance mode. Cluster motor 21583 (FIG. 6B) can
supply input torque to the cluster interface assembly. The cluster interface assembly
can provide a reduction to deliver the torque required to lift the user seated upon
the MD when climbing stairs or lifting up to balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22B). Power
from cluster motor 21583 (FIG. 6B) can be transmitted to the output shaft to provide
the low speed, high torque performance required for stair and obstacle navigation.
Cluster o-ring 40027-14 (FIG. 6B) can form a three-way seal between the cluster plate
30014 (FIG. 6A), cluster interface housing cap 30014 (FIG. 6B), and central housing
21514 (FIG. 6A).
[0093] Continuing to refer to FIG. 6B, cluster drive train damper 40027-21 can damp oscillations
when it is necessary to hold the cluster drive train steady. For example, when the
cluster gear train is holding the front wheels off the ground in standard mode, the
cluster drive train may be difficult to hold steady with motor commands because of
the backlash in the drive train. The motor commands can generate more correction than
is needed and can require corrections in a direction that can lead to oscillation.
The oscillation can be damped with added friction in the cluster drive train. An elastomeric
material can be clamped between the cluster output bearing and cluster interface plate
30014 that can cause friction. Alternatively, a less efficient bearing with significant
drag like a bronze or plastic bushing can be used.
[0094] Referring primarily to FIG. 6C, cluster cross shaft 30765 (FIG. 6D) can operably
couple with ring gear 30891 that can rotate cluster housing 21100 (FIG. 6A). Each
of cluster housings 21100 (FIG. 6A) can include two wheels 21203 (FIG. 6A) that are
positioned symmetrically about the center of rotation of cluster housing 21100 (FIG.
6A). In some configurations, the MD can function substantially the same regardless
of which of wheels 21203 (FIG. 6A) on cluster housings 21100 (FIG. 6A) are nearest
castor wheels 21001 (FIG. 4). Cluster position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) can include,
based on the symmetry, coupling with cluster cross shaft 30765 (FIG. 6C) with a gear
ratio that can cause cluster position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O) to rotate one full rotation
for each half rotation of cluster housing 21100 (FIG. 6A), which doubles the resolution
of cluster position sensor 21579 (FIG. 3O). Cluster housing 21100 (FIG. 6A) is symmetric
so that, for each half revolution, the cluster will function just as if a full rotation
has occurred.
[0095] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 6C and 6D, cluster cross shaft 30765 (FIG. 6F),
part of the cluster gear train, can operably couple centrally-located third stage
gear cluster rotate 30766 (FIG. 6F) to fourth stages 30888 (FIG. 6D) of the gear train
that are mounted on the left and right side of central housings 21514 (FIG. 6A) under
cluster interface caps 30014 (FIG. 6C). Cluster cross shaft 30765 (FIG. 6F) can include
hollow shaft 30765-4 (FIG. 6G) that can include female spline 30765-3 (FIG. 6G). Fourth
stages 30888 (FIG. 6D) can include male splines 30888-1 (FIG. 6C) on one end and pinion
gears 30888-2 (FIG. 6C) that are aligned with the teeth of male splines 30888-1 on
the other end. In this configuration, the teeth of pinion gears 30888-2 (FIG. 6C)
on fourth stages 30888 (FIG. 6D) are aligned when they are assembled. In some configurations,
the splines and gears can include fifteen teeth, but other numbers of teeth can be
accommodated in the present teachings. The gear alignment can enable left and right
cluster housings to be assembled onto the central housings so that wheels are aligned.
This critical alignment enables the MD to rest on all four wheels when driving with
the four main drive wheels.
[0096] Referring now to FIG. 6K, cluster wheel drive 21100 (FIG. 6A) can include, but is
not limited to including, outer cluster housing 30011, input pinion plug assembly
21105, wheel drive output gear 30165, wheel drive output shaft 30102, wheel drive
intermediate shaft and pinion spur 30163, wheel drive intermediate gear 30164, and
inner cluster housing 30010. At least one magnet 40064, captured between housings
30010/30011 at magnet housings 40064-1, can be positioned to be exposed to oil within
cluster housing 21100A, and can attract and remove ferrous metal particulate from
the oil, reducing gear, bearing, and seal wear caused by particulate in the oil. The
teeth of input pinion plug 21105 can engage with wheel drive intermediate stage spur
30163, and wheel drive intermediate stage spur 30163 can engage with the wheel drive
output gear 30165. When drive assembly 21532 (FIG. 6L) rotates, output stage spur
21533 rotates, the output stage spur shaft rotates, and wheel 21203 (FIG. 6A) can
rotate. Wheel drive intermediate stage spur 30163 (FIG. 6L) can achieve and maintain
correct positioning by coupling with gear key 30602 (FIG. 6L) that fits within the
shaft cavity of wheel drive intermediate gear 30164 (FIG. 6L).
[0097] Referring now to FIG. 6M, clam shell housings 21101/21103 can include seams 21100-1
around the perimeter to retain oil within housings 21100/21103, and prevent environmental
contamination to housings 21101/21103. Bonding material 21101-2, for example, but
not limited to, an elastomeric bonding material, can be applied to mating surfaces
of housings 21100/21103. Lips and/or o-ring seals can surround each shaft that passes
into and/or through housings 21101/21103. Cluster housing 21100A can include oil port
21101-4 for adding oil.
[0098] Referring now primarily to FIG. 7A, the main drive wheels can be large enough to
allow the MD to climb over obstacles, but small enough to fit securely on the tread
of a stair. The compliance of the tires can reduce vibrations transmitted to the user
and loads transmitted to the MD. The main drive wheels can remain fixed to the MD
unless intentional action is taken by the user or a technician. The tires can be designed
to minimize electrostatic build-up during surface traversal/contact. Split rim wheel
pneumatic tire assembly 21203 can be mounted onto cluster assembly 21100 (FIG. 6A)
of the MD to afford wheeled movement to the MD.
[0099] Referring now to FIG. 7B, split rim wheel tire assembly 21203 can include, but is
not limited to including, outer split rim 30111, tire 40060 (FIG. 7D), inner tube
40061, rim strip 40062, shield disk 30113, shield disk spacer 30123, and inner split
rim 30112. Pneumatic tire can house inner tube 40061 which can surround rim strip
40062. Shield disk 30113 can be captured between the inner and outer rim of split
rim assembly 21203. Shield disk 30113 can be preloaded in a pre-selected shape, for
example, to enable securing positioning. Shield disk 30113 can guard against foreign
object protrusion through wheel tire assembly 21203. Shield disk 30113 can provide
a smooth surface that can discourage foreign object jamming and wheel damage. Shield
disk 30113 can provide customization opportunities, for example, custom colors and
designs can be selected and provided on shield disk 30113. In some configurations,
tire assembly 21203 can accommodate solid tires such as, for example, but not limited
to, foam-filled tires. Tire selection can be based on the features that a user desires
such as durability, smooth ride, and low failure rate.
[0100] Referring now to FIGs. 7C through 7M, main drive wheels 21203 (FIG. 7B) can be configured
to accommodate traveling over varying types of terrain including, but not limited
to, sand-like surfaces. In some configurations, each of drive wheels 21203 (FIG. 7B)
such as first outer split rim 21201A (FIG. 7C), can accommodate detachable second
drive wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C). Second drive wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C) can be installed
by the user seated in the MD or by an assistant. Second drive wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C)
can be attached to first drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C) by depressing second drive wheel
21201B (FIG. 7C) onto first drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C), rotating second drive wheel
21201B (FIG. 7C), and inserting locking pin 21201-A4 (FIG. 7K) until it becomes engaged.
The attachment steps can be performed by the user seated in the MD as the user expects
to encounter challenging terrain. The attachment steps can also be performed while
not seated in the MD. First drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C) can include attachment base
40062-1 (FIG. 7F) that can provide a means for interlocking first drive wheel 21201A
(FIG. 7C) with second drive wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C). Attachment base 40062-1 (FIG.
7F) can include locking pin receiver 40062-1B (FIG. 7F) and a retaining lip 30090-1A
(FIG. 7E) for twist-lock wheel attachment of second drive wheel 21201 B (FIG. 7C).
Second drive wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C) can include locking pin 21201-A4 (FIG. 7K) that
can operably mate with locking pin receiver 40062-1B (FIG. 7F) of second drive wheel
21201B (FIG. 7C). Locking pin 21201-A4 (FIG. 7K) can include spring 21201-A2 (FIG.
71) that can enable access to locking pin 21201-A4 (FIG. 7K) after locking pin 21201-A4
(FIG. 7K) has been disengaged, and can enable secure locking of locking pin 21201-A4
(FIG. 7K) when locking pin 21201-A4 (FIG. 7K) is engaged. Attachment base 40062-1
(FIG. 7F) can include retaining tangs 40062-1A (FIG. 7F) for twist-lock wheel attachment.
Retaining tangs 40062-1A (FIG. 7F) can operably couple with retaining lip 30090-1B
(FIG. 7E) of first drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C). In some configurations, second drive
wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C) can accommodate hubcap 21201-A1 (FIG. 7H) that can provide
access opening 21201-A1A (FIG. 7H) for locking pin removing ring 21201-A4A (FIG. 7K).
In some configurations, first drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C) and second drive wheel
21201B (FIG. 7C) can be different or the same sizes and/or can have different or the
same treads on tires 40060.
[0101] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 7C through 7M, in some configurations, the attachment
means between first drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C) and second drive wheel 21201B (FIG.
7C) can include a castellated push-in and rotate to lock means (not shown) having
a plurality of radially extending tabs and a mounting structure having a plurality
of retaining members. In some configurations, the attachment means can include an
undercut or male lip (not shown). In some configurations, the attachment means can
include features (not shown) on spokes 30090-1C (FIG. 7E). In some configurations,
the attachment means can include fastener housing 21201-A3 (FIG. 7J) that can mount
between hubs 21201-A2 (FIG. 7E) of second drive wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C) and first drive
wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C). Fasteners such as, for example, but not limited to, screws
or bolts can operably engage first drive wheel 21201A (FIG. 7C) with second drive
wheel 21201B (FIG. 7C) through the cavities in fastener housing 21201-A3 (FIG. 7J).
[0102] Referring now primarily to FIG. 8, the MD can be fitted with any number of sensors
147 (FIG. 16B) in any configuration. In some configurations, some of sensors 147 (FIG.
16B) can be mounted on MD rear 122 to accomplish specific goals, for example, backup
safety. Stereo color cameras/illumination 122A, ultrasonic beam range finder 122B,
time-of-flight cameras 122D/122E, and single point LIDAR sensors 122F can be mounted,
for example, but not limited to, to cooperatively sense obstacles behind the MD. The
MD can receive messages that can include information from the cameras and sensors,
and can enable the MD to react to what might be happening out of the view of the user.
The MD can include reflectors 122C that can be optionally fitted with further sensors.
Stereo color cameras/illumination 122A can be used as taillights. Other types of cameras
and sensors can be mounted on the MD. Information from the cameras and sensors can
be used to enable a smooth transition to balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 3A) by providing
information to the MD to enable the location of obstacles that might impede the transition
to balance mode (described herein).
[0103] Referring now primarily to FIG. 9A, the service brake can be used to hold the MD
in place by applying brake force to the wheel drive motor couplings, stopping the
wheel from turning. The brakes can function as holding brakes whenever the device
is not moving. The brakes can hold when the MD is powered on or off. A manual brake
release lever can be provided so that the MD may be pushed manually with a reasonable
amount of effort when power is off. In some configurations, the lever can be located
at the front of the powerbase and can be accessible by either the user or an attendant.
In some configurations, the manual release lever can be sensed by limit switches that
can indicate the position of the manual release lever. Central gearbox 21514 can include
brake release components including, but not limited to, manual brake release bracket
30003 (FIG. 9E), manual brake release shaft arm 30001 (FIG. 9H), manual brake release
spring arm 30000 (FIG. 9G), Hall sensor 70020 (FIG. 9A), surface mount magnet 70022,
manual brake release cam 30004 (FIG. 9F), and manual brake release shaft 30002 (FIG.
9D). Brake release lever handle 30070 (FIG. 91) can activate manual brake release
through manual brake release shaft 30002 (FIG. 9D). Manual brake release shaft 30002
(FIG. 9D) can be held in position by manual brake release bracket 30003 (FIG. 9E).
Manual brake release shaft 30002 (FIG. 9D) can include tapered end 30002A (FIG. 9D)
that can engage manual brake release shaft arm 30001 (FIG. 9H), which can be operably
connected to manual brake release cam 30004 (FIG. 9F). Manual brake release cam 30004
(FIG. 9H) can be operably connected to two manual brake release spring arms 30000
(FIG. 9G). Spring arms 30000 can operably connect to brake release lever 592A (FIG.
31). Hall sensor 70020 (FIG. 9A) can be operably coupled with PBC board 50001 (FIG.
91).
[0104] Referring now to FIG. 9B and 9C, brake release lever handle 30070 (FIG. 91) has a
return force, for example, a spring-loaded force, pulling on it when it is in engaged
position. Rotational damper 40083 can enable snap back avoidance for lever 30070 (FIG.
91). Rotational damper 40083 can be operably coupled with brake shaft 30002 (FIG.
9D) through connecting collar 30007 and damper actuator arm 30009. Rotational damper
40083 can allow relatively unrestricted movement when lever 30070 (FIG. 91) is turned
clockwise from a vertical position where the brakes are engaged to the horizontal
position where the brakes are released. When lever 30070 (FIG. 91) is turned counter-clockwise
to reengage the brakes, rotational damper 40083 can provide resistance to the rotation
of brake shaft 30002 (FIG. 9D), slowing the speed at which lever 30070 (FIG. 91) returns
to the vertical position, thus substantially preventing lever 30070 (FIG. 91) from
snapping back into the vertical position. Rotational damper 40083 can be operably
coupled with brake assembly stop housing 30003 (FIG. 9E). Damper actuator arm 30009
(FIG. 9B) can be operably coupled with brake shaft 30002 (FIG. 9D).
[0105] Referring now to FIG. 91, manual brake release lever 30070 can include material that
can be damaged before other manual brake release parts are damaged when excessive
force is applied. If manual brake release lever 30070 is damaged, manual brake release
lever 30070 can be replaced without opening of the central housing.
[0106] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 9J-9N, the manual release brake assembly can include
manual brake release bracket 30003 (FIG. 9E), manual brake release shaft arm 30001
(FIG. 9H), manual brake release spring arm 30000 (FIG. 9G), Hall sensor 70020 (FIG.
9J), surface mount magnet 70022, manual brake release pivot interface 30004 (FIG.
9F), and manual brake release shaft 30002 (FIG. 9D). Brake release lever handle 30070
(FIG. 91) can activate the manual brake release through manual brake release shaft
30002 (FIG. 9D). Manual brake release shaft 30002 (FIG. 9D) can be held in position
by manual brake release bracket 30003 (FIG. 9E). Manual brake release shaft 30002
(FIG. 9D) can include tapered end 30002-2A (FIG. 9D) that can engage manual brake
release shaft arm 30001 (FIG. 9H), which can be operably connected to manual brake
release pivot interface 30004 (FIG. 9F). Manual brake release pivot interface 30004
(FIG. 9F) can be operably coupled with two manual brake release spring arms 30000
(FIG. 15) at fastening cavities 30004A-1 (FIG. 9F) and 30004A-2 (FIG. 9F). Spring
arms 30000 (FIG. 9G) can operably couple with brake release lever 592A (FIG. 31).
[0107] Continuing to refer primarily to FIGs. 9J-9N, the service brake can include, but
is not limited to including, travel stop 30005 (FIG. 9K) that can limit the motion
of lever 30070 to a clockwise direction as viewed from the front of the MD from a
vertical position to a horizontal position. Travel stop 30005 (FIG. 9K) can prevent
lever 30070 (FIG. 9J) from rotating in a counterclockwise direction and can assist
an operator in releasing and engaging the brakes. Travel stop 30005 (FIG. 9K) can
be constructed of metal and can operably couple with second brake release shaft 30002
(FIG. 9D). Travel stop 30005 (FIG. 9K) can interface with features of central housing
21515 (FIG. 9A) that can limit the rotation of shaft 30002-2 (FIG. 9L). Hall sensor
70020 can sense if the manual brake release is engaged or disengaged. Hall sensor
70020 can operably couple with both A-side and B-side electronics using cables/connector
70030 which can be mechanically isolate Hall sensor 70020 from the A-side and B-side
electronics. Travel stop 30005 (FIG. 9M) can operably couple with shaft 30002-2 (FIG.
9L) through fastener 40000-1 (FIG. 9M). Travel stop 30005 can encounter protrusion
40003-2 which can enable limitation of the rotation of shaft 30002-2 (FIG. 9L).
[0108] Referring now to FIGs. 10A-10E and 11B, harnesses can be mounted to straddle the
inside and outside of the sealed part of central gearbox 21514 at the cable ports,
and can be surrounded by sealing features such as, for example, but not limited to,
o-rings or gaskets. UC port harness 60007 (FIG. 10C) can channel wires emerging from
UCP EMI filter 50007 (FIG. 10A) that can connect to PSC board 50002 (FIG. 11B). UC
port harness 60007 (FIG. 10C) can include a connector, to which cable 60016 (FIG.
10A) can mate, and thereby connect UCP EMI filter 50007 to UC 130 (FIG. 12A). Charge
input port harness 60008 (FIG. 10D) can channel wires emerging from charge input filter
50008 (FIG. 10A) that can connect PSC board 50002 (FIG. 91) to a charging means, for
example, but not limited to, charging power supply 70002 (FIGs. 11A-11D) via charger
port 1158 (FIGs. 10A, 11A-11D). Accessory port harness 60009 (FIG. 10E) can channel
wires emerging from auxiliary connector filter 50009 that can connect accessory wires
to PSC board 50002. The cable exit locations can be protected from impact and environmental
contamination by being positioned between the front wall of the MD and batteries 70001
(FIG. 1E). Articulating cable chain 1149 (FIGs. 11A-11D) can protect the cables and
can route the cables from the central housings to the seat, protecting the cables
from becoming entangled in the lifting and/or stabilizer arms.
[0109] Referring now to FIGs. 11A-11D, various wiring configurations can connect PBC board
50001, PSC board 50002, and battery packs 70001 (FIG. 1E) with UC 130, charge port
1158, and optional accessories 1150. Emergency power off request switch 60006 can
interface with e-box 1146 through panel mount 1153. Optional accessory DC/DC module
1155 can include, for example, but not limited to, a module that can plug in to PSC
board 50002. In some configurations, DC/DC supply 1155 for optional accessories can
be integrated into PSC board 50002 to eliminate a need for opening e-box 1146 outside
of a controlled environment. In some configurations, charge port 1158 can include
a solder termination of cables to a port. If transmission means 1151 includes cables,
the cables can be confined by use of cable carrier 1149 such as, for example, but
not limited to, IGUS
® energy chain Z06-10-018 or Z06-20-028. In some configurations, e-box 1146, that can
include, but is not limited to including, PBC board 50001 and PSC board 50002, can
be connected to UC 130, optional accessories 1150, and charge port 1158 through junctions
1157 (FIG. 11A) and transmission means 1151. In some configurations, strain relief
means 1156 (FIG. 11C) can provide the interface between e-box 1146 and UC 130, charge
port 1158, and optional accessories 1150. In some configurations, a cable shield can
be brought out to a forked connector and terminated to metal e-box 1146 with, for
example, a screw (see FIG. 11D). In some configurations, one or more printed circuit
boards 1148 (FIG. 11C) can operably couple with strain relief means 1156 L, J, and
K (FIG. 11C), which can be mounted to e-box 1146. Strain relief means 1156 L, J, and
K (FIG. 11C) can double as environmental seals and can provide channels through which
electrical signals or power can pass. Strain relief means 1156 L, J, and K (FIG. 11C)
can include, for example, grommets or glands, or could be overmolded and inseparable
from the cables. One or more printed circuit boards 1148 (FIG. 11C) can (1) provide
a place to connect internal harnesses between printed circuit boards 1148 (FIG. 11C)
and PSC board 50002, and (2) provide a place for electromagnetic compatibility (EMC)
filtration and electrostatic discharge (ESD) protection. EMC filtration and ESD protection
can be enabled by connecting printed circuit boards 1148 (FIG. 11C) to metal e-box
1146, forming chassis ground 1147.
[0110] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 11A-11D, charger port 1158 is the location where the
AC/DC power supply 70002 can be connected to the MD. The AC/DC power supply can be
connected to mains power via line cord 60025. Line cord 60025 can be changed to accommodate
various wall outlet styles. Charger port 1158 can be separate from UC 130 (FIG. 12A),
enabling charger port 1158 to be positioned in a location that is most assessable
to each end user. End users have different levels of mobility and may need charger
port 1158 to be positioned in a personally-accessible location. The connector that
plugs into charger port 1158 can be made without a latch to enable accessibility for
users with limited hand function. Charger port 1158 can include a USB port for charging
external items, such as cellphones or tablets, with the power from the MD. Charger
port 1158 can be configured with male pins that operably couple with female pins on
the AC/DC power supply. In some configurations, it may not be possible to operate
the MD when charger port 1158 in engaged, regardless of whether the AC/DC power supply
is connected to mains power.
[0111] Referring now to FIGs. 12A and 12B, user controller (UC) 130 can include, but is
not limited to including, a control device (for example, but not limited to, joystick
70007), mode selection controls, seat height and tilt/lean controls, a display panel,
speed selection control, a power on and off switch, an audible alert and mute capability,
and a horn button. In some configurations, using the horn button while driving is
allowed. UC 130 can include a means to prevent unauthorized use of the MD. UC 130
can be mounted anywhere on the MD. In some configurations, UC 130 can be mounted on
a left or right arm rest. The display panel of UC 130 can include a backlight. In
some configurations, UC 130 can include joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A), upper housing 30151,
lower housing 30152, toggle housing 30157, undercap 30158, and button platform 50020
(FIG. 12A) that can enable selection of options through, for example, button depression.
Touch screens, toggle devices, joystick, thumbwheels, and other user input devices
can be accommodated by UC 130.
[0112] Referring now to FIGs. 12C and 12D, second configuration UC 130-1 can include toggle
platform 70036 (FIG. 12C) that can include, for example, but not limited to, toggle
lever 70036-2 and toggle switch 70036-1 that can enable selection of options. In some
configurations, toggle lever 70036-2 can enable 4-way toggling (up, down, left, and
right), and toggle switch 70036-1 can enable 2-way toggling. Other option selection
means can replace buttons and toggles, as needed to accommodate a particular disability.
UC 130 (FIG. 12A) and second configuration UC 130-1 can include cable 60026 and cable
connector 60026-1. Cable connector 60026-2 can operably couple with UC PCB 50004 (FIG.
14A) to provide data and power to each configuration of the UC. Connector 60026-1
can operably couple UC 130 (FIG. 12A) with the powerbase through cable 60016 (FIG.
10A) that mates to circuit board 50007 (FIG. 10B).
[0113] Referring now to FIGs. 12E and 12F, third configuration UC 130-1A can include thumbwheel
knob 30173 that can be used to, for example, but not limited to, adjust a maximum
speed of the MD. In some configurations, thumbwheel knob 30173 can make a complete
revolution with no stops. By omitting stops, the mapping of the position, the change
of position, the rotational velocity, and the function of thumbwheel knob 30173 can
be interpreted in a variety of different ways, depending on the configuration of the
system. In some configurations, the user can dial thumbwheel knob 30173 "up" to request
a higher speed gain, and "down" to move the MD more slowly. The change in position,
and not the absolute position, of thumbwheel knob 30173 can be used to configure characteristics
of the MD. The sensitivity of thumbwheel knob 30173 can be configurable. For example,
a user with finger strength, sensitivity, and dexterity sufficient to roll and/or
twist thumbwheel knob 30173 in small increments can achieve fine control of thumbwheel
knob 30173 and its underlying functionality. On the other hand, a user with compromised
dexterity might adjust thumbwheel knob 30173 by bumping it with a knuckle or the edge
of the hand. Thus, in some configurations, a relatively higher sensitivity setting
can enable varying the speed gain from minimum to maximum across, for example, 180°
of travel. In some configurations, a relatively lower sensitivity setting, requiring
severing bumps of, for example, 90° each to traverse the same gain range. Continually
dialing thumbwheel knob 30173 "up" can eventually cause the speed value to discontinue
increasing. Further dialing "up" can be ignored. Dialing thumbwheel knob 30173 "down"
can be detected and can cause the gain value to decrease immediately, i.e. no "unwind"
of ignored upward movement of thumbwheel knob 30173 may be necessary. Because the
absolute position of thumbwheel knob 30173 may not be a factor in processing inputs
from thumbwheel knob 30173, the gain value through changes to the MD such as, for
example, but not limited to, mode changes and power cycling, can be dynamically configured.
In some configurations, the gain value can revert to a default value after a power
cycle. In some configurations, the gain value can be determined by a setting saved
during power down, even if thumbwheel knob 30173 moves after power down.
[0114] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 12E and 12F, The MD can include various speed settings
that can accommodate situations in which the MD might be placed, for example, but
not limited to, when the MD is either indoors or outdoors. The speed settings can
be associated with joystick movement. For example, a maximum forward speed that could
be appropriate for a particular setting can be set so that the user cannot go beyond
the maximum speed regardless of how the joystick is maneuvered. In some configurations,
the MD can be configured to ignore joystick movement. The effect of thumbwheel assembly
is to apply a gain on top of the MD's reaction to joystick movement.
[0115] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 12E and 12F, in some configurations, thumbwheel knob
30173 can rotate between hard stops of less than a complete revolution. In some configurations,
the change in wheel position can indicate a change in maximum speed. When the MD is
powered on, the position of thumbwheel knob 30173 before the preceding power off can
be recalled, and the new maximum speed, when thumbwheel knob 30173 is rotated, can
be based on the recalled position of thumbwheel knob 30173. In some configurations,
the sensitivity of thumbwheel knob 30173 can be adjusted. Depending on the sensitivity
adjustment, the rotation of thumbwheel knob 30173 can adjust the maximum speed from
a relatively small amount to a relatively large amount. Thumbwheel knob 30173 can
be assembled into a blind hole, thus eliminating the need for an environmental seal
at the mounting point of the thumbwheel assembly, and can eliminate a potential place
for water, dust, and/or other contaminants to enter the UC housing. Further, the thumbwheel
mechanism can be cleaned and serviced, and parts can be replaced without accessing
the rest of the UC housing. The angle of the shaft of thumbwheel knob 30173 can be
measured by a non-contact, Hall-effect sensor. The Hall-effect sensor, being a non-contact
sensor, can have an essentially infinite lifetime. The sensor can provide a voltage
that corresponds to the rotational position of the thumbwheel. In some configurations,
the signal can be processed by an analog-to-digital converter and the digital result
can be further processed. In some configurations, the sensor could directly output
a digital signal that could, for example, be communicated to the UC main processor
(see FIG. 14C) via I2C. In some configurations, the sensor can be dual redundant.
[0116] Referring now to FIG. 12G, third configuration upper housing 30151A can include,
but is not limited to including, LCD display 70040, button keypad 70035, joystick
70007, antenna 50025, spacer 30181, joystick backer ring 30154, and display coverglass
30153. In some configurations, buttons 70035 can include undermounted snapdomes (not
shown) that can enable the user to sense when buttons 70035 have been depressed. Antenna
50025 can be mounted within third configuration upper housing 30151A, and can enable,
for example, wireless communications between third configuration UC 130-1A (FIG. 12F).
Spacer 30181 can separate LCD display 70040 from other electronics within third configuration
UC 130-1A (FIG. 12F). LCD display 70040 can be protected from environmental hazards
by display coverglass 30153. Joystick 70007 can include connector 70007-1 (FIG. 12H)
that can provide power to joystick 70007, and can enable signal transmission from
joystick 70007. In some configurations, the direction of movement of joystick 70007
can be measured by more than one independent means to enable redundancy.
[0117] Referring now to FIGs. 12I-12K, UC 130 can include circuit board 50004 that can be
housed and protected by upper housing 30151 and lower housing 30152. UC 130 can include
display coverglass 30153 that can provide visual access to screens that can present
options to the user. A display can be connected to UC PCB 50004 by flexible connector
50004-2 (FIG. 14A). Optional EMC shield 50004-3 can guard against incoming and/or
outgoing emissions of electromagnetic interference to/from UC PCB 50004. Button assembly
50020-A and toggle switches 70036 can be optionally included. Buttons and/or toggles
can be mounted on toggle housing 30157 which can be operably connected with lower
housing 30152 and upper housing 30151 through undercap 30158. UC 130 can be mounted
onto the MD in a variety of ways and locations through mounting cleat 30106. Throughout
UC 130 are environment isolation features such as, for example, but not limited to,
o-rings such as toggle housing ring 130A, grommets such as cable grommet 40028 (FIG.
12K), and adhesives to isolate the components such as, for example, circuit board
50004, from water, dirt, and other possible contaminants. In some configurations,
joystick 70007 and speaker 60023 can be a commercially-available items. Joystick 70007,
such as, for example, but not limited to, APEM HF series, can include a boot that
can be accommodated by, for example, the pressure mount of boot mount cavity 30151-3
and joystick backer ring 30154.
[0118] Referring now to FIG. 12L, upper housing 30151 can include ribs 30151-5 that can
support circuit board 50004. Upper housing 30151 can include mounting spacers 30151-4,
space for secure mounting of joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A). Upper housing 30151 can include,
but is not limited to including, display cavity 30151-2 that can provide a location
for visual access means for display screens of UC 130. Upper housing 30151 can also
include button cavities, for example, but not limited to, power button cavity 30151-6
and menu button cavity 30151-7. Upper housing 30151 can include formed perimeter 30151-1
that can provide a consistent look and feel with other aspects of the MD. Upper housing
30151 can be constructed of, for example, but not limited to, polycarbonate, a polycarbonate
Acrylonitrile Butadiene Styrene blend, or other materials that can meet strength and
weight requirements associated with the UC. Joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be installed
in boot mount cavity 30151-3 using, for example, gaskets, backer ring 30154 (FIG.
12Q), fastening means such as, for example, but not limited to, screws and fastener
holes 30151-X, that can be used to attach joystick 70007 and backer ring 30154 (FIG.
12Q) to upper housing 30151. Installing the joystick boot can isolate UC PCB 50004
(FIG. 14A) and other sensitive components from the environment. Upper housing 30151
can include molding references 30151-X2 that can enable orientation of joystick 70007
during assembly. In some configurations, cable reference 30151-X2 can indicate where
joystick cable connector 70007-1 (FIG. 12H) can be positioned.
[0119] Referring now to FIG. 12M, lower housing 30152 can join upper housing 30151 (FIG.
12L) at perimeter geometry 30152-2. The combination of lower housing 30152 and upper
housing 30151 (FIG. 12L) can house UC PCB 50004 (FIG. 14A), speaker 60023 (FIG. 12K),
display coverglass 30153 (FIG. 12P), and joystick backer ring 30154 (FIG. 12Q), among
other parts. Environmental isolation features at the joint can include, for example,
but are not limited to, gaskets, o-rings, and adhesives. Lower housing 30152 can include
audio access holes 30152-1 that can be located adjacent to speaker mount location
30152-6. A commercially-available speaker can be mounted in speaker mount location
30152-6 and can be securely attached to lower housing 30152 using an attachment means
such as, for example, but not limited to, an adhesive, screws, and hook-and-eye fasteners.
Lower housing 30152 can include at least one post 30152-7 upon which can rest UC PCB
50004 (FIG. 121). Lower housing 30152 can include connector reliefs 30152-3 that can
provide space within lower housing 30152 to accommodate, for example, but not limited
to, joystick connector 50004-8 (FIG. 14A) and power and communications connector 50004-7
(FIG. 14A). Lower housing 30152 can be attached to the MD through fastening means
such as, for example, screws, bolts, hook-and-eye fasteners, and adhesives. When screws
are used, lower housing 30152 can include fastener receptors 30152-5 that can receive
fasteners that can attach toggle housing 30157 (FIG. 12R) to lower housing 30152.
Lower housing 30152 can also include pass-through guides 30152-4 that can position
fasteners, for example, but not limited to, sealing fasteners, that can securely connect
lower housing 30152 with undercap 30158 (FIG. 12K). Sealing fasteners can provide
environmental isolation. In some configurations, lower housing 30152 can be constructed
of, for example, but not limited to, die cast aluminum that can provide strength to
the structure.
[0120] Referring now to FIG. 12N, third configuration lower housing 30152A can include thumbwheel
geometry 30152-A1 that can accommodate thumbwheel 30173. Lower housing 30152 can optionally
include ribbing (not shown) molded into inner back 30152-9. The ribbing can increase
the strength and resistance to damage of UC 130, and can also provide resting positions
for UC PCB 50004 (FIG. 121). Lower housing 30152A can also provide raised posts 30173-XYZ
that can provide chassis ground contact points for UC PCB 50004, which can be grounded
to the powerbase. Chassis ground contact 30173-2 for cable shield 60031 (FIG. 12V)
can tie the metal from lower housing 30152A to the metal of the powerbase. Third configuration
lower housing 30152A can include thumbwheel enabling hardware such as, for example,
but not limited to, a position sensor that can include a magnetic rotary position
sensor such as, for example, the AMS AS5600 position sensor, that can sense the direction
of the magnetic field created by magnet 40064 that rotates when thumbwheel knob 30173
rotates. The magnetic sensor can be mounted upon a flex circuit assembly that can
provide power to and receive information from the magnetic sensor. In some configurations,
enabling hardware, including, but not limited to, bushing 40023, magnet 40064, magnet
shaft 30171, o-ring 40027, retaining nut 30172, and screw 40003, can operably couple
thumbwheel knob 30173 with second configuration lower housing 30152A, and can enable
the movement of magnet 40064 to be reliably sensed by the magnetic sensor. Lower housing
30152A can include a cylindrical pocket in a wall of lower housing 30152A where bushing
40023 is positioned. Bushing 40023 can provide radial and axial bearing surfaces for
shaft 30171. Shaft 30171 can include a flange onto which o-ring 40027 is placed. Shaft
30171 is captured by retaining, threaded, nut 30172 that includes a thru-hole sized
to fit shaft 30171, and smaller than flange/o-ring 40027. When assembled, o-ring 40027
is compressed which can eliminate axial play, and can create viscous drag when shaft
30171 is turned. Thumbwheel knob 30173 is assembled to shaft 30171 with a fastening
means such as, for example, but not limited to, a low-head fastener, a simple friction
fit, and/or knurling. Shaft 30171 can include magnet 40064. The magnetization direction
creates a vector normal to the axis of shaft 30171 which can be measured by a Hall-effect
sensor. A measurement of the magnetization vector can be provided by the sensor to
UC 130 (FIG. 12A). UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can compute, based on the magnetization vector
direction, a relative change in maximum speed. In some configurations, at least some
parts of the enabling hardware, for example, but not limited to, o-ring 40027, can
be lubricated with, for example, but not limited to, silicone grease, to provide a
smooth user experience. In some configurations, detents can be added to the thumbwheel
assembly to provide clicks as thumbwheel knob 30173 is manipulated.
[0121] Referring now to FIG. 120, screw 40003 can pass through thumbwheel 30173 and can
operably couple with magnet shaft 30171. The geometries of the enabling hardware can
interlock to retain thumbwheel 30173 in second configuration lower housing 30152A,
and can provide environmental isolation to the interior of UC 130 because there is
no need in the shown configuration for a shaft to pierce second configuration lower
housing 30152A. The geometry of the thumbwheel assembly enables in-field service and/or
replacement without separating upper housing 30151 (FIG. 12E) from lower housing 30152A.
In particular, thumbwheel knob 30173 can be replaced if damaged by impacts, or worn
out from use. In some configurations, thumbwheel knob 30173 can be operably coupled
with shaft 30171 by click-on or press-in fastening means.
[0122] Referring now to FIG. 12P, display coverglass 30153 can include clear aperture 30153-1
that can expose menu and options displays for the user. The dimensions of clear aperture
30153-1 can be, for example, but not limited to, different from the display active
area. Display coverglass 30153 can include frame 30153-4 that can be masked black
with a pressure sensitive adhesive layer. In some configurations, display coverglass
30153 can be masked with black paint, and double-sticky tape can be applied on top
of the black masking. Clear, unmasked area 30153-3 can admit ambient light. UC 130
can vary the brightness of the display based on the ambient light. Display coverglass
30153 can include button cavities 30153-5 and 30153-6 that can provide locations for
button keypad 70035. Display coverglass 30153 can include outward face 30153-2 that
can, in some configurations, include coatings that can, for example, reduce glaring
reflections and/or improve scratch resistance. In some configurations, a space can
exist between the material of coverglass 30153 and frame 30153-4. The space can include
decorative elements such as, for example, but not limited to, product logos, and can
be indelibly printed and/or etched.
[0123] Referring now to FIG. 12Q, joystick backer ring 30154 can include, but is not limited
to including, receptor 30154-3 to house a joystick boot and body, and holes/slots
30154-2 to fasten backer ring 30154 to upper housing 30151 (FIG. 12L). Holes/slots
30154-2 can be sized to accommodate multiple sizes of joysticks 70007 (FIG. 12A).
Holes 30154-1, for example, can accommodate connections among each component of UC
130 (FIG. 12A). In some configurations, backer ring 30154 can include a pattern of
notches 30154-X2 oriented circumferentially with respect to holes 30154-1 and slots
30154-2. Notches 30154-X2 can interface with ribs 30151-4 (FIG. 12M) in upper housing
30151 (FIG. 12M), and can ensure the correct rotational position of the hole and slot
patterns in backer ring 30154 during assembly of UC 130 (FIG. 12A).
[0124] Referring now to FIG. 12R, toggle housing 30157 can include pocket 30157-2 that can
house a toggle module, for example, but not limited to, button platform 50020-A (FIG.
12BB). Toggle housing 30157 can include connector cavity 30157-3 to accommodate a
flexible cable emanating from the toggle device. Toggle housing 30157 can include
through holes 30157-4 to accommodate fastening means that can connect components of
UC 130 (FIG. 12A) together. Toggle housing 30157 can include lower housing connector
cavities 30157-5 that can provide opening for fastening means to engage. Toggle housing
30157 can include sealing geometry 30157-6 that can enable mating/sealing between
toggle housing 30157 can include and undercap 30158, that can be secured by undercap
fastening means cavity 30157-8. Toggle housing 30157 can include toggle module fastener
cavities 30157-7 to enable attachment of the toggle module to toggle housing 30157.
Toggle housing 30157 can include forked guide 30157-1 to provide a guide for power/communications
cable 60031 (FIG. 12X). O-ring 130B can enable sealing and environmental isolation
between toggle housing 30157 and lower housing 30152A (FIG. 12N).
[0125] Referring now to FIGs. 12S and 12T, toggle housing second configuration 30157B can
enable mounting of toggle platform 70036 (FIG. 12T). Toggle housing second configuration
30157B can include toggle lever support geometry 30157A-1 (FIG. 12S) and toggle switch
support geometry 30157B-1 (FIG. 12S) that can provide supporting structure for toggle
lever 70036-2 (FIG. 12T) and toggle switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12T), respectively. Toggle
housing second configuration 30157A can include connector cavity 30157A-3to accommodate
connections between toggle platform 70036 (FIG. 12T) and electronic components of
UC 130 (FIG. 12A). Toggle housing 30157B can include pocket 30157-2 that can house
a toggle module, for example, but not limited to, button platform 50020-A (FIG. 12BB).
Toggle housing 30157B can include connector cavity 30157A-3 to accommodate a flexible
cable emanating from the toggle device. Toggle housing 30157B can include through
holes 30157A-4 to accommodate fastening means that can connect components of UC 130
(FIG. 12A) together. Toggle housing 30157B can include lower housing connector cavities
30157A-5 that can provide openings for fastening means to engage. Toggle housing 30157B
can include sealing geometry 30157A-6 that can enable mating/sealing between toggle
housing 30157B and undercap 30158 (FIG. 12U), that can be secured by undercap fastening
means cavity 30157A-8. Toggle housing 30157B can include toggle module fastener cavities
30157A-7 to enable attachment of the toggle module to toggle housing 30157B. Toggle
housing 30157B can include forked guide 30157A-1 to provide a guide for power/communications
cable 60031 (FIG. 12X). An o-ring (not shown) can enable sealing and environmental
isolation between toggle housing 30157B and lowering housing 30152A (FIG. 12N). Toggle
lever 70036-2 (FIG. 12T) and toggle switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12T) can be positioned and
sized to accommodate users having various hand geometries. In particular, toggle lever
70036-2 (FIG. 12T) can be spaced from toggle switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12T) by about 25-50
mm. Toggle lever 70036-2 (FIG. 12T) can have rounded edges, its top can be slightly
convex and substantially horizontal, and it can measure 10-14 mm across its top, and
can be about 19-23 mm in height. Toggle switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12T) can be about 26-30
mm long, 10-14 mm wide, and 13-17 mm high. Toggle lever 70036-2 (FIG. 12T) and toggle
switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12T) can be positioned at an angle of between 15° and 45° with
respect to joystick 70007 (FIG. 12K).
[0126] Referring now to FIG. 12U, undercap 30158 can include through fastening holes 30158-1
that can accommodate fastening means to operably couple the components of UC 130 (FIG.
12A). Undercap 30158 can include grommet cavity 30158-2 that can house grommet 40028
that can environmentally seal the cable entry point. Undercap 30158 can include mounting
cleat face 30158-5 that can provide connection points for mounting cleat 30106 (FIG.
12Z). Undercap 30158 can include fastening accommodation 30158-4 that can enable fastening
of undercap 30158 to toggle housing 30157. Undercap 30158 can include relief cuts
30158-3 for toggle module fasteners. Undercap 30158 can accommodate gasket 130A that
can environmentally seal undercap 30158 to toggle housing 30157.
[0127] Referring now to FIGs. 12V-12X, second configuration undercap 30158-1 can include,
but is not limited to including, EMI suppression ferrite 70041, and ferrite retainer
30174. Ferrite retainer 30174 can operably couple with second configuration undercap
30158-1 through mounting features 30158-3 (FIG. 12X) and posts 30158-2 (FIG. 12X).
Retainer 30174 can be affixed to undercap 30158 by heat-staking posts 30158-2 (FIG.
12X). In some configurations, ferrite retainer 30174 can be affixed to undercap 30158
by means of threaded fasteners, adhesives, and/or snap features. In some configurations,
when cable 60031 is threaded through ferrite retainer 30174, EMI suppression ferrite
70041 can protect UC 130 from EMI emissions emanating from cable 60031, which can
house power and CANbus connections for UC 130. Shield 60031-4 can emerge from cable
60031 and can connect to a feature of housing 30152 at connector 60031-3. Metal barrel
60031-1 can enable the shield to continue to the powerbase.
[0128] Referring now to FIG. 12C, UC mounting device 16074 can enable UC 130 (FIG. 12A)
to be mounted securely to the MD by means of any device that can accommodate stem
16160A, stem split mate 16164, and a conventional seat mounted upon the MD through
operable coupling with seat brackets 24001 (FIG. 1A). Tightening orifice 162-672 can
provide a means to secure mounting device 16074 to the MD. Mounting device 16074 can
include ribs 16177 that can be raised away from mounting body 16160 to accommodate
UC mounting feature 30158 (FIG. 12B). UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can operably couple with mounting
device 16074 by sliding mounting cleat 30106 (FIG. 12Z) between ribs 16177 and mounting
body 16160. Release lever 16161 can operate in conjunction with spring-loaded release
knob 16162 to enable secure fastening and easy release of UC 130 to/from mounting
device 16074.
[0129] Referring now to FIG. 12Z, mounting cleat 30106 can enable mounting of UC 130 (FIG.
12A) onto the MD, for example, on an armrest, for example, by mounting device 16074
(FIG. 12Y). Mounting cleat 30106 can include engagement lip 30106-3 that can include
a geometry that can enable sliding and locking engagement of mounting cleat 30106
with a receiver, for example, by depressing a latch button until UC 130 (FIG. 12A)
is correctly positioned. At that position, the latch button could protrude into button
cavity 30106-1, thereby locking UC 130 (FIG. 12A) into place. Edges 30106-4 of mounting
cleat 30106 can fit within the receiver. Mounting cleat 30106 can include fastening
cavities for fastening mounting cleat 30106 to mounting cleat face 30158-5 (FIG. 14A).
[0130] Referring now to FIG. 12AA, grommet 40028-1 can provide an environmental seal surrounding
cable 60031 (FIG. 12X). Grommet 40028-1 can rest in grommet cavity 30158-2 (FIG. 12U),
neck 40028-1B being captured by the geometry of grommet cavity 30158-2 (FIG. 12U).
Cable 60031 (FIG. 12X) can traverse grommet 40028-1 from cable entry 40028-1A to cable
exit 40028-1C. In some configurations, cable grommet 40028-1 can provide strain relief
to cable 60031 (FIG. 12X). The strain relief can prevent damage if cable 60026 is
bent or pulled. In some configurations, cable grommet 40028-1 can be an overmolded
feature integral to cable 60031 (FIG. 12X).
[0131] Referring now to FIGs. 12BB and 12CC, button assembly 50020-A can enable button option
entry at UC 130 (FIG. 12A). Button assembly 50020-A can include buttons 50020-A1,
for example, but not limited to, momentary push buttons that can be mounted on button
circuit board 50020-A9. Buttons 50020-A1 can operably couple with button circuit board
50020-A9 that can include cable connector 50020-A2 that can accommodate, for example,
but not limited to, a flexible cable. Button assembly 50020-A can include spacer plate
50020-S (FIG. 12CC) that can provide cavities 50020-S1 (FIG. 12CC) for buttons 50020-A1.
A coverlay (not shown) providing graphics and environmental sealing can cover buttons
50020-A1.
[0132] Referring now to FIGs. 12DD and 12EE, toggle platform 70036 can include toggle lever
70036-2 (FIG. 12T) and toggle switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12T), and toggle mount means 70036-3
to mount toggle platform 70036 onto toggle housing second configuration 30157A. Toggle
mount means 70036-3 can be adjacent to toggle lever support geometry 30157A-2 (FIG.
12U). In some configurations, a low-profile toggle module 70036A (FIG. 12GG) including
D-pad 70036A-2 (FIG. 12EE) in place of toggle lever 70036-2 (FIG. 12DD) and rocker
switch 70036A-1 (FIG. 12EE) in place of toggle switch 70036-1 (FIG. 12DD) can be included.
In some configurations, toggle lever 70036-2 (FIG. 12DD) can be replaced by two 2-way
toggles (not shown), which could be similar to the controls for powered seating tilt
and recline. The resulting module can include three 2-way toggles.
[0133] Referring now primarily to FIG. 13A, UC holder 133A can house manual and visual interfaces
such as, for example, a joystick, a display, and associated electronics. In some configurations,
UC assist holder 145A can be attached to visual/manual interface holder 145C tool-lessly.
UC assist holder 145A can include electronics that can interface with processors 100
(FIG. 16B) and that can process data from sensors 122A (FIG. 8), 122B (FIG. 8), 122C
(FIG. 8), 122D (FIG. 8), 122E (FIG. 8), and 122F (FIG. 8). Any of these sensors can
include, but are not limited to including, an OPT8241 time-of-flight sensor from TEXAS
INSTRUMENTS
®, or any device that can provide a three-dimensional location of the data sensed by
the sensors. UC assist holder 145A can be located anywhere on the MD and may not be
limited to being mounted on visual/manual interface holder 145C.
[0134] Referring now primarily to FIG. 13B, manual/visual interface holder 145C can include,
but is not limited to including, visual interface viewing window 137A and manual interface
mounting cavity 133B available on first side 133E of manual/visual interface holder
145C. Connector 133C can be provided on second side 133D of manual/visual interface
holder 145C to connect manual/visual interface holder 145C to UC assist holder 145A
(FIG. 13C). Any of viewing window 137A, manual interface mounting cavity 133B, and
connector 133C can be located on any part of manual/visual interface holder 145C,
or can be absent altogether. Manual/visual interface holder 145C, visual interface
viewing window 137A (FIG. 13B), manual interface mounting cavity 133B, and connector
133C can be any size. Manual/visual interface holder 145C can be constructed of any
material suitable for mounting visual interface viewing window 137A, manual interface
mounting cavity 133B, and connector 133C. Angle 145M can be associated with various
orientations of UC holder 133A and thus can be various values. UC holder 133A can
have a fixed orientation or can be hinged.
[0135] Referring now primarily to FIG. 13C, UC assist holder 145A can include, but is not
limited to including, filter cavity 136G and lens cavity 136F providing visibility
to, for example, but not limited to, a time-of-flight sensor optical filter and lens
such as, for example, but not limited to, OPT8241 3D time-of-flight sensor by TEXAS
INSTRUMENTS
®. UC assist holder 145A can be any shape and size and can be constructed of any material,
depending on the mounting position on the MD and the sensors, processors, and power
supply, for example, provided within UC assist holder 145A. Rounded edges on cavities
136G and 136F as well as holder 145A can be replaced by any shape of edge.
[0136] Referring now to FIGs. 14A-14C, UC board 50004 can provide the electronics and connectors
to control the activities of UC 130 (FIG. 12A). UC board 50004 can include circuit
board 50004-9 upon which connectors and ICs can be mounted. For example, joystick
connector 50004-8, power and communications connector 50004-7, toggles connector 50004-5,
thumbwheel connector 50004-4, speaker connector 50004-6, and display connector 50004-2
can be included on mounting board 50004-9. In some configurations, UC board 50004
can include ambient light sensor 50004-X (FIG. 14A), the signal from which can be
used to vary the display brightness and contrast for viewing in indoor and outdoor
environments. EMC shield 50004-3 can provide EMC protection to UC board 50004. Connections
50004-1 to wireless antenna 50025 (FIG. 12H) can include, for example, but not limited
to, spring contacts. Button snap domes 50004-10, for example, can accommodate button
depression activation. In some configurations, button snap domes 50004-10 can each
be associated with back-lighting from, for example, but not limited to, LEDs. Toggle
switches and toggle levers can be accommodated similarly. UC board 50004 can process
data transmitted to and from the user, PBC board 50001 (FIGs. 15A and 15B), PSC board
50002 (FIGs. 15G), and a wireless antenna. UC board 50004 can perform filtering of
incoming data, and can enable the transitions and workflow described in FIGs. 23A-23KK.
UC board 50004 can include, but is not limited to including, a wireless transceiver
that can include a processor and transceiver that can support wireless communications
using, for example, but not limited to, the BLUETOOTH
® low energy protocol. The wireless transceiver can include, for example, but not limited
to, a Nordic Semiconductor nRF51422 chip.
[0137] Referring now to FIGs. 15A and 15B, central gearbox 21514 can include PSC board 50002
and PBC stack. The electronics of PSC board 50002 can manage power and provide power
to PBC board 50001, and PBC board 50001 in turn provides power to the motors of the
MD. PBC board 50001 can include redundant computers and electronics whose responsibilities
can include processing inertial sensor data and computing the motor commands used
to control the MD. Electronics for PBC board 50001 can interface with at least one
inertial measurement unit (IMU) 50003 (FIG. 15B) and UC 130 (FIG. 12A). PBC board
50001 can include redundant processors that can be physically separated from each
other and can have isolation barriers on their interconnections to increase the robustness
of the redundant architecture. Active redundancy can enable conflict resolution during
a fault condition through voting on actuator commands and other vital data. In some
configurations, sensors, powerbase processors and power buses can be physically replicated
in the MD. Sensor inputs, processor outputs, and motor commands from this redundant
architecture can be cross-monitored and compared to determine if all the signals are
within an acceptable tolerance. During normal operation all signals "agree" (are within
an acceptable tolerance) and the full functionality of the MD is available to the
user. If any one set of these signals is not within a range of the other three, the
MD can ignore data from the non-matching set and can continue to operate using data
from the remaining sensor/processor strings. Upon loss of redundancy, a fault condition
can be identified and the user can be alerted, for example, via visual and audible
signals. For redundancy, each of the PBC and the PSC can include an "A" side and a
"B" side. The PBC "A" side can be divided into "A1" and "A2" quadrants that can be
powered by the PSC "A" side. The PBC "B" side can be divided into "B1" and "B2" quadrants
that can be powered by the PSC "B" side. The IMU can include, for example, four inertial
sensors that can each map directly to one of the PBC quadrants.
[0138] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 15A and 15B, load sharing redundancy can be used for
the power amplifiers, high voltage power buses and primary actuators in order to size
the motors and batteries for normal, no-fault conditions and yet allow higher stress
short duration operation during a system fault. Load sharing redundancy can allow
for a lighter weight, higher performance fault tolerant system than other redundancy
approaches. The MD can include multiple separate battery packs 70001 (FIG. 1E). Multiple
battery packs 70001 (FIG. 1E) dedicated to each PBC side can provide redundancy so
that battery failure conditions can be mitigated. The redundant load sharing components
can be kept separate throughout the system to minimize the chance of a failure on
one side causing a cascading failure on the other side. The power delivery components
(battery packs 70001 (FIG. 1E), wiring, motor drive circuitry, and motors) can be
sized to deliver sufficient power to keep the user safe while meeting the system performance
requirements.
[0139] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 15A and 15B, the MD electronics and motors generate
heat that can be dissipated to prevent overheating of the MD. In some configurations,
components of PBC board 50001 can operate over a -25°C to +80° C temperature range.
Heat spreader 30050 can include heat spreader plate 30050 and at least one standoff
30052 (FIG. 15B) that can penetrate holes in powerbase controller board 50001 and
support inertial measure unit (IMU) assembly 50003 (FIG. 15D). Heat spreader plate
30051 can, for example, be operably connected to the central housings and the circuit
boards of the MD through a thin electrically-isolating material that can provide a
thermal conduction path for the heat from the electronics to the central housing.
In some configurations, metal-to-metal contact between heat spreader 30050 and the
mounting features on housings 30020-30023 can dissipate heat. Along with standoff
grommets 30187 (FIG. 15C), standoffs 30052 (FIG. 15B) can isolate the IMU assembly
from vibrations of powerbase controller board 50001 and heat spreader 30050. The vibrations
can result from vibrations throughout the powerbase. The heat management system of
the present teachings can include bars 30114 (FIG. 15B) mounted on heat spreader 30050
but not touching PBC board 50001, copper areas on PBC board 50001, and thermal gap
pads providing heat conductivity between PBC board 50001 and heat spreader 30050.
[0140] Referring now to FIG. 15B, IMU mounting onto heat spreader 30050 can include soft-durometer
grommets 30187 (FIG. 15C) that can dampen vibrations, and flex cable 50028-9B (FIG.
15C) that can provide electrical connection to PBC board 50001. IMU sensors can be
isolated from vibrations generated by the seat, cluster, and wheel drive trains of
the MD by mechanically isolating the IMU PCB 50003 (FIG. 15E) that sensors 608 (FIG.
15E) are mounted to. The IMU assembly can be mounted on at least one elastomeric grommet
30187 (FIG. 15C) that can attach to at least one post 30052 fastened to heat spreader
plate 30050. At least one grommet 30187 (FIG. 15C) can include a low hardness and
damping ability that can limit the transmission of vibration from the MD to the IMU.
Flex circuit cable 50028-9B can be compliant and may not transmit significant vibration
to the IMU assembly.
[0141] Continuing to refer to FIG. 15B, flux shield 30008 can protect the electronics on
PBC board 50001 from the magnetic signal from manual brake release position sensor
70020 (FIG. 9J). Flux shield 30008 can include ferrous metal, and can operably couple
with heat spreader assembly 30050 between manual brake release position sensor 70020
(FIG. 9J) and PBC board 50001. The ferrous metal can intercept and redirect the magnetic
flux of manual brake release position sensor 70020 (FIG. 9J) to substantially prevent
interference with the electronics of PBC board 50001. To possibly increase the overall
reliability of the MD, cables can utilize connectors that have a latching mechanism.
[0142] Referring now to FIGs. 15C-15D, IMU assembly 50003 can include, but is not limited
to including, main board 50003B (FIG. 15D) that can include inertial sensors 608 (FIG.
15D) and memory 610 (FIG. 15D). IMU assembly 50003 can include at least one grommet
30187 (FIG. 15C) that can buffer vibrations and maintain stability of inertial sensors
608, and rigid-flex circuit 50028-9B that can connect IMU assembly 50003 to PBC board
50001 (FIG. 15B) in a way that reduces vibration transmission. Rigid-flex circuit
50028-9B can include stiffener 50028-9S that can facilitate a sturdy connection. Rigid-flex
circuit 50028-9B can include a bend that can divide rigid-flex circuit cable 50028-9B
into two portions that can provide a sensor interface and a connector interface. At
least one grommet 30187 (FIG. 15C) can extend through main board 50003 (FIG. 15B)
at cavities 608A (FIG. 15D), and through similar cavities in optional IMU shield 70015
(FIG. 15C) and PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15B), and can operably couple with stand-offs
30052 (FIG. 15B). Other geometries of rigid-flex circuit cable 50028-9B (FIG. 15C)
are possible, as are other connector patterns and grommet placement.
[0143] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 15C-15D, at least one inertial sensor 608 can include,
for example, but not limited to, ST Microelectronics LSM330DLC IMU. IMU assembly 50003
can include IMU PCB 50003B that can accommodate stand-offs 30052 (FIG. 15B) to enable
elevating and shock-mounting IMU PCB 50003B above PBC board 50001. IMU assembly 50003
can include features to enable mounting IMU shield 70015 (FIG. 15C) onto IMU PCB 50003B.
Optional IMU shield 70015 can protect inertial sensors 608 (FIG. 15D) from possible
interference, including, but not limited to EM interference, from PBC board 50001
(FIG. 15B) and/or PSC board 50002 (FIG. 15G). IMU PCB 50003B can include connectors
609 (FIG. 15F) that can receive/transmit signals from/to inertial sensors 608 to/from
PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15B). Inertial sensors 608 (FIG. 15D) can be mounted to IMU
PCB 50003B, that can allow IMU assembly 50003 to be calibrated separately from the
rest of the MD. IMU PCB 50003B can provide mounting for memory 610 (FIG. 15D) that
can hold, for example, calibration data. Non-volatile memory 610 (FIG. 15D) can include,
for example, but not limited to, Microchip 25AA320AT-I/MNY. Storage of the calibration
data can enable IMU assemblies 50003 from multiple systems to be calibrated in a single
batch and installed without any additional calibration. As sensor technology changes,
inertial sensor 608 (FIG. 15D) can be updated with the latest available sensors in
relative electronics design isolation because IMU assembly 50003 can be relatively
isolated from PBC board 50001. Inertial sensors 608 can be positioned angularly with
respect to each other. The angular positioning can improve the accuracy of data received
from inertial sensors 608. Inertial information, such as pitch angle or yaw rate,
that may lie entirely upon one sense axis of one inertial sensor 608 can be spread
across two sense axes of an angled inertial sensor. In some configurations, two inertial
sensors 608 can be positioned angled 45° from two other inertial sensors 608. In some
configurations, the angled inertial sensors 608 can alternate in placement with non-angled
inertial sensors 608.
[0144] Referring now to FIGs. 15E and 15F, second configuration IMU assembly 50003A can
include at least one inertial sensor 608. Second configuration IMU assembly 50003A
can include second configuration IMU PCB 50003A-1 that can accommodate stand-offs
30052 (FIG. 15B) to enable elevating and shock-mounting second configuration IMU PCB
50003A-1 above PBC board 50001. Second configuration IMU assembly 50003A can include
features to enable mounting IMU shield 70015 onto second configuration IMU PCB 50003A.
Optional IMU shield 70015 can protect inertial sensors 608 from possible interference,
including, but not limited to EM interference, from PBC board 50001 and/or PSC board
50002 (FIG. 15G). Second configuration IMU PCB 50003A can include connectors 609 (FIG.
15F) that can receive/transmit signals from/to inertial sensors 608 to/from PBC board
50001 (FIG. 15B). Inertial sensors 608 (FIG. 15E) can be mounted to second configuration
IMU PCB 50003A. Second configuration IMU PCB 50003A can provide mounting for memory
610 (FIG. 15E) that can hold, for example, calibration data.
[0145] Referring now primarily to FIGS. 15G and 15H, PSC board 50002 can include connectors
277 (FIG. 15G) that can enable batteries 70001 (FIG. 1E) to supply power to PSC board
50002. Connectors 277 can include, for example, contacts, and circuit board mounting
means, for example, but not limited to, MOLEX
® MLX 44068-0059. PSC board 50002 can include at least one microcontroller 401, and
can include at least one bumper 30054/30054A to buffer the interface between PSC board
50002 and e-box lid 21524 (FIG. 1G), and at least one spacer 30053 to maintain the
spacing between PSC board 50002 and PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15B). In some configurations,
spacer 30053, which can include, for example, metal, can be operably coupled with
PSC board 50002. In some configurations, spacer 30053 can be used as an electrical
connection to the chassis of the MD for EMC purposes. Spacer 30053 can provide durability
and robustness to the MD. PSC board 50002 can include charge input connector 1181,
UC connector 1179, auxiliary connector 1175A, at least one power interconnect to PBC
connector 1173, and CANbus-to-PBC connector 1179A, connected as shown in FIGs. 151
and 15J. PSC board 50002 can include at least one power switch 401C, at least one
battery charge circuit 1171/1173A, and at least one coin cell battery 1175ABC to power
at least one real-time clock 1178A (FIG. 15 J). PSC board 50002 is not limited to
the parts listed herein, but can include any integrated circuits and other parts that
could enable operation of the MD.
[0146] Referring now to FIGs. 15I-15J, PSC board 50002 can communicate with batteries 70001
(FIG. 151) that can provide power to UC 130 (FIG. 12A) and auxiliary devices through
for example, but not limited to, 15-V regulator 1175, UC connector 1179, 24-V regulator
1175XYZ, and auxiliary connector 1175A. PSC board 50002 can communicate with battery
management system 50015 (FIG. 1E) from which can be determined, for example, but not
limited to, battery capacity and temperature. PSC board 50002 can monitor the line
voltages from battery packs 70001 (FIG. 151), and can monitor whether, for example,
charger power supply cord 70002 (FIGs. 11A-11D) is plugged in. Batteries 70001 (FIG.
151) can provide power to at least one microcontroller 401 (FIG. 15J) through, for
example, but not limited to, regulator 1176 (FIG. 15J) such as, for example, but not
limited to, a 3.3-V regulator, and regulator 1177 (FIG. 15J), for example, but not
limited to, a 5-V regulator. PSC board 50002 provides power to the PBC board 50001
through board-to-board connectors 1173/1173A (FIG. 15J) such as, for example, but
not limited to, SAMTEC
® PES-02. At least one microcontroller 401 (FIG. 15J), for example, but not limited
to, Renaesas RX64M, can control the opening and closing of power switch 401C (FIG.
15J) between batteries 70001 (FIG. 151) and board-to-board connectors 1173/1173A (FIG.
15J) to PBC board 50001. At least one microcontroller 401 (FIG. 15J) can include memory
1178 (FIG. 15J), for example, but not limited to, ferroelectric non-volatile memory,
that can hold data after being powered off. PSC board 50002 can include a real-time
clock that can be used, for example, to time stamp usage data and event logs. The
real-time clock can be powered by batteries 70001 (FIG. 151) or, alternatively, by
lithium coin cell 1175ABC (FIG. 15J). Communications between at least one microcontroller
401 (FIG. 15J) and batteries 70001 (FIG. 151) can be enabled by an I2C bus and I2C
accelerator 1174 (FIG. 15J). Communications between at least one microcontroller 401
(FIG. 15J) and UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can be enabled by CANbus protocol through UC connector
1179 (FIGs. 15I/15G). Communications between at least one microcontroller 401 (FIG.
15G) and PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15B) can be enabled by CANbus protocol through connector
1179A. Sensors 401B (FIG. 15J) can be positioned throughout PSC board 50002 to determine
the actual level of the voltage and current being supplied to PBC board 50001, versus
the level of voltage reported by batteries 70001 (FIG. 151) and sensed by sensors
410A (FIG. 151). At least one sensor 410A (FIG. 151) can sense high acceleration events
such as, for example, but not limited to, hard impacts, vehicle crashes, and mishandling
in shipment. The high acceleration events can be logged, for example, and can be used
as part of service and warranty claims, and can provide usage statistics that can,
for example, provide data for quality improvement efforts. In some configurations,
at least one sensor 410A (FIG. 151) can reside on PSC board 50002, and can communicate
to a corresponding PSC processor 401 (FIG. 15J) via a small peripheral interface (SPI)
bus, for example.
[0147] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 15I-15J, power can flow from each battery pack 70001
(FIG. 151) through PSC board 50002, through PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15B), and out to
the motors. Battery packs 70001 (FIG. 151) may discharge at different rates for example,
because of internal impedance differences. Because they are ganged together electrically,
the A-side batteries have approximately the same voltage, and the B-side batteries
have approximately the same voltage, but there could be differences between the voltage
in the A-side batteries and the voltage in the B-side batteries. Bus voltage can be
monitored, and if necessary, the voltage of batteries 70001 on each side can be equalized
by sending a slightly larger command to the motor on the side that has a higher voltage
and a smaller command to the other side. Current limiting devices can be used throughout
the power distribution to prevent an over-current condition on one subsystem from
affecting the power delivery to another subsystem. Anomalies caused by marginal power
supply operation can be mitigated by 1) supply monitoring for critical analog circuits
and 2) power supply supervisory features for digital circuits.
[0148] Referring now to FIG. 16A, the MD can include, but is not limited to including, powerbase
21514A, communications means 53, power means 54, UC 130, and remote control device
140. Powerbase 21514A can communicate with UC 130 using communications means 53 using
a protocol such as, for example, but not limited to, the CANbus protocol. User controller
130 can communicate with remote control device 140 through, for example, but not limited
to, wireless technology 18 such as, for example, BLUETOOTH
® technology. In some configurations, powerbase 21514A can include redundancy as discussed
herein. In some configurations, communications means 53 and power means 54 can operate
inside powerbase 21514A and can be redundant therein. In some configurations, communications
means 53 can provide communications from powerbase 21514A to components external to
powerbase 21514A.
[0149] Referring now primarily to FIG. 16B, in some configurations, MD control system 200A
can include, but is not limited to including, at least one powerbase processor 100
and at least one power source controller 11 that can bi-directionally communicate
over serial bus 143 using system serial bus messaging system 130F. System serial bus
messaging 130F can enable bi-directional communications among external applications
140 and I/O interface 130G, and UC 130. The MD can access peripherals, processors,
and controllers through interface modules that can include, but are not limited to
including, input/output (I/O) interface 130G and external communications interface
130D. In some configurations, I/O interface 130G can transmit/receive messages to/from,
for example, but not limited to, at least one of audio interface 150A, electronic
interface 149A, manual interface 153A, and visual interface 151A . Audio interface
150A can provide information to audio devices such as, for example, speakers that
can project, for example, alerts when the MD requires attention. Electronic interface
149A can transmit/receive messages to/from, for example, but not limited to, external
sensors 147. External sensors 147 can include, but are not limited to including, time-of-flight
cameras and other sensors. Manual interface 153A can transmit/receive messages to/from,
for example, but not limited to, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) and/or switches 70036-1/2
(FIG. 12V) and buttons 70035 (FIG. 12H), and/or information lighting such as LED lights,
and/or UC 130 (FIG. 12A) having, for example, a touch screen. UC 130 and processors
100 can transmit/receive information to/from I/O interface 130G, external communications
130D, and each other.
[0150] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 16B, system serial bus interface 130F can enable
communications among UC 130, processors 100 (also shown, for example, as processor
A1 43A (FIG. 18C), processor A2 43B (FIG. 18C), processor B1 43C (FIG. 18D), and processor
B2 43D (FIG. 18D)), and power source controllers 11 (also shown, for example, as power
source controller A 98 (FIG. 18B) and power source controller B 99 (FIG. 18B)). Messages
described herein can be exchanged among UC 130 and processors 100 using, for example,
but not limited to, system serial bus 143. External communications interface 130D
can enable communications among, for example, UC 130 and external applications 140
using wireless communications 144 such as, for example, but not limited to, BLUETOOTH
® technology. UC 130 and processors 100 can transmit/receive messages to/from external
sensors 147 that can be used to enable automatic and/or semi-automatic control of
the MD.
[0151] Referring now primarily to FIG. 17A, powerbase controller 50001 (FIG. 15B) can include
powerbase processor 100 that can process incoming motor data 775 and sensor data 767
upon which wheel commands 769, cluster commands 771, and seat commands 773 can be
at least in part based. To perform the data processing, powerbase processor 100 can
include, but is not limited to including, CANbus controller 311 managing communications,
motor drive control processor 305 preparing motor commands, timer interrupt service
request processor 301 managing timing, voting/commit processor 329 managing the redundant
data, main loop processor 321 managing various data inputs and outputs, and controller
processing task 325 receiving and processing incoming data. Controller processing
task 325 can include, but is not limited to including, IMU filter 753 managing IMU
data preparation, speed-limiting processor 755 managing speed-related features, weight
processor 757 managing weight-related features, adaptive speed control processor 759
managing obstacle avoidance, traction control processor 762 managing challenging terrain,
and active stabilization processor 763 managing stability features. Inertial sensor
pack 1070/23/29/35 can provide IMU data 767 to IMU filter 753 which can provide data
that can result in wheel commands 769 to right wheel motor drive 19/31 and left wheel
motor drive 21/33. IMU filter 753 can include, but is not limited to including, body
rate to gravity rate and projected rate processor 1102 (FIG. 19A), body rate and gravity
to Euler angles and rates processor 1103 (FIG. 19A), and gravity rate error and projected
yaw rate error to body rates processor 1103 (FIG. 19A). Seat motor 45/47 can provide
motor data 775 to weight processor 757. Voting processor 329 can include, but is not
limited to including, initial vote processor 873, secondary vote processor 871, and
tertiary vote processor 875.
[0152] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 17B and 17C, in some configurations, powerbase processors
100 can share, through, for example, CANbus 53A/B (FIG. 18B), as controlled by CANbus
controller task 311 (FIG. 17B), accelerometer and gyro data from inertial sensor packs
1070/23/29/35 (FIG. 17A). Powerbase serial buses 53A/B (FIG. 18B) can communicatively
couple processors A1/A2/B1/B2 43A-43D (FIG. 18C/18D) with other components of the
MD. CANbus controller 311 (FIG. 17B) can receive interrupts when CANbus messages arrive,
and can maintain current frame buffer 307 (FIG. 17B) and previous frame buffer 309
(FIG. 17B). When accelerometer and gyro data (sensor data 767 (FIG. 17A)) have arrived
from processors A1/A2/B1/B2 43A-43D (FIG. 18C/18D), CANbus controller 311 (FIG. 17B)
can send a start commits processing message 319 (FIG. 17B) to voting/commit processor
329 (FIG. 17C). Voting/commit processor 329 (FIG. 17C) can send a commit message 331
(FIG. 17C) that can include the results of the voting process, for example, but not
limited to, the voting processes of, for example, method 150 (FIGs. 21B/21C), applied
to motor data 775 (FIG. 17A) and IMU data 767 (FIG. 17A), and can send start controller
processing message 333 (FIG. 17C) to controller processing task 325 (FIG. 17C). Controller
processing task 325 (FIG. 17C) can compute estimates based at least on, for example,
received IMU data 767 (FIG. 17A) and motor data 775 (FIG. 17A), and can manage traction
(traction control processor 762 (FIG. 17A)), speed (speed processor 755 (FIG. 17A),
adaptive speed control processor 759 (FIG. 17A)), and stabilization (active stabilization
processor 763 (FIG. 17A)) of the MD based at least on the estimates, and can send
motor-related messages 335. If CANbus controller 311 (FIG. 17B) has not received messages
from processors A1/A2/B1/B2 43A-D (FIG. 18C/18D) within a timeout period, such as,
for example, but not limited to, 5 ms, timer interrupt service request processor 301
(FIG. 17B) can start commit backup timer 317 (FIG. 17B) that can, when the timer expires,
start commits processing by sending a starts commits processing message 319 (FIG.
17B) to commits processing task 329 (FIG. 17C). Timer interrupt service request processor
301 (FIG. 17B) can also send start main loop message 315 (FIG. 17B) to main loop processor
321 (FIG. 17B) and update motors message 303 (FIG. 17B) to motor drive control 305
(FIG. 17B) when a timer has elapsed, for example, every 5ms, and main loop processor
321 (FIG. 17B) can capture sensor data and data from user controller 130 (FIG. 16A).
Main loop processor 321 (FIG. 17B) can send a synchronization message 313 (FIG. 17B)
over CANbus 53A/B (FIG. 18B), if main loop processor 321 (FIG. 17B) is executing on
a master of processors A1/A2/B1/B2 43A-D (FIG. 18C/18D). Main loop processor 321 (FIG.
17B) can track timed activities across powerbase processor 21514A (FIG. 16A), can
start other processes, and can enable communications through powerbase output packet
323 (FIG. 17B).
[0153] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 18A-18D, PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15G) can include,
but is not limited to including, at least one processor 43A-43D (FIGs. 18C/18D), at
least one motor drive processor 1050, 19, 21, 25, 27, 31, 33, 37 (FIGs. 18C/18D),
and at least one power source controller (PSC) processor 11A/B (FIG. 18B). PBC board
50001 (FIG. 15G) can be operably coupled with, for example, but not limited to, UC
130 (FIG. 18A) through, for example, but not limited to, electronic communications
means 53C and a protocol such as, for example, a CANbus protocol, and PBC board 50001
(FIG. 15G) can be operably coupled with at least one IMU and inertial system processor
1070, 23, 29, 35 (FIGs. 18C/18D). UC 130 (FIG. 18A) can be optionally operatively
coupled with electronic devices such as, for example, but not limited to, computers
such as tablets and personal computers, telephones, and lighting systems. UC 130 (FIG.
18A) can include, but is not limited to including, at least one joystick and at least
one display. UC 130 (FIG. 18A) can include push buttons and toggles. UC 130 (FIG.
18A) can optionally be communicatively coupled with peripheral control module 1144
(FIG. 18A), sensor aid modules 1141 (FIG. 18A), and autonomous control modules 1142/1143
(FIG. 18A). Communications can be enabled by, for example, but not limited to, a CANbus
protocol and an Ethernet protocol 271 (FIG. 18A).
[0154] Continuing to refer primarily to FIGs. 18A-18D, processors 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D)
can control the commands to wheel motor processors 85/87/91/93 (FIGs. 18C/18D), cluster
motor processors 1050/27 (FIGs. 18C/18D) and seat motor processors 45/47 (FIGs. 18C/18D).
Processors 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D) can receive joystick, seat height and frame lean
commands from UC 130 (FIG. 12A). Software that can enable UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can perform
user interface processing including display processing, and can communicate with the
external product interface. Software that can enable PSC 11A/B (FIG. 18B) can retrieve
information from batteries 70001 (FIG. 1E) over a bus such as, for example, but not
limited to, an I2C bus or an SMBus, and can send that information on CANbus 53A/53B
(FIG. 18B) for UC 130 (FIG. 12A) to interpret. Boot code software executing on processors
39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D) can initialize the system and can provide the ability to update
application software. External applications can execute on a processor such as, for
example, but not limited to, a personal computer, cell phone, and mainframe computer.
External applications can communicate with the MD to support, for example, configuration
and development. For example, a product interface is an external application that
can be used by, for example, service, manufacturing, and clinicians, to configure
and service the MD. An engineering interface is an external application that can be
used by, for example, manufacturing, to communicate with UC 130 (FIG. 12A), processors
39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D), and PSCs 11A/B (FIG. 18B) when commissioning the MD. A software
installer is an external application that can be used by, for example, manufacturing
and service, to install software onto UC 130 (FIG. 12A), processors 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D),
and PSCs 11A/B (FIG. 18B).
[0155] Continuing to refer primarily to FIGs. 18C-18D, in some configurations, each at least
one processor 43A-43D (FIGs. 18C/18D) can include, but is not limited to including,
at least one cluster motor drive processor 1050, 27 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one
right wheel motor drive processor 19, 31 (FIG. 18C), at least one left wheel motor
drive processor 21, 33 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one seat motor drive processor 25,
37 (FIGs. 18C/18D), and at least one inertial sensor pack processor 1070, 23, 29,
35 (FIGs. 18C/18D). At least one processor 43A-43D can further include at least one
cluster brake processor 57/69 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one cluster motor processor
83/89 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one right wheel brake processor 59/73 (FIGs. 18C/18D),
at least one left wheel brake processor 63/77 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one right
wheel motor processor 85/91 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one left wheel motor processor
87/93 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one seat motor processor 45/47 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at
least one seat brake processor 65/79 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one cluster position
sensor processor 55/71 (FIGs. 18C/18D), and at least one manual brake release processor
61/75 (FIGs. 18C/18D). Processors 43A-43D can be used to drive cluster assembly 21100
(FIG. 6A) of wheels forming a ground-contacting module. The ground-contacting module
can be mounted on cluster assembly 21100 (FIG. 6A), and each wheel of the ground-contacting
module can be driven by a wheel motor drive commanded by right wheel motor drive processor
A 19 (FIG. 18C), or redundant right wheel motor drive processor B 31 (FIG. 18D). Cluster
assembly 21100 (FIG. 6A) can rotate about a cluster axis, the rotation being governed
by, for example, cluster motor drive processor A 1050 (FIG. 18C), or redundant cluster
motor drive processor B 27 (FIG. 18D). At least one of the sensor processors such
as, for example, but not limited to, at least one cluster position sensor processor
55/71 (FIGs. 18C/18D), at least one manual brake release sensor processor 61/75 (FIGs.
18C/18D), at least one motor current sensor processors (not shown), and at least one
inertial sensor pack processor 17, 23, 29, 35 (FIGs. 18C/18D) can process data transmitted
from sensors residing on the MD. Processors 43A-43D (FIGs. 18C/18D) can be operably
coupled to UC 130 (FIG. 18A) for receiving user input. Communications 53A-53C (FIG.
18B) among UC 130 (FIG. 18A), PSCs 11A/11B (FIG. 18B), and processors 43A-43D (FIGs.
18C/18D) can be according to any protocol including, but not limited to, a CANbus
protocol. At least one Vbus 95/97 (FIG. 18B) can operably couple at least one PSC
11A/B (FIG. 18B) to processors 43A-43D (FIGs. 18C/18D) and components external to
PBC board 50001 (FIG. 15G) through external Vbus 107 (FIG. 18B). In some configurations,
processor A1 43A (FIG. 18C) can be the master of CANbus A 53A (FIG. 18B). Slaves on
CANbus A 53A (FIG. 18B) can be processor A2 43B (FIG. 18C), processor B1 43C (FIG.
18D), and processor B2 43D (FIG. 18D). In some configurations, processor B1 43C (FIG.
18D) can be the master of CANbus B 53B (FIG. 18B). Slaves on CANbus B 53B (FIG. 18B)
can be processor B2 43C (FIG. 18D), processor A1 43A (FIG. 18C), and processor A2
43B (FIG. 18C). In some configurations, UC 130 (FIG. 18A) can be the master of CANbus
C 53C (FIG. 18B). Slaves on CANbus C 53C (FIG. 18B) can be PSCs 11A/B (FIG. 18B),
and processors A1/A2/B1/B2 43A/B/C/D (FIGs. 18C/18D). The master node (any of processors
43A-43D (FIGs. 18C/18D) or UC 130 (FIG. 18A)) can send data to or request data from
the slaves.
[0156] Referring primarily to FIGs. 18C/18D, in some configurations, powerbase controller
board 50001 (FIG. 15G) can include redundant processor sets A/B 39/41 that can control
cluster 21100 (FIG. 6A) and rotating drive wheels 21201 (FIG. 7B). Right/left wheel
motor drive processors A/B 19/21, 31/33 can drive right/left wheel motors A/B 85/87/91/93
that drive wheels 21201 (FIG. 7B) on the right and left sides of the MD. Wheels 21201
(FIG. 7B) can be coupled to drive together. Turning can be accomplished by driving
left wheel motor processors A/B 87/93 and right wheel motor processors A/B 85/91 at
different rates. Cluster motor drive processor A/B 1050/27 can drive cluster motor
processors A/B 83/89 that can rotate the wheel base in the fore/aft direction which
can allow the MD to remain level while front wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) are higher or
lower than rear wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A). Cluster motor processors A/B 83/89 can keep
the MD level when climbing up and down curbs, and can rotate the wheel base repeatedly
to climb up and down stairs. Seat motor drive processor A/B 25/37 can drive seat motor
processors A/B 45/47 that can raise and lower a seat (not shown).
[0157] Continuing to further refer to FIGs. 18C/18D, cluster position sensor processors
A/B 55/71 can receive data from cluster position sensor that can indicate the position
of cluster 21100 (FIG. 3). The data from the cluster position sensors and seat position
sensors can be communicated among processors 43A-43D and can be used by processor
set A/B 39/41 to determine information to be sent to, for example, right wheel motor
drive processor A/B 19/31, cluster motor drive processor A/B 15/27, and seat motor
drive processor A/B 25/37. The independent control of clusters 21100 (FIG. 3) and
drive wheels 21201 (FIG. 7B) can allow the MD to operate in several modes, thereby
allowing the user or processors 43A-43D to switch between modes, for example, in response
to the local terrain.
[0158] Continuing to still further refer to FIGs. 18C/18D, inertial sensor pack processors
1070, 23, 29, 35 can receive data that can indicate, for example, but not limited
to, the orientation of the MD. Each inertial sensor pack processor 1070, 23, 29, 35,
can process data from, for example, but not limited to, accelerometers and gyroscopes.
In some configurations, each inertial sensor pack processor 1070, 23, 29, 35 can process
information from four sets of three-axis accelerometers and three-axis gyros. The
accelerometer and gyro data can be fused, and a gravity vector can be produced that
can be used to compute the orientation and inertial rotation rates of the MD. The
fused data can be shared across processors 43A-43D and can be subjected to threshold
criteria. The threshold criteria can be used to improve the accuracy of device orientation
and inertial rotation rates. For example, fused data from certain of processors 43A-43D
that exceed certain thresholds can be discarded. The fused data from each of processors
43A-43D that are within pre-selected limits can be, for example, but not limited to,
averaged or processed in any other form. Inertial sensor pack processors 1070, 23,
29, 35 can process data from sensors such as, for example, ST
®microelectronics LSM330DLC, or any sensor supplying a 3D digital accelerometer and
a 3D digital gyroscope, or further, any sensor that can measure gravity and body rates.
Sensor data can be subject to processing, for example, but not limited to, filtering
to improve control of the MD. Cluster position sensor processors A/B 55/71, seat position
sensor processors A/B 67/81, and manual brake release sensor processors A/B 61/75
can process, but are not limited to processing, Hall sensor data. Processors 39/41
can manage the storage of information specific to a user.
[0159] Referring now primarily to FIG. 19A, at least one inertial sensor pack processor
17, 23, 29, 35 (FIGs. 18C/18D) can process sensor information from IMU 608 (FIG. 15D)
through to IMU filter 9753. A state estimator can estimate dynamic states of the MD
relative to an inertial coordinate system from the sensor information measured in
a body coordinate system, that is, relative to the coordinate system associated with
the MD. The estimation process can include relating the acceleration and rate measurements
as taken by IMU board 50003 (FIG. 15B) on the axis system in which they are mounted
(body coordinate systems) to the inertial coordinate system, to generate dynamic state
estimates. The dynamic states relating the body coordinate frame to the inertial coordinate
frame can be described with Euler angles and rates, which are computed from an estimate
of the earth's gravitational field vector. The gyroscopes can supply rate measurements
relative to their mounting reference frame. Pitch Euler angle 9147 and roll Euler
angle 9149 can be estimated as follows.
[0160] Mapping rates from the body coordinate frame of reference to the inertial coordinate
frame of reference can include evaluating the kinematic equation of the rotation of
a vector.

where
Ġ is the gravity rate vector,
Ĝf is the filtered gravity vector, and Ω
f is the body rate vector.
[0161] Integrated overtime,
Ġ provides a gravity vector estimate. The projected gravity rate estimate is as follows.

Where ,
γ̇ is the projected gravity rate.
[0162] Mapping inertial rates back to the body coordinate frame in order to integrate error
to compensate for gyro bias can be accomplished as follows:

where
Ġe is the gravity rate error and Ω
e is the body rate error, which is equivalent to:

where
Gfx-y-z are components of filtered gravity vector 9125,
ωex-y-z are components of filtered body rate error 9157, and
Ġex-y-z are components of filtered gravity rate error 9129. The projected gravity rate can
be computed as follows.

or

[0163] Coupled with the matrix above, this yields a matrix that can be viewed in the
Ax=
b format:

[0164] To solve for body rate error 9157, the pseudo-inverse for the 'A' matrix can be computed
as follows:

[0165] The transpose 'A' matrix multiplied with the 'A' matrix yields the following matrix:

[0166] Since filtered gravity vector 9125 is a unit vector, the above matrix simplifies
to a 3x3 identity matrix, whose inverse is a 3x3 identity matrix. Therefore, the pseudo-inverse
solution to the Ax=b problem reduces to

where
ψ̇e is the difference between the projected gravity rate 9119 and the wheel speed derived
from data received from the right/left wheel motors. The resulting matrix can be written
as the following identity:

[0167] Filtered gravity vector 9125 can be translated into Euler pitch 9147 and Euler roll
9149:
Euler angles:

[0168] Filtered body rates can be translated into Euler pitch rate 9153 and Euler roll rate
9155:
Pitch rate:

Roll rate:

Yaw rate:

[0169] Continuing to refer to FIG. 19A, IMU filter 9753 can filter gravity vector 9125 which
can represent the inertial z-axis. IMU filter 9753 can provide a two-dimensional inertial
reference in three-dimensional space. Measured body rates 9113 (measured, for example,
from gyros that can be part of the inertial sensor packs, filtered gravity vector
9127 computed based on accelerometer data, and differential wheel speed 9139 (that
can be computed from data received from the right/left wheel motor drives of left
and right wheels 21201 (FIG. 1A) can be inputs to IMU filter 9753. IMU filter 9753
can compute pitch 9147, roll 9149, yaw rate 9151, pitch rate 9153, and roll rate 9155,
for example, to be used to compute wheel commands 769 (FIG. 21A). Filtered output
(G) and measured input (G
meas) are compared to produce an error, along with the comparison of gravity projected
rate and differential wheel speed. There errors are fed back to the rate measurements
to compensate for rate sensor bias. Filtered gravity vector 9125 and filtered body
rates 9115 can be used to compute pitch 9147, roll 9149, yaw rate 9151, pitch rate
9153, and roll rate 9155.
[0170] Referring now to FIG. 19B, method 9250 for processing data using IMU filter 9753
(FIG. 19A) can include, but is not limited to including, subtracting 9251 gyro bias
from gyro readings to remove the offset. Method 9250 can further include computing
9255 gravity rate vector 9143 (FIG. 19A) and projected gravity rate estimate 9119
(FIG. 19A) based at least on filtered body rates 9115 (FIG. 19A) and filtered gravity
vector 9125 (FIG. 19A). Method 9250 can still further include subtracting 9257 the
product of gain K1 and gravity vector error from gravity rate vector 9117 (FIG. 19A)
and integrating 9259 filtered gravity rate 9143 (FIG. 19A) over time to produce filtered
gravity vector 9125 (FIG. 19A). Gravity vector error 9129 (FIG. 19A) can be based
at least on filtered gravity vector 9125 (FIG. 19A) and measured gravity vector 9127
(FIG. 19A). Method 9250 can further include computing 9261 pitch rate 9153 (FIG. 19A),
roll rate 9155 (FIG. 19A), yaw rate 9151 (FIG. 19A), pitch, and roll based on filtered
gravity rate vector 9125 (FIG. 19A) and filtered body rates 9115 (FIG. 19A). Gyro
bias 9141 (FIG. 19A) can be computed by subtracting differential wheel speed 9139
(FIG. 19A) between wheels 21201 (FIG. 1A) from projected gravity rate estimate 9119
(FIG. 19A) to produce projected rate error 9137 (FIG. 19A). Further, the cross product
of gravity vector error 9129 (FIG. 19A) and filtered gravity vector 9125 (FIG. 19A)
can be computed and added to the dot product of filtered gravity vector 9125 (FIG.
19A) and projected gravity rate estimate error 9137 (FIG. 19A) to produce body rate
error 9157 (FIG. 19A). Method 9250 can include computing gyro bias 9141 (FIG. 19A)
based on applying gain K2 9133 (FIG. 19A) to the integration 9135 (FIG. 19A) overtime
of body rate error 9157 (FIG. 19A) to produce the gyro bias that is subtracted in
step 9251. Equations describing method 9250 follow.

where
Ġm is the measured gravity rate vector,
Ĝf is the filtered gravity vector, and ω is the filtered body rate vector.

where
γ̇ is the projected rate.

where
γ̇e is the projected rate error and
Vdiff is the differential wheel speed.

where
Ġ is the filtered gravity rate,
Ġm is the measured gravity rate vector, K1 is a gain, and
Gerror is the gravity error vector.

where
Gm is the measured gravity vector from the accelerometer readings.

where
ω̇e is the body rate error vector and
Ġe is the gravity rate error vector.

where
ωe is the integrated body rate error vector and K2 9133 (FIG. 19A) is a gain.

where
ωm is the measured body rate vector

[0171] Referring to FIG. 20, field weakening can cause the motor to temporarily run faster
at times when needed, for example, when unexpected circumstances arise. The electrical
system equations of motion for a motor in a rotating reference frame are:

where
VdLN is direct voltage line to neutral
ωe is the electrical speed
LLN is the winding inductance line to neutral
Iq is the quadrature current
Id is the direct current
RLN is the line to neutral resistance
VqLN is the quadrature voltage line to neutral
KeLN is the back EMF line to neutral
wm is the mechanical speed
Under normal field-oriented control of a brushless motor drive, where Id is regulated to zero,

[0172] To implement field weakening in a field-oriented control scheme, the term
ωeLLNIq may be increased by giving the direct current controller a non-zero current command,
yielding a higher motor velocity and a diminished torque capability.
[0173] Continuing to refer to FIG. 20, field weakening in the rotating frame of reference
can be implemented as follows. In a conventional drive without field weakening, the
maximum command voltage is

, where
Vbus is bus voltage. As the quadrature command voltage increases, the motor drive voltage
controller increases the duty cycle to match the commanded input until the duty cycle
reaches its maximum and the back EMF voltage equals the command voltage. When direct
current is regulated to zero, under normal motor control conditions without field
weakening,

where
Vcommand is the commanded voltage from the powerbase.
[0174] Under field weakening conditions, the last term in equation (2) is non-zero yielding

[0175] When the quadrature voltage saturates at the bus, the direct axis current can be
commanded to a non-zero value to increase the motor speed to emulate a higher voltage
command to the motor as seen by the powerbase wheel speed controller. By isolating
the direct current component of equation (6), a direct current command may be computed:

[0176] The velocity controllers can effectively command higher velocities to the motors,
and the motors can behave as if they are receiving larger voltages.
[0177] Continuing to refer to FIG. 20, in some configurations, the addition of ~ 25 amps
of direct current can nearly double the maximum speed of certain motors, allowing
for relatively short bursts of relatively high speed when unexpected stabilization
is required, for example. Current and voltage command limits can be computed as follows:

[0178] The direct current controller can have priority when regulating the direct current,
leaving the leftover to the quadrature controller and reporting the subsequent limits
to processors A/B 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D).
[0179] Continuing to refer to FIG. 20, method 10160 for computing command voltage limits
and current limits can include, but is not limited to including, computing 10161 the
overall current limit
Ilim based on FET temperature, and computing the voltage limit
Vlim based on the measured bus voltage,

. Method 10160 can include setting 10163 the quad voltage controller current limit
based on the overall current limit and the commanded direct current from a previous
measurement. Method 10160 can further include computing 10165 the direct current command,
restricting the overall current limit
Ilim, and computing the commanded direct voltage
VdLNCommanded.. Method 10160 can include setting 10167 the quad voltage controller current limit
based on the overall voltage limit and the commanded direct voltage from the direct
current controller.
[0180] Continuing to refer to FIG. 20, in a conventional motor drive, voltage saturation
is reported when the voltage command from the current controller saturates at the
bus voltage limit
. When field weakening is used, the motor drive injects direct current to increase
motor speed when the quadrature voltage saturates. The direct current controller only
computes a direct current command when the commanded voltage has surpassed the capability
of the bus to command quadrature voltage. Otherwise, direct currents are regulated
to zero to maintain efficiency. Therefore, voltage saturation can be reported when
the direct current controller attempts to regulate the direct current command to a
maximum value, not when the quadrature voltage saturates at the bus voltage limit
like a conventional drive. In a conventional motor drive, current saturation is reported
when the current command from the voltage controller saturates at the maximum current,
for example, but not limited to, 35 amps, unless otherwise limited by heat. However,
the voltage controller's current command saturates when the maximum quadrature voltage
command reaches the bus limit. If this remained the same for field weakening, the
voltage controller would report a current saturation regardless of the actual quadrature
current. Therefore, if the quadrature voltage controller is issuing a maximum current
command and the quadrature current controller has not run out of voltage headroom,
then maximum current has been reached. If the quadrature current controller has run
out of voltage headroom, then the quadrature current controller is not capable of
generating maximum current, and the current limit has not been reached.
[0181] Referring now primarily to FIG. 21A, to enable failsafe operation, the MD can include,
but is not limited to including, redundant subsystems by which failures can be detected,
for example, by comparison of data associated with each subsystem to data associated
with the remaining subsystems. Failure detection in redundant subsystems can create
fail-operative functionality, wherein the MD can continue to operate on the basis
of the information provided by the remaining non-failing subsystems, if one subsystem
is found to be defective, until the MD can be brought to a safe mode without endangering
the user. If a failed subsystem is detected, the remaining subsystems can be required
to agree to within prescribed limits in order for operation to continue, and operation
can be terminated in case of disagreement between the remaining subsystems. Voting
processor 329 can include, but is not limited to including, at least one way to determine
which value to use from redundant subsystems, and in some configurations, voting processor
329 can manage different types of data in different ways, for example, but not limited
to, calculated command data and inertial measurement unit data.
[0182] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 21A, voting processor 329 can include, but
is not limited to including, initial vote processor 873, secondary vote processor
871, and tertiary vote processor 875. Initial vote processor 873 can include, but
is not limited to including, computer instructions to average sensor data 767 or command
data 767A, from each processor A1/A2/B1/B2 43A-43D (FIG. 18C/18D) (referred to herein
as processor values). Initial vote processor 873 can further include computer instructions
to compute the absolute value difference between each processor value and the average,
and discard the highest absolute value difference leaving three remaining processor
values. Secondary vote processor 871 can include, but is not limited to including,
computer instructions to compute differences between the remaining processor values
and each other, to compare the differences to a preselected threshold, to compare
the processor values that have the highest difference between them to the remaining
value, to vote out the processor value with the highest difference from the remaining
value, to compare the voted out values to the remaining values, to vote out any difference
above the pre-selected threshold, if any, and to select a remaining processor values
or an average of the processor values, depending, for example, on the type of data
the processor values represent. Tertiary vote processor 875 can include, but is not
limited to including, computer instructions to, if there are no differences greater
than the pre-selected threshold, compare the discarded value to the remaining values,
vote out the discarded value if there are any differences greater than the pre-selected
threshold, and select one of the remaining processor values or an average of the remaining
processor values depending, for example, on the type of data the processor values
represent. Tertiary vote processor 875 can also include computer instructions to,
if there are no differences greater than the pre-selected threshold, select a remaining
processor value or an average of the remaining processor values. It can be possible
that the discarded value is not voted out and all processor values remain to be selected
from or averaged. Tertiary vote processor 875 can still further include computer instructions
to, if a processor value is voted out a pre-selected number of times, raise an alarm,
and, if the voting scheme fails to find a processor value that satisfies the selection
criteria, increment the frame counter. Tertiary vote processor 875 can also include
computer instructions to, if the frame counter has not exceeded a pre-selected number
of frames, discard the frame containing the processor values in which the voting scheme
failed to find a processor value that satisfies the selection criteria, and to select
the last frame with at least one processor value that could be used. Tertiary vote
processor 875 can also include computer instructions, if the frame counter is greater
than a pre-selected number of frames, to move the MD to a failsafe mode.
[0183] Referring now to FIGs. 21B and 21C, method 150 for resolving which value to use from
redundant processors, referred to herein as "voting", can include, but is not limited
to including, initializing 149 a counter, averaging 151 values, for example, but not
limited to, sensor or command values, from each processor 43A-43D (FIG. 21A) (referred
to herein as processor values), computing 153 the absolute value difference between
each processor value and the average, and discarding the highest difference. Method
150 can further include computing 155 differences between the remaining processor
values and each other. If 157 there are any differences greater than a preselected
threshold, method 150 can include comparing 167 the values that have the highest difference
between them to the remaining value, voting out 169 the value with the highest difference
from the remaining value, comparing 171 the voted out values to the remaining values,
and voting out 173 any difference above the pre-selected threshold and selecting one
of the remaining processor values or an average of the processor values. For example,
if processor values from processors A1 43A (FIG. 21A), B1 43C (FIG. 21A), and B2 43D
(FIG. 21A) remain, the processor value (or an average of the processor values) from
any of the remaining processors can be chosen. If 157 there are no differences greater
than the pre-selected threshold, method 150 can compare 159 the voted out value to
the remaining values. If 161 there are any differences greater than the pre-selected
threshold, method 150 can include voting out 163 the value voted out in the compare
159 step, and selecting one of the remaining processor values or an average of the
remaining processor values. If 161 there are no differences greater than the pre-selected
threshold, method 150 can include selecting 165 one of the remaining processor values
or an average of the remaining processor values. If 185 a processor value is voted
out a pre-selected number of times, method 150 can include raising 187 an alarm. If
175 the voting scheme fails to find a processor value that satisfies the selection
criteria, method 150 can include incrementing 177 the counter. If 179 the counter
has not exceeded a pre-selected number, method 150 can include discarding the frame
having no remaining processor values and selecting 181 a previous frame having at
least one processor value that meets the selection criteria. If 179 the frame counter
is greater than the pre-selected number, method 150 can include moving 183 the MD
to a failsafe mode.
[0184] Referring now primarily to FIG. 21D, example1 519 of voting can include first computations
521 in which processor values for processors A1-B2 43A-43D (FIG. 21A) can be averaged
and can be compared to the computed average. The processor having the largest difference
from the average, in example1 519, processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A), can be discarded.
Processor values from processor B2 43D (FIG. 21A) could have instead been discarded.
Second computations 523 can include comparisons between the processor values of the
remaining three processors A2/B1/B2 43B-43D (FIG. 21A). Comparisons can be taken between
the discarded processor value of processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) and the processor values
of the three remaining processors A2/B1/B2 43B-43D (FIG. 21A). In example1 519, none
of the differences exceeds the exemplary threshold of fifteen. The voting result from
example1 519 is that any of the processor values from processors A1/A2/B1/B2 43A-43D
(FIG. 21A) can be selected.
[0185] Referring now primarily to FIG. 21E, example2 501 of voting can include first computations
507 in which processor values for processors A1-B2 43A-43D (FIG. 21A) can be averaged
and can be compared to the computed average. The processor having the largest difference
from the average, in example2 501, processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A), is discarded. Second
computations 509 can include comparisons between processor values of the remaining
three processors A2/B1/B2 43B-43D (FIG. 21A). In example2 501, none of the differences
exceeds the exemplary threshold of fifteen. Comparisons can be taken between the processor
value of discarded processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) and the processor values of the three
of remaining processors A2/B1/B2 43B-43D (FIG. 21A). In example2 501, one of the differences,
the difference between the processor values of processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) and processor
B2 43D (FIG. 21A), exceeds the exemplary threshold of fifteen. Since one difference
exceeds the exemplary threshold, the processor value from discarded processor A1 43A
(FIG. 21A) can be voted out. The voting result from example2 501 is that any of processor
values from processors A2/B1/B2 43A-43D (FIG. 21A) can be selected because processor
A1 43A (FIG. 21A) was voted out.
[0186] Referring now primarily to FIG. 21F, example3 503 of voting can include first computations
511 in which processor values for processors A1-B2 43A-43D (FIG. 21A) can be averaged
and can be compared to the computed average. The processor having the largest difference
from the average, in example3 503, processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A), is discarded. Second
computations 513 can include comparisons between processor values of the remaining
three processors A2/B1/B2 43B-43D (FIG. 21A). In example3 511, none of the differences
exceeds the exemplary threshold of fifteen. Comparisons can be taken between the processor
value of discarded processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) and the processor values of the three
remaining processors A2/B1/B2 43B-43D (FIG. 21A). In example3 511, two of the differences,
the differences between processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) and processors B1/B2 43C/43D (FIG.
21A), exceed the exemplary threshold of fifteen. Since at least one difference exceeds
the exemplary threshold, the processor value from discarded processor A1 43A (FIG.
21A) can be voted out.
[0187] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 21G, example4 505 of voting can include first
computations 515 in which processor values for processors A1-B2 43A-43D (FIG. 21A)
can be averaged and can be compared to the computed average. The processor having
the largest difference from the average, in example4 515 processor B2 43D (FIG. 21A),
is discarded. Second computations 517 can include comparisons between processor values
of the remaining three processors A1/A2/B1 43A-43C (FIG. 21A). In example4 505, the
difference between processor values of processors A1/B1 43A/C (FIG. 21A) exceeds the
exemplary threshold of fifteen. Comparisons can be taken between the processor values
of processors A1/B1 43A/C (FIG. 21A) with remaining processor A2 43B (FIG. 21A). In
example4 505, the difference between the processor values of processors A1/A2 43A/B
(FIG. 21A) equals the threshold value of fifteen, therefore, between the two processors,
A1/B1 43A/C (FIG. 21A), processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) can be discarded. Comparisons
can be taken between the processor values of discarded processors A1/B2 43A/43D (FIG.
21A) and the processor values of the two remaining processors A2/B1 43B-43C (FIG.
21A). In example4 505, one of the differences, the difference between the processor
values of processor A1 43A (FIG. 21A) and processor A2 43B (FIG. 21A), does not exceed
the exemplary threshold of fifteen. Therefore, the processor value from processors
A1 and B2 43A/D (FIG. 21A) can be voted out. The voting result from example4 505 is
that the processor value from either processor A2 43B (FIG. 21A) or B1 43C (FIG. 21A)
can be selected and A2 43B (FIG. 21A) is selected in example4 505.
[0188] Referring now to FIG. 22A, the MD can operate several modes. In standard mode 100-1,
the MD can operate on two drive wheels and two caster wheels. Standard mode 100-1
can provide turning performance and mobility on relatively firm, level surfaces (e.g.,
indoor environments, sidewalks, pavement). Seat tilt can be adjusted to provide pressure
relief, tilting the seat pan and back together. From standard mode 100-1, users can
transition to 4-Wheel 100-2, docking 100-5, stair 100-4, and remote 100-6 modes, and,
through other modes, into balance mode 100-3. Standard mode 100-1 can be used where
the surfaces are smooth and ease of turning is important, for example, but not limited
to, positioning a chair at a desk, maneuvering for user transfers to and from other
supports, and driving around offices or homes. Entry into standard 100-1, remote 100-6,
and docking mode 100-5 can be based upon in which operating mode the MD is currently,
and upon cluster/wheel velocities. In enhanced mode, or 4-Wheel mode 100-2, the MD
can operate on four drive wheels, can be actively stabilized through onboard sensors,
and can elevate the main chassis, casters, and seating. 4-Wheel mode 100-2 can provide
the user with mobility in a variety of environments, enabling users to travel up steep
inclines and over soft, uneven terrain. In 4-Wheel mode 100-2, all four drive wheels
can be deployed and the caster wheels can be retracted by rotating the MD. Driving
four wheels and equalizing weight distribution on the wheels can enable the MD to
drive up and down steep slopes and through many types of gravel, sand, snow, and mud.
Cluster rotation can allow operation on uneven terrain, maintaining the center of
gravity of the device over the wheels. The drive wheels can drive up and over curbs.
This functionality can provide users with mobility in a wide variety of outdoor environments.
The seat height can be adjusted by the user to provide necessary clearance over obstacles
and along slopes. Users can be trained to operate in 4-Wheel mode directly up or down
slopes of up to 10°, and stability can be tested to 12° to demonstrate margin. The
MD can operate on outdoor surfaces that are firm and stable but wet.
[0189] Continuing to refer to FIG. 22A, frost heaves and other natural phenomena can degrade
outdoor surfaces, creating cracks and loose material. In 4-Wheel mode 100-2, the MD
can operate on these degraded surfaces under pre-selected conditions. 4-Wheel mode
100-2 can be available for selection by users from standard 100-1, balance 100-3,
and stair 100-4 modes, for example. Users may transition from 4-Wheel mode 100-2 to
each of these other modes. In the event of loss of stability in balance mode 100-3
due to a loss of traction or driving into obstacles, the MD can attempt to execute
an automatic transition to 4-Wheel mode 100-2. Sensor data and user commands can be
processed in a closed loop control system, and the MD can react to changes in pitch
caused by changes in terrain, external impacts, and other factors. 4-Wheel mode 100-2
can use both wheel and cluster motors to maintain stability. Traversing obstacles
can be a dynamic activity, with the user and the MD possibly pitching fore and aft
as the wheels follow the terrain and the cluster motor compensates for the changing
slope of the terrain. 4-Wheel mode 100-2 can protect the user if necessary, and can
coordinate the wheel and cluster motors to keep the MD underneath the user. 4-Wheel
mode 100-2 can give the user the ability to traverse uneven terrain such as ramps,
gravel, and curbs. 4-Wheel mode 100-2 can be used to catch automatic transitions from
balance mode 100-3 if the two-wheel controller fails (due to a loss of traction, a
collision, etc.), and normal transitions from stair mode 100-4 onto a top landing.
The seat height can be adjustable between the "cluster clear height" and the maximum
seat height. The frame lean position can be set to an optimum position for active
stabilization. 4-Wheel mode 100-2 can coordinate the wheel and cluster servos to actively
stabilize the MD.
[0190] Continuing to refer to FIG. 22A, in balance mode 100-3, the MD can operate on two
drive wheels at elevated seat height and can be actively stabilized through onboard
sensors. Balance mode 100-3 can provide mobility at an elevated seat height. In balance
mode 100-3, the MD can mimic human balance, i.e. the MD can operate on two wheels.
Additional height comes in part from rotating the clusters to put a single pair of
wheels directly under the user. The seat height may be adjusted by the user as well.
Balance mode 100-3 can be requested from several modes, and balance mode 100-3 can
be entered if the wheel and cluster motors are substantially at rest and the MD is
level. Calibration mode can be used to determine a user's center of gravity for a
specific MD. In calibration mode the user can achieve balance at specified calibration
points while the controller averages the pitch of the MD. The averaged value can be
stored, along with seat height and cluster position, for use in calculating the user
center of gravity (CG) fit parameters. The CG fit parameters can be used to determine
the MD/user's center of gravity. In stair mode 100-4, the MD can use wheel clusters
to climb stairs and can be actively stabilized. The MD can climb stairs by rotating
the cluster while the machine is balanced-at least partially-by the user or an attendant.
The user can control the motion of the cluster by offsetting the MD from the balance
point. If the MD is pitched forward, the cluster can rotate in the downward climbing
direction (stairs can be climbed with the user facing away from the stairs). Conversely,
if the MD is pitched backwards, the cluster can rotate in the upward climbing direction.
The user can balance the MD by applying moderate forces to the handrail, or alternately
an assistant can balance the MD using an attendant handle on the MD. Stair mode 100-4
can enable users to ascend and descend stairs. If the MD begins to lose stability
in stair mode 100-4, the MD can be made to fall on its back instead of falling forward
to provide a safety feature for the user.
[0191] Continuing to refer to FIG. 22A, in remote mode 100-6, the MD can operate on four
drive wheels, unoccupied. Remote mode 100-6 can provide the user with a way to operate
the device when not seated in it. This mode can be useful for maneuvering the device
for transfers, parking the device after a transfer (e.g., after transferring to bed
the user can move the device out of the way), and other purposes. Remote mode 100-6
can be used in any environment where standard mode 100-1 may be used, as well as on
steep ramps. In remote mode 100-6, the MD can be operated with the four drive wheels
on the ground and the frame lean reclined such that the casters can be raised. Joystick
70007 (FIG. 12A) can be inactive unless the frame lean is at a rear detent. The rear
detent can be selected to provide ample caster clearance for climbing forward up relatively
steep inclines such as, for example, a 20° incline. UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can be in remote
communications, for example, through a wireless interface, with a device that can
control the MD in remote mode 100-6. In optional docking mode 100-5, the MD can operate
on four drive wheels and two caster wheels, therefore lowering the main chassis. Docking
mode 100-5 can allow the user to maneuver the MD for engagement with a docking base.
Docking mode 100-5 can operate in a configuration that can lower the docking attachments
to engage the MD with a vehicle docking base. Docking mode 100-5 can be used within
a motor vehicle that is configured with a docking base, for example. Utility mode
can be used to access various device features to configure the MD, or diagnose issues
with the MD. Utility mode can be activated when the device is stationary, and in standard
mode 100-1.
[0192] Continuing to refer to FIG. 22A, the MD can enter standard mode 100-1 when caster
wheels 21001 (FIG. 7) are deployed, when on four drive wheels 21201 (FIG. 1A) with
the frame lean reclined, or when the seat is being adjusted during a transition. In
standard mode 100-1, the MD can use inertial data to set lean limits, seat height
limits, speeds and accelerations to improve the stability of the MD. If inertial data
are unavailable, speeds, accelerations, seat height and lean limits can take on default
values that can be, but are not limited to being, conservative estimates. In standard
mode 100-1, active control may not be needed to maintain the MD in an upright position.
The MD can continue to be in standard mode 100-1 after failure of one of the redundant
systems. In some configurations, entry into standard mode 100-1 can be dependent upon
the current mode of the MD. In some configurations, entry into standard mode 100-1
can depend at least upon cluster and wheel velocities. When the MD is in remote mode
100-6, entry into standard mode 100-1 can be based upon the movement of the MD, and
the position of caster wheels 21001 (FIG. 7). In some configurations, entry into standard
mode 100-1 can be based on the movement of the MD. In some configurations, entry into
standard mode 100-1 can activate a seat controller and can set the MD in a submode
based on the current mode of the MD. Lean and seat limits of the MD, joystick status,
and cluster velocity can be based on the submode. While in standard mode 100-1, the
MD can receive and filter desired fore/aft and yaw velocities, calculate cluster velocity,
wheel and yaw positions, and velocity errors, and can limit velocities if required.
While in standard mode 100-1, the MD can apply wheel and cluster brakes to, for example,
conserve power when the MD is not moving, can monitor wheel speed, and can disable
joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A). In some configurations, if data originating at IMU 50003
(FIG. 15C) are inaccurate, the MD can automatically adjust back lean limits and accelerations.
In some configurations, when the joystick command is the reverse of the current velocity,
braking can be adjusted to minimize any abrupt change from a reverse command to a
forward command that might occur and that might cause problems in stability on inclines.
[0193] Continuing to refer to FIG. 22A, in some configurations, there can be multiple machine
statuses - e.g., but not limited to, driving, reclining, and transitioning - in standard
mode 100-1. In driving status, caster wheels 21001 (FIG. 7) can touch the ground and
forward drive wheels 21513 can be held off the ground. In reclining status, caster
wheels 21001 (FIG. 7) can be raised off the ground, the cluster can be moved by the
user, and the joystick can be disabled. In transitioning status, the MD can be transitioning
to 4-Wheel mode 100-2. In some configurations, transitioning can include phases such
as leaning the frame back and raising/lowering the seat to access/exit 4-Wheel mode
100-2. In some configurations, a reclining angle limit for reclining status can be
based on a forward lean limit that can be set to a cluster angle that can correspond
to a seat pan angle of, for example, but not limited to, approximately 6° reclined
from horizontal. In some configurations, the back frame lean limit for standard mode
100-1 can be based on parameters related to the center of gravity and the cluster
angle. Rearward static stability can be based on the center of gravity with respect
to rear drive wheel 21201 (FIG. 1A). In some configurations, a rear lean limit can
be set to, for example, 13° less than rearward static stability to provide a stability
margin, and there can be an absolute limit on the rear lean limit. In some configurations,
additional rearward frame lean may not be allowed if the center of gravity location
is outside of the wheel drive wheel base, the incline is excessive for operation in
standard mode 100-1, or for other reasons.
[0194] Continuing to refer to FIG. 22A, in some configurations, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A)
can be disabled in standard mode 100-1 if caster wheels 21001 (FIG. 7) have moved
off the ground due to, for example, but not limited to, a frame lean or seat height
adjustment. In some configurations, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be disabled whenever
the wheel motors are hot and the desired wheel velocity is in the same direction as
the wheel command or the desired yaw velocity is in the same direction as the yaw
command, but enabled otherwise. Desired velocity commands can be obtained from UC
130 (FIG. 12A). Desired velocity commands can be shaped to provide acceptable accelerations
and braking rates for fore/aft velocity control in standard mode 100-1. Filters can
be used to shape the commands to acceptable trajectories. The corner frequency of
the filters can vary depending upon whether the MD is accelerating or braking. The
corner frequency of the yaw filter can be reduced when the MD is traveling slowly.
In some configurations, the corner frequency can be scaled when the wheel velocity
is less than, for example, but not limited to, a pre-selected value such as, for example,
but not limited to, 1.5 m/s. In some configurations, a filter coefficient can be scaled
linearly as the wheel velocity decreases, and the decrease can be limited to a pre-selected
value for example, but not limited to, 25% of the original value. In some configurations
and under certain conditions, if the MD is accelerating on level ground, the filter
corner frequency can be set to a pre-selected value such as, for example, but not
limited to, 0.29 Hz. Under other conditions, for example, if the MD is on a slope
of, for example, up to a pre-selected value such as, for example, but not limited
to, 5°, acceleration can be reduced as a linear function of pitch, a maximum corner
frequency can be set to a pre-selected value such as, for example, but not limited
to, 0.29Hz, and a minimal corner frequency can be set to a pre-selected value such
as, for example, but not limited to, 0.15 Hz. In some configurations, if the MD is
on a slope of, for example, greater than a pre-selected value such as, for example,
but not limited to, 5°, and other conditions are met, a minimal corner frequency of
a pre-selected value such as, for example, but not limited to, 0.15Hz can be used
to reduce accelerations. The rearward speed can be limited to a pre-selected value
such as, for example, but not limited to, 0.35 m/s if the MD is on an incline greater
than a pre-selected value, for example, but not limited to, 5° and other conditions
are met. In some configurations, and in some modes and/or when the MD is braking,
the filter corner frequency can be set to a constant.
[0195] Referring now primarily to FIG. 22B, in some configurations, the MD can support at
least one operating mode that can include, but is not limited to including, standard
mode 100-1, enhanced mode 100-2, balance mode 100-3, stair mode 100-4, docking mode
100-5, and remote mode 100-6. Service modes can include, but are not limited to including,
recovery mode 100-7, failsafe mode 100-9 (FIG. 22C), update mode 100-10 (FIG. 22C),
self-test mode 100-13 (FIG. 22C), calibrate mode 100-8, power on mode 100-12 (FIG.
22C), and power off mode 100-11 (FIG. 22C). Mode descriptions and screen flows that
accompany the modes are described herein. With respect to recovery mode 100-7, if
a power off occurs when the MD is not in one of a pre-selected set of modes, such
as for example, but not limited to, standard mode 100-1, docking mode 100-5, or remote
mode 100-6, the MD can enter recovery mode 100-7 to safely reposition the MD into
the driving position of standard mode 100-1, for example. During recovery mode 100-7,
powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can select certain components to activate such
as, for example, seat motor drive A/B 25/37 (FIG. 18C/18D) and cluster motor drive
A/B 1050/27 (FIG. 18C/18D). Functionality can be limited to, for example, controlling
the position of the seat and cluster 21100 (FIG. 6A). In calibrate mode 100-8, powerbase
controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can receive data related to the center of gravity of the
MD from, for example, user controller 130 (FIG. 12A) and use those data to update
the center of gravity data. Mode information can be supplied to active controller
64A which can supply the mode information to mode controller 62A (FIG. 17A12).
[0196] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 22C and 22D, powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D)
can transition the MD into failsafe mode 100-9 when powerbase controller 100 (FIG.
22D) determines that the MD can no longer effectively operate. In failsafe mode 100-9
(FIG. 22C), powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can halt at least some active operations
to protect against potentially erroneous or uncontrolled motion. Powerbase controller
100 (FIG. 22D) can transition from standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B) to update mode 100-10
(FIG. 22C) to, for example, but not limited to, enable communications with applications
that can be executing external to the MD. Powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can
transition to self-test mode 100-13 (FIG. 22C) when the MD is first powered. In self-test
mode 100-13 (FIG. 22C), electronics in powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can perform
self diagnostics and can synchronize with one another. In some configurations, powerbase
controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can perform system self-tests to check the integrity of
systems that are not readily testable during normal operation, for example, memory
integrity verification tests and disable circuitry tests. While in self-test mode
100-13 (FIG. 22C), operational functions can be disabled. Mode controller 62A (FIG.
17A12) can determine a requested mode and can set the mode into which the MD can transition.
In some configurations, powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can calibrate the center
of gravity of the MD. Powerbase controller 100 (FIG. 22D) can control task creation,
for example, through controller task 325, and can control user notifications through,
for example user notify task 165A.
[0197] Referring now to FIGs. 23A-23K, a first configuration of the process by which the
user interfaces with the MD can include a workflow that can be user-friendly specifically
for disabled users. When the power button on UC 130 (FIG. 12A) is selected, UC 130
(FIG. 12A) can display startup screen 1000 (FIG. 23A), for example, but not limited
to, a splash screen. If 10001 (FIG. 23A) the MD is in recovery mode, and if 10001A
(FIG. 23F) the recovery happens under certain circumstances, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can
display specific graphic user interface (GUI) information for the particular kind
of recovery. If 10001 (FIG. 23A) the MD is not in recovery mode, UC 130 (FIG. 12A)
can display home screen 1020 (FIG. 24A) that can include, for example, various icons,
a notification banner that can display notification icons, current time, current mode,
current speed, and battery status. If the user selects changing the seat height, and
if 10001C (FIG. 23B) the user can change the seat height in the current mode, UC 130
(FIG. 12A) can send 10005A (FIG. 23B) a seat height change command to processors A/B
39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D). If 10001C (FIG. 23B) the user cannot change the seat height
in the current mode, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can ignore 10005B (FIG. 23B) the seat height
change request. The user can also choose to lean/tilt the seat. If 10001D (FIG. 23B)
the user can lean the seat in the current mode, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display 10005D
(FIG. 23B) a seat lean icon. If 10001D (FIG. 23B) the user cannot lean the seat in
the current mode, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can ignore 10005C (FIG. 23B) the seat lean request.
The user can move a UC input device, for example, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A). If 10001E
(FIG. 23C) the movement is a double tap forward or backward, or a quick push and hold,
UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display transition screen 1040 (FIG. 24I). In some configurations,
the user is moving from/to balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22B) to/from standard mode 100-1
(FIG. 22B) and UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display icons associated with balance mode 100-3
(FIG. 22B) and standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B), for example. If 10001E (FIG. 23C) the
movement is not a double tap forward or backward, and if 10001F (FIG. 23C) the movement
is a single hold motion forward or backward, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display transition
screen 1040 (FIG. 24I). If 10001F (FIG. 23C) the movement is not a single hold motion
forward or backward, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display home screen 1020 (FIG. 24A). The
user can depress the power button while home screen 1020 (FIG. 24A) is displayed.
If 10006 (FIG. 23A) UC 130 (FIG. 12A) is in standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B) or docking
mode 100-5 (FIG. 22A), UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can transition to off state 10006B (FIG.
23A). If 10006 (FIG. 23A) UC 130 (FIG. 12A) is any mode, and if the power button is
pushed quickly, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can change 10006A (FIG. 23A) the current speed to
zero, or emergency/quick stop, on home screen 1020 (FIG. 24A).
[0198] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 23A-23K, if the menu button is depressed from the home
driving screen, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display main menu screen 1010 (FIG. 24C). If
the menu button is depressed from a screen other than the home driving screen except
the transition screen, the user can be brought to the home driving screen. Using main
menu screen 1010 (FIG. 24C), the user can, for example, but not limited to, select
a mode, adjust the seat, adjust the speed, and configure the device. Configuring the
device can include, but is not limited to including, adjusting brightness, silencing
non-critical cautions and alerts, clearing the service wrench, and forced power off.
If the user chooses to change the mode (FIG. 23D), UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display selection
screen 1050 (FIG. 24E) where the user can select among, for example, but not limited
to, standard, 4-wheel, balance, stair, docking, and remote. If the user confirms 10007A
(FIG. 23E) a new mode selection, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display transition screen 1040
(FIG. 24I), transition the MD to the selected mode, and display home screen 1020 (FIG.
24A). If the user confirms a mode that the MD is already in, home screen 1020 (FIG.
24A) is displayed. If the user chooses to adjust the seat (FIG. 23D), UC 130 (FIG.
12A) can display selection screen 1050 (FIG. 24E) where the user can select among,
for example, but not limited to, various seat adjustments including, but not limited
to, seat height adjustment and seat lean/tilt, and the display home screen 1020 (FIG.
24A) can be displayed. If the user chooses to adjust the speed (FIG. 23D), UC 130
(FIG. 12A) can display selection screen 1050 (FIG. 24E) where the user can select
among, for example, but not limited to, various speed options such as, for example,
but not limited to, speed 0 (joystick off), speed 1 (indoor), or speed 2 (outdoor).
If the user confirms 10010 (FIG. 23D) the selected speed option (FIG. 23D), UC 130
(FIG. 12A) can inform processors A/B 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D) of the selected speed option,
and can display home screen 1020 (FIG. 24A). If the clinician chooses to adjust the
settings (FIG. 23D, FIG. 29-7), UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display selection screen 1050
(FIG. 24E) where the user and/or clinician can select among, for example, but not
limited to, clearing a service wrench, viewing the service code, logging a service
call, setting the brightness/contrast of UC 130 (FIG. 12A), silencing non-critical
cautions and alerts, entering a service update (clinicians and service/technicians),
and forcing a power off. In some configurations, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display settings
selection screen 1050 (FIG. 24E) under pre-selected conditions, for example, but not
limited to, when UC 130 (FIG. 12A) detects that a clinician is attempting to adjust
the settings. If the clinician chooses to perform a CG fit (FIG. 23G), UC 130 (FIG.
12A) can display CG fit selection screen 1050 (FIG. 24E). If the clinician chooses
10005G to continue with the CG fit, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display transition screen
1040 (FIG. 24I) having, for example, a calibration icon, or a CG fit screen 1070 (FIGs.
24M/24N). UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display 10009-1 (FIG. 23H) a seat height icon that
can guide the user in the first step necessary to perform a CG fit. When the user
completes the step, the MD can perform 10009-2 (FIG. 23H) CG fit-related calibrations.
If 10009-3 (FIG. 23H) the calibrations are successful, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display
10009-4 (FIG. 23H) seat lean and/or seat height icons that can guide the user in the
second through sixth steps (FIGs. 23H-23J) necessary to perform a CG fit. If 10009-3
(FIG. 23H) the calibrations are not successful, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can transition 10009-6
(FIG. 23H) the MD to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B), and can identify 10009-7 (FIG.
23H) a caution before returning to CG fit selection screen 1070 (FIGs. 24M/24N) to
begin CG fit again. In some configurations, a backward joystick movement at transition
screen 1040 (FIG. 24I) can exit all transitions. When the user successfully completes
all six steps, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can instruct processors A/B 39/41 (FIGs. 18C/18D)
to transition 10012-2 (FIG. 23J) the MD to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B), can display
10012-1 (FIG. 23J) a status of the CG fit, and can display menu screen 1010 (FIG.
24C) and select home screen 1020 (FIG. 24A) depending on user input. If the user selects
(FIG. 23G) to view a service code and/or to adjust the brightness/contrast of UC 130
(FIG. 12A), UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display appropriate selection screens 1050 (FIG.
24E), can accept user input based on the displayed screen, and can display (FIG. 23D)
menu screen 1010 (FIG. 24C) depending on user input. If the user selects (FIG. 29-11)
forced power off of the MD, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display 10013-1 (FIG. 23K) a settings
screen (FIG. 23G) that can invite power off user sequence 10013-2 (FIG. 23K) to be
performed through a forward joystick hold.
[0199] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 23A-23K, left/right joystick movement on menu screen
1010 (FIG. 24C) on a particular icon can open selection screen 1050 (FIG. 24E). For
example, left/right joystick movement on a mode icon can open a mode selection screen.
Left/right joystick movement in mode selection, seat adjustment, speed selection,
and settings can cycle the options to the user. The icons can loop around, for example,
for the mode selection screen, movement of the joystick could cause icons for 4-Wheel,
standard, balance, stair, docking, remote modes to appear, then to cycle back to the
4-Wheel icon. Up/down joystick movement on menu screen 1010 (FIG. 27), indicated by,
for example, but not limited to, an arrow of a first pre-selected color, can change
the selected icon. Up/down joystick movement on any other screen indicated by, for
example, but not limited to, an arrow of a second pre-selected color, can be used
as a confirmation of selection. Upon entering menu screen 1010 (FIG. 24C), an icon
can be highlighted, for example, the mode icon can be highlighted. In some configurations,
while driving the MD, if the user accidently hits the menu button, menu screen 1010
(FIG. 24C) may be disabled unless joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) is in a neutral position.
If the transition screen 1040 (FIG. 24I) is displayed, the user can, for example,
use the joystick or the toggle (if available) to complete the transition. The menu
button may be disabled while transition screen 1040 (FIG. 24I) is displayed. Transition
screen 1040 (FIG. 24I) can remain displayed until the transition has ended or there
was an issue with the transition. If there is an issue with the transition, UC 130
(FIG. 12A) can provide an indication to the user that the transition was not completed
properly. During a caution state, the user can drive unless the level of caution prevents
the user from driving, for example, when battery 70001 (FIG. 1E) is depleted. If the
user can drive, the display can include the mode and speed. If the user cannot drive,
the speed icon can be replaced with a prompt that indicates what the user needs to
do to be able to drive again. When the user has tilted the seat in standard mode 100-1
(FIG. 22B), UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can display, for example, a seat adjustment icon. The
caution sound can continue until the user takes some action such as, for example,
pressing a button. The alarm icon may remain illuminated until the alarm condition
has been resolved. If the user is transitioning to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B)
from balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22B), UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can indicate that the MD is
transitioning to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B). However, if the MD is on uneven terrain,
the MD may automatically stop and proceed to 4-Wheel mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B), and UC
130 (FIG. 12A) may inform the user. In some configurations, if the load on the MD
is below a pre-selected threshold, a selection of balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22B) can
be rejected. A default mode selection screen 1050 (FIG. 24E) can include 4-Wheel mode
100-2 (FIG. 22B), standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B), and balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22B)
options, one of which can be highlighted and positioned in, for example, a center
circle, for example, standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B). Moving the joystick right or
left can move another mode into center circle and can highlight that mode. If the
user is in a mode that can prevent the user from transitioning to other modes, UC
130 (FIG. 12A) can notify the user, for example, but not limited to, by graying out
the modes that cannot be accessed.
[0200] Referring now to FIGs. 23L-23X, a second configuration workflow can include screens
that can enable the user and/or clinician to control the MD. When the power button
is depressed by the user or clinician when the MD is in an off state, and the MD is
not in recovery mode, the user can be presented with home screen 1020 (FIGs. 23L,
24A). When a screen other than home screen 1020 (FIG. 23L) is displayed, and the power
button is depressed for 3+ seconds, if in standard, remote, or docking mode, the MD
can shut down. In any other mode, the user can remain on the current screen, and the
MD can experience an emergency stop. If there is a short depression of the power button,
the speed of the MD can be modified. From home screen 1020 (FIG. 23L), the user can
view the MD status and can select options based upon the MD status. Options can include,
but are not limited to including, seat height and lean adjustments, and proceeding
to main menu screen 1010 (FIGs. 23O, 24C). Main menu screen 1010 (FIG. 23O) can provide
options such as, for example, but not limited to, mode selection (FIG. 23P), seat
adjustment (FIG. 23O), speed control (FIG. 23O), and settings control (FIG. 23R).
If the MD is in recovery mode when the power button is depressed (see FIG. 23V), options
for recovery can include, but are not limited to including, standard recovery. Each
type of recovery provides a different workflow, and possibly different instructions
to the user, for example, UC 130 can instruct the user to transition from 4-wheel
mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B) to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B).
[0201] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 23L-23X, in some configurations, transition screen 1040
(FIGs. 23N, 24I) can be displayed to guide the user through a transition from a current
mode to a selected mode of the MD. In some configurations, standard mode 100-1 (FIG.
22B) can be shown automatically as the selected option when the user opens mode selection
screen 1060 (FIG. 23P). In some configurations, the MD can display information about
the availability of driving within drive speed area 1020-2 (FIG. 24A) on home screen
1020 (FIG. 23L). In some configurations, when main menu screen 1010 (FIG. 23O) is
selected during a transition (FIG. 23Q), setting selection can be automatically shown
as the selected option. In some configurations, when settings selections screen 1110
(FIG. 23R) is displayed, icons can be shown with options such as, for example, but
not limited to, the CG fit, MD service, brightness/contrast edit, connect to wireless,
and forced power off. The user can scroll to select the desired setting, and can scroll
to confirm the selection. In some configurations, if CG fit is selected (see FIG.
23R), CG fit screens (FIGs. 24M and 24N) can be displayed when the clinician connects
to UC 130. In some configurations, when wireless screen 1120 (FIG. 23R) is selected,
a connected icon or a status icon can be displayed. If the clinician selects the back
(menu) button, and the wireless screen is exited, the wireless connection can also
be terminated. During the CG fit workflow (see FIGs. 23S-23U), UC 130 can display
which way to move the joystick. The menu button can be used to move into the CG fit
workflow, and out of the CG fit workflow to drive the MD. If the service screen (see
FIG. 23X) is selected, there could be a service code displayed. In some configurations,
a grayed service icon with 'X' can be displayed if there is no service code. An 8-digit
code can be displayed if no wrench clearing is necessary. If wrench clearing is necessary,
after the user enters commands given by service (for example, but not limited to,
N, S, E/R, W/L), numbers 1-4 can be displayed that can correspond to the movement
of the joystick. After the user has entered 6 digits, the green up arrow can be displayed
for the user to then hold forward on the joystick. If the user is in a position where
a forced power off is necessary (see FIG. 23W), for example if the user is stuck in
the midst of a transition, and the user holds the menu button for a pre-selected amount
of time, for example, 6+ seconds, home screen 1020 (FIG. 23L) can be displayed having
icons that are relevant to the condition of the MD. If the user passes through pre-selected
steps and confirms power off, the MD can power down.
[0202] Referring now to FIGs. 23Y-23KK, a third configuration workflow can include screens
that can enable the user and/or clinician to control the MD. When the power button
is depressed by the user or clinician when the MD is in an off state, and the MD is
not in recovery mode, the user can be presented with home screen 1020 (FIGs. 23Y,
24A). If the power button is depressed from home screen 1020 (FIGs. 23Y, 24A), and
if 10005 the user is in certain modes, for example, but not limited to, standard,
docking, or remote mode, the user can be presented with a power off screen. If the
power button is depressed and held for a pre-selected amount of time, for example,
but not limited to, approximately two seconds, the MD can be transitioned to an off
state. If the power button is not held for the pre-selected time, the user can be
presented again with the power off screen. In some configurations, no confirmation
is needed for the shut down. In a mode other than one of the certain pre-selected
modes, if 10006 the power button has experienced a short depression for the first
time, the speed of the MD can be modified, for example, emergency stop 10006B can
be instituted and home screen 1020 (FIGs. 23Y, 24A) can once again be presented to
the user. If 10006 the power button has not experienced a short depression for the
first time, the MD can revert to the previous value of the speed before the power
button was depressed and home screen 1020 (FIGs. 23Y, 24A) can be presented to the
user. From home screen 1020 (FIGs. 23Y, 24A), the user can view the MD status and
can select options based upon the MD status. Options can include, but are not limited
to including, seat height and lean adjustments, audio activation such as, for example,
but not limited to, a horn, settings, and proceeding to main menu screen 1010 (FIGs.
23BB, 24C). Main menu screen 1010 (FIG. 23O) can provide options such as, for example,
but not limited to, mode selection (FIG. 23CC), seat adjustment (FIG. 23BB), speed
control FIG. 23BB), and settings control (FIG. 23EE). If the MD is in recovery mode
when the power button is depressed (see FIG. 2311), options for recovery can include,
but are not limited to including, standard recovery. Each type of recovery can provide
a different workflow, and possibly different instructions to the user, for example,
UC 130 can instruct the user to transition from 4-wheel mode 100-12 (FIG. 22B) to
standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B). The user can be instructed in how to move from one
mode to another before a transition occurs.
[0203] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 23Y-23KK, in some configurations, transition screen
1040 (FIGs. 23DD, 24I) can be displayed to guide the user through a transition from
a current mode to a selected mode of the MD. In some configurations, standard mode
100-1 (FIG. 22B) can be shown automatically as the selected option when the user opens
mode selection screen 1060 (FIG. 23CC). In some configurations, if driving is not
allowed during a transition (FIG. 23Q), the MD can display information about the availability
of driving within drive speed area 1020-2 (FIG. 24A) on home screen 1020 (FIG. 23L).
In some configurations, when main menu screen 1010 (FIG. 23DD) is selected during
a transition (FIG. 23DD), mode selection can be automatically shown as the selected
option. In some configurations, when settings selections screen 1110 (FIG. 23EE) is
displayed, icons can be shown with options such as, for example, but not limited to,
the CG fit, MD service, brightness/contrast edit, connect to wireless, and forced
power off. The user can scroll to select the desired setting, and can scroll to confirm
the selection. In some configurations, if CG fit is selected (see FIG. 23EE), CG fit
screens (see FIGs. 23FF-23HH) can be displayed when the clinician sets up a connection
between a wireless display and UC 130. In some configurations, the user cannot see
the display. In some configurations, when connection to wireless screen 1120 (FIG.
23EE) is selected, a connected wireless icon or a status icon can be displayed. If
the clinician selects the back (menu) button, and the wireless screen is exited, the
wireless connection can also be terminated. During the CG fit workflow (see FIGs.
23FF-23HH), when UC 130 displays which way to move the joystick, in some configurations,
if the user moves the joystick, the user can be sent to a step in the CG workflow
depending on the orientation of the joystick. The menu button can be used to move
into the CG fit workflow, and out of the CG fit workflow to drive the MD. If the service
screen (see FIG. 23KK) is selected, there could be a service code displayed. In some
configurations, a service icon with 'X' can be displayed if there is no service code
and there are no existing conditions. If there are existing conditions, a service
icon with "X" can be displayed with a code. If the user is in a position where a forced
power off is necessary (see FIG. 23JJ), and if the user holds the menu button for
a pre-selected amount of time, for example, 6+ seconds, settings (see FIG. 23EE) can
be presented to the user. If the user passes through pre-selected steps and confirms
power off, the MD can power down.
[0204] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 23Y-23KK, in some configurations, the user and/or clinician
may, while driving, use the horn (see FIG. 23Y) and force an emergency stop by depressing
the power button (see FIG. 23Y). In some configurations, depressing the menu button
while driving will not cause a display of the menu button which can be displayed with
the joystick is in a neutral position. When transitioning from one mode to another,
the user can control the MD with either joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) and/or toggle 70036-2
(FIG. 12D). In some configurations, when transitioning from standard mode 100-1 (FIG.
22B) to balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22B) and the terrain is uneven, the MD can stop and
end the transition in 4-wheel mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B). In some configurations, if UC
130 (FIG. 12A) becomes disconnected from the MD during a transition, when UC 130 (FIG.
12A) is reconnected, the transition status can be recalled. During an alarm state,
the alarm sound can continue until the user has pressed the horn button. Left/right
movement of joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) on some screens can open a selection, while
on other screens, the movement can cycle options to the user. Up/down movement of
joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can change the selected icon on some screens, while on other
screens, the movement can be used as a confirmation of the selection.
[0205] Referring now to FIGs. 23LL-23VV, a fourth configuration workflow can include screens
that can enable the user and/or clinician to control the MD. The workflow can be divided
into subflows that can include, but are not limited to including, normal workflow
1070 (FIG. 23LL), power button workflow 1072 (FIG. 23MM), stair mode workflow1074
(FIG. 23NN), forced power off workflow 1076 (FIG. 23OO), CG fit workflow 1078 (FIGs.
23PP-1, 23PP-2), recovery mode workflow 1080 (FIG. 23QQ), wireless workflow 1082 (FIG.
23RR), brightness workflow 1084 (FIG. 23SS), alarm mute workflow 1086 (FIG. 23TT),
shortcut toggle workflow 1088 (FIG. 23UU), and battery charging workflow 1090 (FIG.
23VV). Normal workflow 1070 (FIG. 23LL) can include the display of startup screen
1000 and, if the MD is not in recovery mode, home/driving screen 1020 can be displayed.
Otherwise, the display can transition to recovery mode workflow 1080 (FIG. 23QQ).
If the menu button is depressed when home/driving screen 1020 is displayed, main menu
screen 1010 can be displayed, and manipulation of the joystick to select an option
can cause any of setting screen 1043, speed selection screen 1041, seat adjustment
selection screen 1042, or mode selection screen 1060 to display. If the menu button
is depressed, home/driving screen 1020 can be displayed. If settings screen 1043 is
displayed, any of alarm mute workflow 1086 (FIG. 23TT), brightness workflow 1084 (Fl.
23SS), CG fit workflow 1078 (FIGs. 23PP, 23PP-1), FPO workflow 1076 (FIG. 23OO), and
wireless workflow 1082 (FIG. 23RR) can be entered. If settings screen 1043 is displayed
and the menu button is depressed, home/driving screen 1020 can be displayed. If speed
selection screen 1041 is displayed, the user can either select a speed with the joystick
or return to home/driving screen 1020 by depressing the menu button. If seat adjustment
selection screen is depressed, the user can adjust the seat and return to home/driving
screen 1020 by depressing the menu button. If mode selection screen 1060 is displayed,
the user can choose a mode and confirm it through joystick manipulation, or return
to home/driving screen 1020 by depressing the menu button. If the user chooses stair
mode, the MD can enter stair mode workflow 1074 (FIG. 23NN). If the user does not
choose stair mode, transition screen 1040 can be displayed, and when the transition
is complete, home/driving screen 1020 can be displayed.
[0206] Referring now to FIG. 23MM, if the power button is depressed, home/driving screen
1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed unless the power button is depressed while transition
screen 1040 is displayed. If the MD is in standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A), docking
mode 100-5 (FIG. 22A), or remote mode 100-6 (FIG. 22A) and the user depresses the
power button for a pre-selected amount of time, the MD can power down. If the user
does not depress the power button for a pre-selected amount of time, an emergency
stop can be enabled in which the speed is set to 0. If the MD is not in standard mode
100-1 (FIG. 22A), docking mode 100-5 (FIG. 22A), or remote mode 100-6 (FIG. 22A) and
the user depresses the power button, an emergency stop can be enabled. The user can
depress the power button again to enable the MD to return to the speed it was traveling
before the power button was depressed and to return to home/driving screen 1020 (FIG.
23LL).
[0207] Referring now to FIG. 23NN, if the user selects stair mode, stair mode workflow 1074
can be entered. If solo mode is selected, transition screen 1040 can be displayed
followed by grab handrail confirmation screen 1092. If the user confirms that the
handrail is to be used, home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed. If
the menu button is depressed, no further input is accepted. If the user declines to
use the handrail, the MD can automatically transition to 4-wheel mode 100-2 (FIG.
22A) and home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed. If assisted mode is
selected, stair attendant confirmation screen 1094 can be displayed. If the user declines
to use a stair attendant, mode selection screen 1060 can be displayed. If the user
depresses the menu button, no input is accepted. If the user confirms the use of a
stair attendant, transition screen 1040 can be displayed until the transition is complete,
and home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed.
[0208] Referring now to FIG. 23OO, if the user depresses and holds the menu button for a
pre-selected amount of time, for example, but not limited to, 6+ seconds, forced power
off workflow 1076 can be entered and settings screen 1043 can be displayed. If the
joystick is manipulated, forced power off confirmation screen 1096 can be displayed,
and if the menu button is depressed, home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed.
If forced power off is confirmed, the MD is powered down. If forced power off is not
confirmed, the user can be given another chance to accomplish forced power off after
a pre-selected amount of time. The user can depress the menu button to display home/driving
screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL). If the user does not hold the menu button for the pre-selected
amount of time, home/driving screen 1020 can be displayed and main menu screen 1010
can be displayed if the menu button is depressed. The user can enable forced power
off by opening setting screen 1043 and manipulating the joystick to enable display
of forced power off confirmation screen 1096 as described herein.
[0209] Referring now to FIGs. 23PP-1 and 23PP-2, if CG fit is selected from settings screen
1043 (FIG. 23LL), CG fit workflow 1078 can be entered. Depending on how CG fit is
entered, a CG fit icon can either appear on settings screen 1043 (FIG. 23LL) or not.
If the CG fit icon appears, joystick manipulation can enable a transition from standard
mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A) to balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22A). If the joystick is moved backwards,
CF fit workflow 1078 can be exited. Otherwise, steps in the CG fit process can be
displayed. The sub-steps for each step can include, but are not limited to including,
displaying an indication that the MD is in a CG fit step, receiving a selection of
a horn/ack button depression, calibrating the MD, and checking for success of the
step. When all steps have executed, the MD can transition to standard mode 100-1 (FIG.
22A) and settings screen 1043 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed with an indication that
the calibration has completed. If the MD power cycles, the CG fit calibration can
be removed from the MD. If all the steps did not complete successfully, the MD can
transition to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A), a CG fit fail icon can be displayed,
and a visual and/or audible alert can be generated. Either the process can be repeated,
or the menu button can be depressed, and home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can
be displayed.
[0210] Referring now to FIG. 23QQ, following power on and the display of startup screen
1000, if the MD is in recovery mode, recovery mode workflow 1080 can executed. In
particular, prompts can appear in a status area of the display to indicate how the
user can return to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A). When the transition to standard
mode 100-1 (FIG. 23LL) is complete, or if the MD is not in recovery mode at startup,
home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed.
[0211] Referring now to FIG. 23RR, when wireless connectivity is selected, wireless workflow
1082 can be executed. In particular, service update screen 1083 can be displayed,
and the user can enter a passcode or provide another form of authentication. The user
can be a clinician, and wireless connectivity can be used to remotely control the
MD. If the user authenticates, service update screen 1083 can be displayed with an
indication that the user is allowed to connect wirelessly. The user can be given up
to a pre-selected number of times to authenticate.
[0212] Referring now to FIG. 23SS, when brightness adjustment is selected from settings
screen 1043 (FIG. 23LL), brightness workflow 1084 can be executed. Brightness screen
1085 can be displayed, and joystick manipulation can change the brightness of the
display. If the menu button is depressed, brightness settings can be saved and home/driving
screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed.
[0213] Referring now to FIG. 23TT, when alarm mute is selected from settings screen 1043
(FIG. 23LL), alarm mute workflow 1086 can be executed. Alarm mute screen 1087 can
be displayed, and joystick manipulation can enable or disable volume. Further joystick
manipulation can save the volume settings and return to home/driving screen 1020 (FIG.
23LL), while depressing the menu button can return to home/driving screen 1020 (FIG.
23LL) without saving volume settings.
[0214] Referring now to FIG. 23UU, when shortcuts are taken from home/driving screen 1020,
shortcut toggle workflow 1088 can be executed. Possible shortcuts can include, but
are not limited to including, seat height shortcut, seat lean shortcut, and shortcut
toggle. Because the seat height and seat lean can only be changed in certain modes,
any attempts to change the seat height and/or the seat lean, including through the
seat height and seat lean shortcuts, can be ignored. If the MD is in a mode in which
the seat height and/or the seat lean can be changed, the seat height shortcut and/or
the seat lean shortcut can be used to change the seat height and/or the seat lean.
During the seat height change, the user can continue to drive. After the seat height
and/or the seat lean are changed, home/driving screen 1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed.
To use the shortcut toggle, the joystick is manipulated in a pre-selected way, for
example, but not limited to, a short tap and hold. When this happens, transition screen
1040 can be displayed, and the mode of the MD can change, for example, the MD can
transition from standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A) to balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 23LL) and
vice versa. If the joystick is manipulated in a different pre-selected way, for example,
a single hold, transition screen 1040 can be displayed. Otherwise, home/driving screen
1020 (FIG. 23LL) can be displayed.
[0215] Referring now to FIG. 23VV, to charge the batteries of the MD, battery charging workflow
1090 can be executed. If the MD is powered down, and if the A/C adapter is connected
to the MD, a battery charging icon can be displayed until the battery is charged or
until there is a battery fault. If the battery is charged, the full battery icon can
be displayed. If there is a battery fault, a battery fault icon can be displayed.
When the user disconnects the A/C adapter from the MD, the MD can power down. If the
MD is not powered down and the A/C adapter is not connected to the MD, an indication
that the battery is not charging can be displayed on home/driving screen 1020 (FIG.
23LL). If the MD is not powered down and the A/C adapter is connected to the MD, an
indication of the current status, such as, for example, but not limited to, an audible
alert, can be sounded until, for example, the alert is muted.
[0216] Referring now to FIGs. 24A and 24B, UC home screen 1020/1020A can include, but is
not limited to including, base banner 1020-1 that can include, but is not limited
to including, time, and indication of the status of the parking brake, an alert status,
a service required status, and a temperature status. UC home screen 1020/1020A can
include first screen area 1020-2 that can present, for example, but not limited to,
the speed of the MD, and can also provide a shortcut for seat adjustment. A prompt
can inform the user that the seat is in a position that prevents driving. Second screen
area 1020-3 can display, for example, but not limited to, the current mode of the
MD, for example, but not limited to, in iconic form. UC home screen 1020A (FIG. 24B)
can include battery status strip 1020-4 that can provide, for example, but not limited
to, battery status that can be, for example, visually highlighted in, for example,
red, yellow, and green colors.
[0217] Referring now to FIGs. 24C and 24D, UC main menu screen 1010/1010A can include, but
is not limited to including, base banner 1020-1 and, optionally, battery status strip
1020-4 (FIG. 24D) as described herein. UC main menu screen 1010/1010A can accommodate
selection of modes, seat adjustment, speed, and setting. A selection can be indicated
by the presence of a highlighted icon, for example, within selected area 1010-2, which
can be surrounded by further selection option arrows 1010-1. Each of selection area
1010-3 can include, but is not limited to including, an icon indicative of a possible
selection option.
[0218] Referring now to FIGs. 24E-24H, UC selection screen 1050/1050A/1050B/1050C can include,
but is not limited to including, base banner 1020-1 and, optionally, battery status
strip 1020-4 (FIG. 24F) as described herein. UC selection screen 1050/1050A/1050B/1050C
can accommodate an indication of mode selected in mode selected area 1050-1. Optionally,
selected mode can also be displayed in selected transition area 1050-3 that can be
surrounded by unselected, but possible modes in unselected areas 1050-2 and 1050-4.
UC selection screen can include breadcrumb 1050B-1 (FIG. 24G) that can provide a navigational
path of the modes navigated.
[0219] Referring now to FIGs. 24I and 24J, UC transition screen 1040/1040A can include,
but is not limited to including, base banner 1020-1 and, optionally, battery status
strip 1020-4 (FIG. 24D) as described herein. UC transition screen 1040/1040A can include
target mode area 1040-1 in which an icon, for example, indicating the mode to which
the transition is occurring, can be displayed. UC transition screen 1040/1040A can
include transition direction area 1040-2 and transition status area 1040-3 that can
indicate the status and direction of the transition from one mode to another.
[0220] Referring now to FIG. 24K, UC power off screen 1060A can include, but is not limited
to including, base banner 1020-1, power off first screen area 1060A-1, power off second
screen area 1060A-2, and optional battery status area 1020-4. When a user indicates
a desire to power down the MD under normal conditions, for example, but not limited
to, when the user depresses and holds the power button on UC 130, power off first
screen area 1060A-1 can indicate the speed at which the MD is traveling, and power
off second screen area 1060A-2 can indicate power off progress. In some configurations,
power off progress can be indicated by the progressive changing of color of the area
inside the shape in power off second screen area 1060A-2. Base banner 1020-1 and optional
battery status area 1020-4 are described elsewhere herein.
[0221] Referring now to FIG. 24L, UC forced power off screen 1060B can include, but is not
limited to including, base banner 1020-1, forced power off first screen area 1060B-1,
power off second screen area 1060A-2, and optional battery status area 1020-4. When
a user indicates a desire to power down the MD under other than normal conditions,
for example, but not limited to, if the MD is experiencing mechanical problems, the
forced power off screen 1060A can display the progress of the power down sequence.
In particular, forced power off first screen area 1060B-1 can indicate that a forced
power off sequence is in progress, and power off first screen area 1060A-1 can indicate
forced power off progress. In some configurations, forced power off progress can be
indicated by the progressive changing of color of the area inside the shape in power
off second screen area 1060A-2. In some configurations, the user can begin the forced
power off sequence by navigating to a menu and selecting forced power off.
[0222] Referring now to FIGs. 24M and 24N, CG fit screen 1070 can include, but is not limited
to including, base banner 1020-1, CG fit breadcrumb 1070-1, menu button indicator
1070-2, and optional battery status area 1020-4. When a user indicates a desire to
perform a CG fit, the CG fit screen 1070 can display prompts for actions that can
be needed to perform CG fit. In particular, CG fit breadcrumb 1070-1 can indicate
that a CG fit is in progress in which prompts can be displayed that can indicate the
joystick action required to move from one step in the CG fit process to the next.
Steps can include raising, lowering, and tilting the MD when input is received by
the MD such as laid out in FIGs. 23FF-23HH, for example. Menu button 1070-2 can be
depressed when it is desired to drive the MD while a CG fit is in progress. In some
configurations, completion, either successful or unsuccessful, of the CG fit process
can indicate that exit of the CG fit process is possible.
[0223] Referring now to FIG. 25A, speed processor 755 can accommodate a continuously adjustable
scaled factor to control the MD. A user and/or clinician can set at least one parameter
bound 765 that can be adjusted according to the driving needs of the user and/or clinician.
Wheel commands 769 can be calculated as a function of joystick input 629 and profile
constants 768 that can include, but are not limited to including, k
s601/607 (FIG. 25E), k
a 603/609 (FIG. 25E), k
d 605/611 (FIG. 25E), and k
m 625 (FIG. 25E), where k
s 601/607 (FIG. 25E) is a maximum speed range, k
a 603/609 (FIG. 25E) is an acceleration range, k
d 605/611 (FIG. 25E) is a deadband range, k
m 625 (FIG. 25E) is a merge range, and k
w is a conversion from wheel counts to speed. Ranges of profile constants k
s, k
a, k
d, and k
m 625 (FIG. 25E) can vary, ranges provided herein are exemplary. Parameter bounds 765
and profile constants 768 can be supplied by, for example, but not limited to, the
user, can be pre-set, and can be determined in any other way. Speed processor 755
can access parameter bounds 765 and profile constants 768. Exemplary ranges for profile
constants 768 can include:
ks = Max Speed value, can scale from, for example, but not limited to, 1 - 4 m/s
ka = Acceleration value, can scale from, for example, but not limited to, 0.5 - 1.5
kd = Deadband value, can scale from, for example, but not limited to, 0 - 5.5
km = Merge value, can scale from, for example, but not limited to, 0 - 1



where k
x,1 is the minimum of the range of gain k
x, and k
x,2 is maximum of the range of gain k
x, where x = s or a or m. Exemplary parameter bounds 765 can include:

where k
d,m is the gain k
d of the merger of profile A 613 (FIG. 25E) and profile B 615 (FIG. 25E), and where
k
s,m is the gain k
s of the merger of profile A 613 (FIG. 25E) and profile B 615 (FIG. 25E).

[0224] Exemplary computations for wheel command 769 can include:

where W
i 769 is the velocity or yaw command that is sent to right/left wheel motor drive 19/31,
21/33.
[0225] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 25A, adjusting C
3 can adjust the shape of the curve of the profile and therefore the user experience
when user commands, for example, but not limited to, joystick commands 629, are converted
to wheel commands 769. In particular, adjusting C
3 can adjust the size of deadband 605/611 (FIG. 25E) and the maxima and minima on either
side of deadband 605-611 (FIG. 25E). Speed processor 755 can include, but is not limited
to including, joystick processor 756 including computer instructions to receive joystick
commands 629, and profile constants processor 754 including computer instructions
to access profile constants 768 and merge value 625 (FIG. 25E), and to scale profile
constants 768 based at least on merge value 625 (FIG. 25E), for example, but not limited
to, as shown in equations set out herein. Speed processor 755 can also include bounds
processor 760 including computer instructions to compute a maximum velocity based
at least on profile constants 768 and a maximum joystick command, and to compute a
proportional gain based at least on profile constants 768 and the maximum velocity,
as shown, for example, but not limited to, in equations set out herein. Speed processor
755 can also include wheel command processor 761 including computer instructions to
compute wheel command 769 based at least on profile constants 768 and joystick commands
629, as shown, for example, but not limited to, in equations set out herein, and provide
wheel commands 769 to wheel motor drives 19/31/21/33.
[0226] Referring now primarily to FIG. 25B, method 550 for accommodating a continuously
adjustable scale factor can include, but is not limited to including, receiving 551
joystick commands 629 (FIG. 25A), accessing 553 profile constants 768 (FIG. 25A) and
a merge value (shown exemplarily as merge value 625 (FIG. 25E) which portrays the
merger of profile A 613 (FIG. 25E) and profile B 615 (FIG. 25E)), scaling 555 profile
constants 768 (FIG. 25A) based at least on the merge value, computing 557 a maximum
velocity based at least on profile constants 768 (FIG. 25A) and a maximum joystick
command (shown exemplarily as the maximum of speed 601 (FIG. 25E), acceleration 603
(FIG. 25E), and deadband 605 (FIG. 25E)), computing 559 a proportional gain based
at least on profile constants 768 (FIG. 25A) and the maximum velocity, computing 561
wheel command 769 (FIG. 25A) based at least on profile constants 768 (FIG. 25A) and
joystick commands 629 (FIG. 25A), and providing 563 wheel commands 769 (FIG. 25A)
to wheel motor drives 19/31/21/33 (FIG. 25A). In some configurations, powerbase controller
100 can modify joystick command 629 provided by user controller 130 before joystick
commands 629 are provided to joystick processor 756. In some configurations, user
controller 130 could be receiving joystick commands 629 from a joystick, whereas in
some configurations, user controller 130 can include the joystick.
[0227] Referring now primarily to FIG. 25C, joystick 130 (FIG. 12A) can be configured to
have different transfer functions to be used under different conditions according
to, for example, the abilities of the user. Speed template (transfer function) 700
shows an exemplary relationship between physical displacement 702 of joystick 70007
(FIG. 12A) and output 703 of UC 130 (FIG. 12A) after transfer function processing
with a particular transfer function. Forward and reverse travel of joystick 70007
(FIG. 12A) can be interpreted as forward longitudinal requests and reverse longitudinal
requests, respectively, as viewed from a user in the seat of the MD, and can be equivalent
to commanded velocity. Left and right travel of joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be interpreted
as left turn requests and right turn requests, respectively, as viewed from a user
in the seat, and can be equivalent to a commanded turn rate. Joystick output 703 can
be modified during certain conditions such as, for example, but not limited to, battery
voltage conditions, height of the seat, mode, failed conditions of joystick 70007
(FIG. 12A), and when speed modification is requested by powerbase controller 100 (FIG.
25A). Joystick output 703 can be ignored and joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be considered
as centered, for example, but not limited to, when a mode change occurs, while in
update mode, when the battery charger is connected, when in stair mode, when joystick
70007 (FIG. 12A) is disabled, or under certain other conditions.
[0228] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 25C, the MD can be configured to suit a particular
user. In some configurations, the MD can be tailored to user abilities, for example,
by setting speed templates and mode restrictions. In some configurations, the MD can
receive commands from external applications 140 (FIG. 16B) executing on devices such
as, for example, but not limited to, a cell phone, a computer tablet, and a personal
computer. The commands can provide, for example, default and/or dynamically-determinable
settings for configuration parameters. In some configurations, a user and/or an attendant
can configure the MD.
[0229] Referring now primarily to FIG. 25D, in some configurations, speed settings can control
the system response to joystick movement. In some configurations, a speed setting
such as speed 0 can be used to disable a response to joystick movement, a speed setting
such as speed 1 can be used to set a maximum speed that may be appropriate for indoor
travel, and a speed setting such as speed 2 can be used to set a maximum speed that
may be appropriate for outdoor and/or hallway travel. The MD can be configured with
any number of speed settings, and the relationship between joystick movement and motor
commands can include non-linear functions. For example, a parabolic relationship could
provide finer control at low speeds. In some configurations, a thumbwheel assembly
as in FIG. 12P can be used to apply a gain on top of the described speed settings.
In some configurations, the gain can vary from 0 to 1, and a gain of 1 can be used
when no speed variations are desired over configured speeds. When the thumbwheel assembly
is used to change the gain by dialing thumbwheel knob 30173 (FIG. 12N) "down", the
maximum speed and every speed along the configured speed trajectory can be reduced
proportional to the amount of the dialing "down". Any maxima for speeds 1 and 2, for
example, can be configured, and minima can be configured as well. In some configurations,
speed 2 can include a minimum speed that is greater than the maximum speed of speed
1 (see FIG. 25D-3), the speed 2 minimum speed and the speed 1 maximum speed can overlap
(see FIG. 25D-1), and the speed 2 minimum can approximately equal the speed 1 maximum
(see FIG. 25D-2). In some configurations, when the current speed setting is already
at its maximum, for instance, further dialing "up" of the thumbwheel 30173 (FIG. 12N)
can be ignored and can result in no change in speed. However, any dialing "down" of
the thumbwheel can immediately cause the speed gain to decrease proportional to the
"downward" movement of the thumbwheel. Similarly, when the current speed setting is
at its minimum, dialing the thumbwheel "down" can result in no change, but dialing
"up" can immediately cause an increase in speed gain.
[0230] Continuing to refer to FIG. 25D, in some configurations, manipulation of thumbwheel
knob 30173 (FIG. 12N) can be interpreted as a desired for a speed setting change.
In some configurations, continuing to dial the thumbwheel "up" when the gain is already
saturated at that speed's maximum can indicate a request to increase the speed setting.
Similarly, continuing to dial down when the gain is at its minimum can indicate a
request for a lower speed setting. In some configurations, dialing thumbwheel knob
30173 (FIG. 12N), pausing any thumbwheel assembly manipulation, and resuming dialing
of thumbwheel knob 30173 (FIG. 12N) can indicate a request for a change in speed settings.
In some configurations, multiple manipulations surrounding one or more pauses can
indicate a request for a change in speed settings. In some configurations, the rate
of manipulation of thumbwheel knob 30173 (FIG. 12N) can indicate, rather than a change
in the gain itself, instead a request to change the speed setting.
[0231] Referring now primarily to FIG. 25E, a user and/or clinician can use a graphical
user interface display that could be, for example, but not limited to, included in
user controller 130 (FIG. 12A), to enable configuration of drive options in the form
of joystick command shaping that can allow the user and/or clinician to configure
the MD for driving preferences. Templates can be provided for the user/clinician to
set or pre-set profile constants 768 (FIG. 25A) that can place the MD in at least
one situation, for example, but not limited to, sport situation, comfort situation,
or economy situation. In economy mode, for example, speed and acceleration can be
limited to reduce power consumption. In sport situation, the user could be allowed
to drive aggressively by, for example, but not limited to, achieving maximum speeds.
Comfort situation can represent an average between economy and sport situations. Other
situations can be possible. Profile constants k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625 can be adjusted through, for example, but not limited to, variable display items,
and wheel command velocity W
i 627 can be computed and graphed based at least on adjusted k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625. For example, profiles A/B 613/615 can result from adjusting speed and deadpan
ranges such that k
s 601 and k
s 607 differ, and k
d 605 and k
d 611 are similar. Wheel command velocity W
i 627 can be computed and graphed for a range of joystick command counts 629 for both
the minimum values (profile A 613) of k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625 and the maximum values (profile B 615) of k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625. Profile A 613 and profile B 615 can be averaged for an easier comparison with
other configurations of profile constants k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625. For example, first joystick control graph 600 indicates that an average wheel
command 617 of 1.5 m/s at 100 joystick command counts results from a first configuration
of k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625.
[0232] Referring now to FIG. 25F, when k
s 601 and k
s 607 are similar, and k
d 605 and k
d 611 differ, wheel command velocity W
i 627 can be computed and graphed for a range of joystick command counts 629 for both
the minimum values (profile A 623) of k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625 and the maximum values (profile B 621) of k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625. Profile A 623 and profile B 621 can be averaged and compared to other configurations
of profile constants k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625. For example, second joystick control graph 700 indicates that an average wheel
command 617 of 1.75 m/s at 100 joystick command counts results from a second configuration
of profile constants k
s 601/607, k
a 603/609, k
d 605/611, and k
m 625. Changes to k
a 603 and k
a 609 can scale filter constants under certain circumstances. Further, joystick command
629 can be filtered by a joystick filter to enable speed-sensitive steering by managing
accelerations. For example, a relatively low corner frequency CF of the joystick filter
can result in a relatively high damped response between joystick commands 629 and
activity of the MD. For example, the corner frequency CF can be an adjustable function
of speed which could result in, for example, but not limited to, a relatively high
relationship between joystick commands 629 and wheel command velocity W
i 769 when the MD is traveling at a relatively high speed, and a relatively lower relationship
between joystick commands 629 and wheel command velocity W
i 769 when the MD is traveling at a relatively low speed. For example, wheel command
velocity W
i 769 can be compared to a full speed threshold T and the corner frequency CF can be
set according to the result of the comparison. In some configurations, if wheel command
velocity W
i 769 is less than a value based at least on the threshold T, the corner frequency
CF can be set to a first value, or if wheel command velocity W
i 769 is less than the threshold T, the corner frequency CF can be set to another value,
for example (W
i*CF)/T. Deceleration rate and acceleration rate can be managed separately and can
be independent of one another. For example, deceleration rate may not be allowed to
be as aggressive as acceleration rate. The deceleration rate can, for example, depend
on the acceleration rate or can dynamically vary in some other way, or can be a fixed
value. The user can, for example, control the deceleration rate.
[0233] Referring now to FIG. 25G, adaptive speed control processor 759 for adaptive speed
control of the MD can include, but is not limited to including, terrain/obstacle data
receiver 1107 including computer instructions to receive terrain and obstacle data
in the vicinity of the MD. By using terrain and obstacle detection sensors for example,
but not limited to, Lidar, remote sensing technology can measure distance by illuminating
a target with a laser and analyzing the reflected light, stereo cameras, and radar.
Adaptive speed control processor 759 can also include mapping processor 1109 including
computer instructions to map obstacles and approaching terrain in real time based
at least on the terrain and obstacle data. Adaptive speed control processor 759 can
further include virtual valley processor 1111 including computer instructions to compute
virtual valleys based at least on the mapped data. Virtual valley processor 1111 can
delineate a sub-area referred to herein as a virtual valley in the vicinity of the
MD. The virtual valley can include at least one low point, gradual and/or dramatic
elevation increases from the at least one low point, and at least one rim surrounding
the at least one low point in which the gradual and/or dramatic elevation increases
terminate at the rim. In the virtual valley, a relatively high wheel command 769 can
be required to turn out of the virtual valley, possibly pre-disposing the MD to stay
in the low point of the virtual valley. Adaptive speed control processor 759 can further
include collision possible processor 1113 including computer instructions to compute
collision possible areas based at least on the mapped data. Collision possible areas
can be sub-areas in which, when in the vicinity of the MD, adaptive speed control
processor 759 can make it difficult to steer the MD into the obstacle. Collision possible
areas can, for example, prevent the MD from running into objects. The position of
the MD can be measured from, for example, any part or parts of the MD, for example,
the center, the periphery, or anywhere in between. Adaptive speed control processor
759 can further include slow-down processor 1115 including computer instructions to
compute slow-down areas based at least on the mapped data and the speed of the MD.
Adaptive speed control processor 759 can slow the MD in the slow-down areas. Adaptive
speed control processor 759 can further make it difficult to turn into slow-down areas
relative to turning into non-slow-down areas. Adaptive speed control processor 759
can recognize any number of types of slow-down areas, each having a set of characteristics.
For example, adaptive speed control processor 759 can adjust the processing of fore-aft
commands to the MD in some types of slow-down areas differently than in others. In
some configurations, the size of the different types of slow-down areas can change
as the speed of the MD changes. Adaptive speed control processor 759 can still further
include preferences processor 1117 including computer instructions to receive user
preferences with respect to the slow-down areas. Adaptive speed control processor
759 can include wheel command processor 761 including computer instructions to compute
wheel commands 769 based at least on, for example, but not limited to, the virtual
valleys, the collision possible areas, the slow-down areas, and the user preferences,
and provide wheel commands 769 to wheel motor drives 19/31/21/33. When adaptive speed
control processor 759 detects that the MD has entered, for example, a collision possible
area, adaptive speed control processor 759 can, for example, move the MD away from
the collision possible area. Adaptive speed control processor 759 can move the MD
in a direction to the direction opposite the collision possible area, a direction
parallel to the collision possible area, or a direction that moves the MD into a collision
free area.
[0234] Referring now primarily to FIG. 25H, method 1150 for adaptive speed control of the
MD can include, but is not limited to including, receiving 1151 terrain and obstacle
detection data, mapping 1153 terrain and obstacles, if any, in real time based at
least on the terrain and obstacle detection data, optionally computing 1155 virtual
valleys, if any, based at least on the mapped data, computing 1157 collision possible
areas, if any, based at least on the mapped data, computing 1159 slow-down areas if
any based at least on the mapped data and the speed of the MD, receiving 1161 user
preferences, if any, with respect to the slow-down areas and desired direction and
speed of motion, computing 1163 wheel commands 769 (FIG. 25G) based at least on the
collision possible areas, the slow-down areas, and the user preferences and optionally
the virtual valleys, and providing 1165 wheel commands 769 (FIG. 25G) to wheel motor
drives 19/31/21/33 (FIG. 25G). Collision possible areas can include discreet obstacles
that can include a buffer that can follow the contour of the discreet obstacle, or
can follow a type of outline, for example, but not limited to, a polygon, enclosing
the discreet obstacle. Collision possible areas can also include a number of discreet
obstacles viewed as a single discreet obstacle. The transition area between one sub-area
and another can be, for example, abrupt or gradual. The shape of a virtual valley
can be dynamic based at least upon the position of the MD in the virtual valley.
[0235] Referring now to FIG. 251, gradient map 1120 can be used to indicate to the user
at, for example, but not limited to, user controller 130 (FIG. 12A), either periodically
or dynamically updated, the sub-areas in the vicinity of the MD. For example, collision
possible areas 1121 can be places in which adaptive speed control processor 759 can
make it automatically impossible to steer into and the MD can be automatically prevented
from running into objects and can be, for example, but not limited to, steered to
a different direction of travel. In some configurations, the position of the MD can
be measured from the center of the MD and, in some configurations, the edge of the
MD can be substantially near to the physical objects in the vicinity of the MD. In
some configurations, first slow-down areas 1125 can be places in which adaptive speed
control processor 759 can automatically slow down the MD slightly and can make turning
into first slow-down areas 1125 more difficult than turning into no-barriers sub-areas
1127. In some configurations, second slow-down areas 1123 can be places in which adaptive
speed control processor 759 can automatically slow down fore-aft commands to the MD
more than in first slow-down sub-areas 1125, and adaptive speed control processor
759 can automatically make turning into second slow-down sub-areas 1123 harder than
turning into first slow-down sub-areas 1125.
[0236] Referring now to FIG. 25J, path map 1130 can indicate path 1133 that the MD can follow
when adaptive speed control processor 759 (FIG. 25G) recognizes special sub-areas
in the vicinity of the MD. As user controller 130 (FIG. 16A) receives forward velocity
commands, the MD, under the control of adaptive speed control processor 759 (FIG.
25G), can veer according to path 1133 towards no barriers sub-area 1127 and, for example,
turn to a less collision-likely direction of travel.
[0237] Referring now to FIG. 25K, adaptive speed control processor 759 can recognize objects
that are moving (referred to herein as dynamic objects). Terrain/obstacle data receiver
1107 can receive from sensors 1105 terrain/obstacle detection data 1101 that is characteristic
of non-stationary (dynamic) object 1134. Preferences processor 1117 can, for example,
receive joystick commands 629 that indicate that straight path 1132 is the user-selected
direction of travel, but when dynamic object 1134 is ahead of the MD and straight
path 1132 would intersect with dynamic object 1134, dynamic object processor 1119
(FIG. 25G) can designate a set of sub-areas around dynamic object 1134 starting with
first slow down area 1125, then transitioning to second slow-down sub-area 1123, and
finally transitioning to collision possible sub-area 1121. When sensors 1105 recognize
the sub-areas in the vicinity of dynamic object 1134, slow-down processor 1115 can
slow the MD when entering first slow-down sub-area 1125 and dynamic object processor
1119 can match the pace of dynamic object 1134 in second slow-down sub-area 1123.
If preferences processor 1117 receives an aggressive forward command in first slow-down
sub-areas 1125 and/or second slow-down sub-area 1123, or an oblique command, dynamic
object processor 1119 can adjust path 1132 to veer as, for example, in path 1131,
to follow the safest closest path past dynamic object 1134. Forward velocity commands,
in the absence of adaptive speed control processor 759 (FIG. 25G), could have the
MD follow path 1132 directly through first slow-down sub-area 1125, second slow-down
sub-area 1123, and collision possible subarea 1121.
[0238] Referring now primarily to FIG. 26A, traction control processor 762 can adjust the
torque applied to wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) to minimize slipping. In particular, adjusting
the torque can prevent wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) from excessive slipping. When the linear
acceleration measured by inertial sensor packs 1070/23/29/35 and linear acceleration
measured from the wheel velocity disagree by a pre-selected threshold, cluster 21100
(FIG. 6A) can drop such that wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) and caster assemblies 21000 (FIG.
7) are on the ground. Having wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) and caster assemblies 21000 (FIG.
7) on the ground at once can lengthen the wheelbase of the MD and can increase the
friction coefficient between the MD and the ground. Linear acceleration processor
1351 can include computer instructions to compute the acceleration of the MD based
at least on the speed of wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A). IMU acceleration processor 1252 can
include computer instructions to compute the IMU acceleration based at least on sensor
data 767 from inertial sensor pack 1070/23/29/35. Traction loss processor 1254 can
compute the difference between the MD acceleration and the IMU acceleration, and compare
the difference to a pre-selected threshold. If the threshold is exceeded, wheel/cluster
command processor 761 can send cluster commands 771 (FIG. 17A) to cluster 21100 (FIG.
6A) to drop such that wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) and caster assembly 21000 (FIG. 7) are
on the ground. Wheel/cluster command processor 761 can adjust the torque to wheel
motor drives 19/21/31/33 by dynamically adjusting drive current limits if traction
loss is detected. In some configurations, wheel/cluster command processor 761 can
compute torque values for wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A) that can be independent of each other
and based at least on the speed of the MD and the speed of wheels 21201 (FIG. 6A).
In some configurations, traction loss processor 1254 can include computer instructions
to dynamically adjust the center of gravity of the MD, for example, but not limited
to, backwards and forwards to manage traction for the MD.
[0239] Continuing to still further refer to FIG. 26A, in standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B),
cluster 21100 (FIG. 6A) can be rotated to affect traction so that wheels 21201 (FIG.
6A) can come in contact with the ground when aggressive and/or quick braking is requested.
Aggressive braking can occur when the MD is traveling forward and receives a reverse
command from, for example, user controller 130 (FIG. 12A), that exceeds a pre-selected
threshold. In enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B), traction control processor 762 can accomplish
traction control by (1) detecting the loss of traction by taking the difference between
a gyro measured device yaw and differential wheel speed of predicted device yaw, and
(2) reducing the torque to wheel motors drives A/B 19/21/31/33 by dynamically reducing
the drive current limits when loss of traction is detected.
[0240] Referring now primarily to FIG. 26B, method 1250 for controlling traction of the
MD can include, but is not limited to including, computing 1253 the linear acceleration
of the MD, and receiving 1255 the IMU measured acceleration of the MD. If 1257 the
difference between an expected linear acceleration and a measured linear acceleration
of the MD is greater than or equal to a preselected threshold, adjusting 1259 the
torque to cluster/wheel motor drives 19/21/31/33 (FIG. 2C/D). If 1257 the difference
between an expected linear acceleration and a measured linear acceleration of the
MD is less than a preselected threshold, method 1250 can continue testing for loss
of traction (step 1253).
[0241] Referring now to FIG. 27A, tipping of the MD can be controlled to actively stabilize
the MD and to protect against, for example, a rearward fall. In some configurations,
standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A) may not be actively stabilized. If caster wheels 21001
are against an obstacle such that forward motion does not occur, a continuous forward
command can build up. Excess command in this scenario could lead to a rearward fall.
In some configurations, an overall command limit can be placed on the wheel command
to prevent excessive wheel command from building up when the wheels are unable to
move. In some configurations, anti-tipping can be enabled when the rearward pitch
of the MD falls in a range such as, for example, but not limited to, between about
5° and 30°. Tipping control can be disabled when caster wheels 21001 are raised during
frame lean adjustments, or when the MD is transitioning to 4-Wheel mode 100-2, or
under certain conditions in IMU 50003 (FIG. 15C).
[0242] Continuing to refer to FIG. 27A, when the MD is tipped backwards on rear wheels 21201,
the MD can drive rear wheels 21201 backwards to attempt recovery from a potential
rearwards fall. Tipping control can be implemented through the interaction of anti-tip
and wheel controllers, with motor control authority of the two controllers governed
by ramp functions that depend on rearward pitch angle. Wheel speed proportional and
integral errors and pitch proportional and derivative errors can be multiplied by
the ramp functions to change the behavior of the MD on a rearward pitch angle. Pitch
error can be computed relative to a nominal pitch of, for example, but not limited
to, -6.0°. Pitch rate can be filtered to smooth erroneous measurements, and can be
filtered, for example, but not limited to, with a .7Hz filter. A deadband can be applied
to the pitch rate values. Controller gains can be applied as variable functions when
multiplied by ramp functions that vary between 0 and 1 over the range of the pitched
back error. The ramp functions can be used continuously in standard mode 100-1.
[0243] Continuing to refer to FIG. 27A, the wheel controller can compute commands based
on desired wheel velocity from the joystick input while simultaneously responding
to rearward pitch values in order to prevent the chair from falling over backwards.
A PI loop can be used to compute a command based on the wheel velocity error. The
dynamic state of the MD, as characterized by the value of the pitched back error,
can be used to determine which of the terms is used to compute the wheel fore/aft
command. Ramp functions can be based on the pitch of the MD. The ramp functions are
sliding gains that operate on pitch, pitch rate, and wheel errors. The ramp functions
can allow the wheel controller and the anti-tipping controller to interact to maintain
stability and controllability of the MD. Tipping control can be disabled if, for example,
but not limited to, inertial sensors on the MD have not been initialized or if the
inertial estimator has faulted, and if the MD has tipped over.
[0244] Referring now primarily to FIG. 27B, in standard mode wheel control, method 8750
can include determining if 8267 stabilization is possible based on, for example, whether
the MD has already tipped over, or if there has been an inertial estimator fault,
or if the MD is transitioning. If 8267 stabilization is not possible, various actions
can be taken depending on whether or not stabilization is not possible. If 8267 stabilization
is possible, method 8750 can include computing 8255 a stabilization metric based on,
for example, but not limited to, the distance the MD has moved since active stabilization
has been engaged and the measured pitch angle. Method 8750 can include computing 8257
a stabilization factor based on, for example, but not limited to, the measured pitch
angle, filtered to allow only rearward angles and subjected to a proportional gain.
The stabilization factor can be based on the measured pitch rate around which has
been placed a hysteresis band and to which a derivative gain has been applied. Ramp
functions can be applied to the stabilization factor. Method 8750 can include computing
8259 wheel command inputs based on the derivative over time of the desired fore-aft
velocity, the desired fore-aft velocity, the measured fore-aft velocity, the desired
yaw velocity, and the measured yaw velocity. The derivative of the velocity can be
used to compute a feed forward component. The desired and measured fore-aft velocities
can be inputs to a PI controller, and ramp functions can be applied to the result.
The desired and measured yaw velocities can be inputs to a proportional controller.
If 8261 the metric indicates that stabilization is needed, method 8750 can include
computing right/left wheel voltage commands based on the wheel command inputs and
the stabilization factor. If 8261 the metric indicates that stabilization is not needed,
method 8750 can include computing right/left wheel voltage commands based on the wheel
command inputs.
[0245] Referring now primarily to FIG. 27C, the controls to implement method 8750 (FIG.
27B) are shown. Filter 8843 can be applied to measured pitch angle 8841 to allow pitch
rates in the rearward tip direction, and hysteresis band 8849 can be placed around
measured pitch rate 8847. The derivative of desired fore-aft velocity 8853 is used
as a feed forward term in the wheel controller. Desired fore-aft velocity 8853 and
measured fore-aft velocity 8855 can be fed to first proportional-integral (PI) controller
8857, and ramp functions 8859 can be applied to the output of first PI controller
8857. Desired yaw velocity 8861 and measured yaw velocity 8863 can be fed to proportional
controller 8865. If active stabilization is engaged, the measured pitch angle 8841,
filtered and with proportional gain 8845 applied, is combined with measured pitch
rate 8849, modified and with derivative gain 8851 applied. Ramp functions 8867 can
be applied to the combination. Right wheel voltage command 768A and left wheel voltage
command 768B can be based upon the combination result, and the results of PI controller
8857 and proportional controller 8865.
[0246] Continuing to refer to FIG. 27C, the CG fit of the MD can estimate a maximum allowed
acceleration that can help prevent backwards falls based at least on pitch angle θ
705 (FIG. 27A) and a center of gravity determination for the MD. Active stabilization
processor 763 can include a closed loop controller that can maintain the stability
of the MD by automatically decelerating forward motion and accelerating backward motion
when the MD begins tipping backwards. Dynamic metric 845, that can be based at least
on, for example, but not limited to, measured pitch angle, and can control whether
to include the pitch rate feedback in wheel voltage commands 768, thereby metering
the application of active stabilization. Optionally, the anti-tip controller can base
its calculations at least in part on the CG location. If the anti-tip controller drives
the MD backwards beyond a pre-selected distance, the MD can enter failsafe mode.
[0247] Referring now to FIG. 27D, active stabilization processor 763 can include, but is
not limited to including, center of gravity estimator 1301 including computer instructions
to estimate the center of gravity based at least on the mode, and inertial estimator
1303 to estimate the pitch angle required to maintain balance based at least on the
center of gravity estimate. In some configurations, the location of center of gravity
181 (FIG. 27A) can be used to set the frame lean limits. In some configurations, an
estimate of the location of center of gravity 181 (FIG. 27A) can be used to, for example,
but not limited to, actively stabilize mobility device 120 (FIG. 27A) and regulate
transitions between modes. The location of center of gravity 181 (FIG. 27A) can vary
with each user and seat setup combination, and is a function of the height of seat
105 (FIG. 27A) and the position of cluster 21100 (FIG. 3). An estimate of center of
gravity 181 (FIG. 27A) over a range of seat heights and cluster positions that can
occur during normal operation of mobility device 120 (FIG. 27A) can be calculated.
Calibration parameters can be calculated that can be used to determine various reference
pitch angles that can relate the location of center of gravity 181 (FIG. 27A) to the
balance point of the system. The calibration parameters can allow the reference angles
to be calculated every control cycle as the seat height and the cluster position change.
The estimation process can include balancing mobility device 120 (FIG. 27A) and its
load at various angles of cluster 21100 (FIG. 3) and various heights of seat 105 (FIG.
27A), and collecting data at each location including the pitch angle of mobility device
120 (FIG. 27A) with respect to gravity. These data can be used to error check the
result of the estimation process. Powerbase controller 100 can compute reference variables
based at least on the location of center of gravity 181 (FIG. 27A), for example, but
not limited to, (1) the angle of mobility device 120 (FIG. 27A) that places center
of gravity 181 (FIG. 27A) over the axis of cluster 21100 (FIG. 3), a function of the
height of seat 105 (FIG. 27A), used in enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG. 22A), and stair mode
100-4 (FIG. 22A); (2) the angle of powerbase 160 (FIG. 27A) that can place center
of gravity 181 (FIG. 27A) over one set of wheels 21201 (FIG. 27A), a function of the
height of seat 105 (FIG. 27A) and the position of cluster 21100 (FIG. 3), used in
balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22A); and (3) the distance from a pivot point of cluster
21100 (FIG. 3) to an estimated center of gravity, a function of the height of seat
105 (FIG. 27A), used in standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22A) and stair mode 100-4 (FIG.
22A). These values can allow the controllers to maintain active balance.
[0248] Referring now to FIG. 27E, method 11350 for computing center of gravity fit (CG fit)
can include, but is not limited to including, (1) entering 11351 the balancing mode,
(2) measuring 11353 data including a pitch angle required to maintain the balancing
the balance at a pre-selected position of the at least one wheel cluster and a pre-selected
position of the seat, (3) moving 11355 the mobility device/user pair to a plurality
of pre-selected points and collecting calibration data at each of the plurality of
pre-selected points, (4) repeating 11357 steps (2) and (3) at each of the plurality
of pre-selected points, (5) verifying 11359 that the measured data fall within pre-selected
limits, and (6) generating 11361 a set of calibration coefficients to establishing
the center of gravity at any usable cluster and seat position during machine operation
based on the verified measured data. Method 11350 can optionally include storing the
coefficients into, for example, but not limited to, non-volatile memory for use during
operation of mobility device 120 (FIG. 27A). A method for entering a vehicle while
seated in the MD can include, but is not limited to including, receiving an indication
that the MD is encountering a ramp between the ground and the vehicle, directing the
clusters of wheels to maintain contact with the ground, changing the orientation of
the cluster of wheels according to the indication to maintain the device center of
gravity between the wheels, and dynamically adjusting the distance between the seat
and the clusters of wheels to prevent contact between the seat and wheels while keeping
the seat as low as possible. The MD and the user can clear the doorjam of the vehicle
if the seat remains as low and as close to the clusters of wheels as possible, and
if the MD is actively stabilized while the MD traverses the ramp into and out of the
vehicle. A method for moving a balancing mobility device on relatively steep terrain
can include, but is not limited to including, receiving an indication that the mobility
device is upon the steep terrain, directing the clusters of wheels to maintain contact
with the ground, and dynamically adjusting the distance between the seat and the clusters
of wheels based at least on the indication and active stabilization of the mobility
device. The method can optionally include setting a travel speed of the mobility device
based on the indication.
[0249] Referring now primarily to FIG. 28A, controller gains, for certain loads on the MD,
can be a function of the weight of the load, and stability of the MD is a function
of at least the controller gains. Controller gains can include, but are not limited
to including, gains applied during enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B) to stabilize the
MD when, for example, the load is light, or when transitioning into balance mode 100-3
(FIG. 22B). Powerbase controller 100 can include at least one default value for the
center of gravity for the MD. The weight of the load on the MD can determine which
default value for the center of gravity is used. The weight of the load, and/or the
change of weight of the load, and the chosen default value of the center of gravity
can be used to adjust controller gains. Controller gains can include a range of discreet
values or analog values. For example, if the load falls out of the seat, the MD can
experience relatively large accelerations resulting from a relatively small input
torque. In some configurations, the change in load weight on the seat can change the
controller gain based at least on the load weight. Weight processor 757 can adjust
the stability of the MD based at least on the change in load weight. Weight processor
757 can determine the weight of the load based at least on, for example, but not limited
to, motor current of seat motor 45/47 (FIG. 18C/18D). Weight processor 757 can potentially
detect unstable situations by, for example, but not limited to, processing collected
pitch rate data using a rolling discrete fast Fourier transform, recognizing values
of the resulting pitch rate frequency that could represent instability-generating
changes, filtering the pitch rate frequencies based at least on the recognized values,
squaring the filtered pitch rate frequencies, and analyzing the squared pitch rate
frequencies based at least on known profiles of potential instability. Weight processor
757 for stabilizing the MD can include, but is not limited to including, weight estimation
processor 956 including computer instructions to estimate the weight of a load on
the MD, controller gains processor 947 including computer instructions to compute
controller gains based at least on the weight, and wheel command processor 761 applying
the controller gains to control the MD.
[0250] Referring now primarily to FIG. 28B, method 800 for stabilizing the MD can include,
but is not limited to including, estimating 851 the weight and/or change in weight
of a load on the MD, choosing 853 a default value or values for the center of gravity
of the MD, computing 855 controller gains based at least on the weight and/or change
in weight and the center of gravity values, and applying 857 the controller gains
to control the MD.
[0251] Referring now primarily to FIG. 28C, weight-current processor can measure the weight
of the load on the MD. Weight-current processor 758 can include, but is not limited
to including, position and function receiver 1551, motor current processor 1552, and
torque-weight processor 1553. Position and function receiver 1551 can receive sensor
data 767 and mode information 776 to determine possible actions that can be taken
with respect to the load. Motor current processor 1552 can process measured electrical
current to seat motor drive 25/37 (FIG. 18C/18D) when, for example, but not limited
to, the MD is transitioning to enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B). Since the motor current
is proportional to torque, torque-weight processor 1553 can use the current readings
to provide an estimate of the torque required to lift the load in the seat. In some
configurations, for an exemplary motor, MD geometry, and height of the seat, the weight
of the load on the seat can be computed as follows, where SC = seat correction, SH
= seat height, and MC = motor current:

where
a and
b are constants determined by the geometry of the MD.

If MC (corrected) > T then weight = c*MC (corrected) *MC (corrected) +
d*MC (corrected) - e, where
c,
d, and e are constants relating the motor current to the user, seat, and UC weight.
The total system weight is the sum of the user/seat/UC weight and the weight of the
powerbase and the wheels.
[0252] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 28C, when the seat reaches a stable position
and when the seat brake is engaged, there is no current going through the motor windings.
When the seat brake is released, the current that is required to hold the position
of the seat can be measured. In some configurations, the weight of the load can be
estimated by computing a continuous estimate of the weight based at least on continuous
monitoring of the current signal from seat motor processors 45/47 (FIG. 18C/18D).
Predicting abrupt changes in weight can be based at least on, for example, but not
limited to, accelerometer data, current data from other than seat motor processors
45/47 (FIG. 18C/18D), the current required to slew cluster 21100 (FIG. 6A), and wheel
acceleration. The specific predictor can be based at least on whether the MD is stationary
or moving.
[0253] Referring now primarily to FIG. 28D, method 900 for computing the weight on the MD
can include, but is not limited to including, receiving 951 the position of a load
on the MD, receiving 953 the setting of the MD to standard mode 100-1 (FIG. 22B),
measuring 955 the motor current required to move the MD to enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG.
22B) at least once, computing 957 a torque based at least on the motor current, computing
959 a weight of the load based at least on the torque, and adjusting 961 controller
gains based at least on the weight to stabilize the MD.
[0254] Referring now to FIG. 29A, the MD can provide enhanced functionality 145 to a user,
for example, but not limited to, assisting a user in avoiding obstacles, traversing
doors, traversing stairs, traveling on elevators, and parking/transporting the MD.
In general, The MD can receive user input (for example UI data 633) and/or input from
the MD through, for example, but not limited to, messages from user interface devices
and sensors 147. The MD can further receive sensor input through, for example, but
not limited to sensor processing systems 661. UI data 633 and output from sensor processing
systems 661, for example, can inform command processor 601 to invoke the mode that
has been automatically or manually selected. Command processor 601 can pass UI data
633 and output from sensor processing systems 661 to a processor that can enable the
invoked mode. The processor can generate movement commands 630 at least based on previous
movement commands 630, UI data 633, and output from sensor processing systems 661.
[0255] Continuing to refer to FIG. 29A, the MD can include, but is not limited to including,
command processor 601, movement processor 603, simultaneous location and mapping (SLAM)
processor 609, point cloud library (PCL) processor 611, geometry processor 613, and
obstacle processor 607. Command processor 601 can receive user interface (Ul) data
633 from the message bus. UI data 633 can include, but is not limited to including,
signals from, for example, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) providing an indication of a
desired movement direction and speed of the MD. UI data 633 can also include selections
such as an alternate mode into which the MD could be transitioned. In some configurations,
in addition to the modes described with respect to FIG. 22B, the MD can process mode
selections such as, but not limited to, door mode 605A, rest room mode 605B, enhanced
stair mode 605C, elevator mode 605D, mobile park mode 605E, and static storage/charging
mode 605F. Any of these modes can include a move-to-position mode, or the user can
direct the MD to move to a certain position. Message bus 54 can receive control information
in the form of UI data 633 for the MD, and can receive a result of the processing
done by the MD in the form of commands such as movement commands 630 that can include,
but are not limited to including, speed and direction. Movement commands 630 can be
provided, by message bus 54, to The MD which can transmit this information to wheel
motor drives 19/21/31/33 (FIGs. 18C/18D) and cluster motor drives 1050/27 (FIGs. 18C/18D).
Movement commands 630 can be determined by movement processor 603 based on information
provided by the mode-specific processors. Mode-specific processors can determine mode-dependent
data 657, among other things, based on information provided through sensor-handling
processors 661.
[0256] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 29A, sensor-handling processors 661 can include,
but are not limited to including, MD geometry processor 613, PCL processor 611, SLAM
processor 609, and obstacle processor 607. Movement processor 603 can provide movement
commands 630 to the sensor-handling processors 661 to provide information necessary
to determine future movements of the MD. Sensors 147 can provide environmental information
651 that can include, for example, but not limited to, obstacles 623 and geometric
information about the MD. In some configurations, sensors 147 can include at least
one time-of-flight sensor that can be mounted anywhere on the MD. There can be multiple
of sensors 147 mounted on the MD. PCL processor 611 can gather and process environmental
information 651, and can produce PCL data 655. The PCL, a group of code libraries
for processing 2D/3D image data, can, for example, assist in processing environmental
information 651. Other processing techniques can be used.
[0257] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 29A, MD geometry processor 613 can receive
MD geometry information 649 from sensors 147, can perform any processing necessary
to prepare MD geometry information 649 for use by the mode-dependent processors, and
can provide the processed of MD geometry information 649 to the mode-dependent processors.
The geometry of the MD can be used for, but is not limited to being used for, automatically
determining whether or not the MD can fit in and/or through a space such as, for example,
a stairway and a door. SLAM processor 609 can determine navigation information 653
based on, for example, but not limited to, UI data 633, environmental information
651 and movement commands 630. The MD can travel in a path at least in part set out
by navigation information 653. Obstacle processor 607 can locate obstacles 623 and
distances 621 to obstacles 623. Obstacles 623 can include, but are not limited to
including, doors, stairs, automobiles, and miscellaneous features in the vicinity
of the path of the MD.
[0258] Referring now to FIGs. 29B and 29C, method 650 for processing at least one obstacle
623 (FIG. 29D) while navigating the MD can include, but is not limited to including,
receiving at least one movement command, and receiving and segmenting 1151 (FIG. 29B)
PCL data 655 (FIG. 29D), identifying 1153 (FIG. 29B) at least one plane within the
segmented PCL data 655 (FIG. 29D), and identifying 1155 (FIG. 29B) at least one obstacle
623 (FIG. 29D) within the at least one plane. Method 650 can further include determining
1157 (FIG. 29B) at least one situation identifier 624 (FIG. 29D) based at least on
the at least one obstacle, UI data 633 (FIG. 29D), and movement commands 630 (FIG.
29D), and determining 1159 (FIG. 29B) distance 621 (FIG. 29D) between the MD and at
least one obstacle 623 (FIG. 29D) based at least on at least one situation identifier
624 (FIG. 29D). Method 650 can also include accessing 1161 (FIG. 29B) at least one
allowed command related to distance 621 (FIG. 29D), at least one obstacle 623 (FIG.
29D), and at least one situation identifier 624 (FIG. 29D). Method 650 can still further
include accessing 1163 (FIG. 29B) at least one automatic response to the at least
one allowed command, mapping 1167 (FIG. 29C) at least one movement command 630 (FIG.
29D) with one of the at least one allowed commands, and providing 1169 (FIG. 29C)
at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29D) and the at least one automatic response
associated with the mapped allowed command to the mode-dependent processors.
[0259] Continuing to refer to FIGs. 29B and 29C, at least one obstacle 623 (FIG. 29D) can
optionally include at least one stationary object and/or at least one moving object.
Distance 621 (FIG. 29D) can optionally include a fixed amount and/or a dynamically-varying
amount. At least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29D) can optionally include a follow
command, at least one pass-the-at-least-one-obstacle command, a travel beside-the-at-least-one-obstacle
command, and a do-not-follow-the-at-least-one obstacle command. Method 650 can optionally
include storing obstacle data 623 (FIG. 29D), and allowing access to stored obstacle
data, for example, stored in cloud storage 607G (FIG. 29D) and/or local storage 607H
(FIG. 29D), by systems external to the MD. PCL data 655 (FIG. 29D) can optionally
include sensor data 147 (FIG. 29A). Method 650 can optionally include collecting sensor
data 147 (FIG. 29A) from at least one time-of-flight sensor mounted on the MD, analyzing
sensor data 147 (FIG. 29A) using a point cloud library (PCL), tracking the at least
one moving object using simultaneous location and mapping (SLAM) with detection and
tracking of moving objects (DATMO) based on the location of the MD, identifying the
at least one plane within obstacle data 623 (FIG. 29D) using, for example, but not
limited to, random sample consensus and a PCL library, and providing the at least
one automatic response associated with the mapped allowed command to the mode-dependent
processors. Method 650 can also optionally include receiving a resume command, and
providing, following the resume command, at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29D)
and the at least one automatic response associated with the mapped allowed command
to the mode-dependent processors. The at least one automatic response can optionally
include a speed control command.
[0260] Referring now to FIG. 29D, obstacle processor 607 for processing at least one obstacle
623 while navigating the MD can include, but is not limited to including, nav/PCL
data processor 607F receiving and segmenting PCL data 655 from PCL processor 611,
identifying at least one plane within the segmented PCL data 655, and identifying
at least one obstacle 623 within the at least one plane. Obstacle processor 607 can
further include distance processor 607E determining at least one situation identifier
624 based at least on UI data 633, at least one movement command 630, and at least
one obstacle 623. Distance processor 607E can determine distance 621 between the MD
and at least one obstacle 623 based at least on at least one situation identifier
624. Moving object processor 607D and/or stationary object processor 607C can access
at least one allowed command related to distance 621, at least one obstacle 623, and
at least one situation identifier 624. Moving object processor 607D and/or stationary
object processor 607C can access at least one automatic response, from automatic response
list 627, associated with the at least one allowed command. Moving object processor
607D and/or stationary object processor 607C can access at least one movement command
630 including, for example, speed/signal command and direction command/signal, and
map at least one movement command 630 with one of the at least one allowed commands.
Moving object processor 607D and/or stationary object processor 607C can provide at
least one movement command 630 and the at least one automatic response associated
with the mapped allowed command to the mode-dependent processors.
[0261] Continuing to refer to FIG. 29D, stationary object processor 607C can optionally
perform any special processing necessary when encountering at least one stationary
object, and moving object processor 607D can optionally perform any special processing
necessary when encountering at least one moving object. Distance processor 607E can
optionally process distance 621 that can be a fixed and/or a dynamically-varying amount.
At least one movement command 630 can optionally include a follow command, a pass
command, a travel-beside command, a move-to-position command, and a do-not-follow
command. Nav/PCL processor 607F can optionally store obstacles 623, for example, but
not limited to, in local storage 607H and/or on storage cloud 607G, and can allow
access to the stored obstacles 623 by systems external to the MD such as, for example,
but not limited to, external applications 140 (FIG. 16B). PCL processor 611 can optionally
collect sensor data 147 (FIG. 29A) from at least one time-of-flight camera mounted
on the MD, and can analyze sensor data 147 (FIG. 29A) using a point cloud library
(PCL) to yield PCL data 655. Moving object processor 607D can optionally track the
at least one moving object using navigation information 653 collected by simultaneous
location and mapping (SLAM) processor 609 based on the location of the MD, identify
the at least one plane using, for example, but not limited to, random sample consensus
and a PCL library, and can provide at least one movement command 630 based on the
at least one automatic response associated with the mapped allowed command to the
mode-dependent processors. Obstacle processor 607 can optionally receive a resume
command, and provide, following the resume command, at least one movement command
630 based on the at least one automatic response associated with the mapped allowed
command to the mode-dependent processors. The at least one automatic response can
optionally include a speed control command. For example, if joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A)
indicates a direction that could position the MD in a collision course with obstacle
623, such as, for example, a wall, the at least one automatic response can include
speed control to protect the MD from a collision. The at least one automatic response
could be overridden by a contrary user command, for example, joystick 70007 (FIG.
12A) could be released and movement of the MD could be halted. Joystick 70007 (FIG.
12A) could then be re-engaged to restart movement of the MD towards obstacle 623.
[0262] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 29E-29H, environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A)
can be received from sensors 147 (FIG. 29A). The MD can process environmental information
651 (FIG. 29A). In some configurations, PCL processor 611 (FIG. 29A) can process environmental
information 651 (FIG. 29A) using, for example, and depending upon sensor 147 (FIG.
29A), point cloud library (PCL) functions. As the MD moves along travel path 2001
(FIG. 29H) around potential obstacles 2001A, sensors 147 (FIG. 29A) can detect a cloud
of points from, for example, and depending upon sensor 147 (FIG. 29A), box 2005 (FIGs.
29G-29H) that can include data that could take the shape of frustum 2003 (FIGs. 29F-29H).
A sample consensus method, for example, but not limited to, the random sample consensus
method, from, for example, but not limited to, the PCL, can be used to find a plane
among the cloud of points. The MD can create a projected cloud and can determine point
cloud inliers, and from these, determine a centroid of the projected cloud. Central
reference point 148 can be used to determine the location of environmental features
with respect to the MD. For example, whether the MD is moving towards or away from
an obstacle, or where a door hinge is with respect to the MD can be determined based
on the location of central reference point 148. Sensors 147 (FIG. 29A) can include,
for example, time-of-flight sensor 147A.
[0263] Referring now primarily to FIG. 29I, method 750 for enabling the MD to navigate stairs
can include, but is not limited to including, receiving 1251 at least one stair command,
and receiving 1253 environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A) from sensors 147 (FIG.
29A) mounted on the MD through obstacle processor 607 (FIG. 29A). Method 750 can further
include locating 1255, based on environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A), at least
one of staircases 643 (FIG. 29J) within environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A),
and receiving 1257 selection of selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J) from the at least
one of staircases 643 (FIG. 29J). Method 750 can still further include measuring 1259
at least one characteristic 645 (FIG. 29J) of selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J),
and locating 1261, based on environmental information 651 (FIG. 29J), obstacles 623
(FIG. 29J), if any, on selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J). Method 750 can also include
locating 1263, based on environmental information 651 (FIG. 29J), a last stair of
selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J), and providing 1265 movement commands 630 (FIG.
29J) to move the MD on selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J) based on the measured at
least one characteristic 645 (FIG. 29J), the last stair, and obstacles 623 (FIG. 29J),
if any. If 1267 the last stair has not been reached, method 750 can continue providing
movement commands 630 (FIG. 29J) to move the MD. Method 750 can optionally include
locating at least one of staircases 643 (FIG. 29J) based on GPS data, and building
and saving a map of selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J) using, for example, but not
limited to, SLAM. Method 750 can also optionally include accessing geometry 649 (FIG.
29J) of the MD, comparing geometry 649 (FIG. 29J) to at least one of characteristics
645 (FIG. 29J) of selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J), and modifying the step of navigating
based on the step of comparing. At least one of characteristics 645 (FIG. 29J) can
optionally include the height of at least one riser of selected staircase 643A (FIG.
29J), the surface texture of the at least one riser, and the surface temperature of
the at least one riser. Method 750 can optionally include generating an alert if the
surface temperature falls outside of a threshold range and the surface texture falls
outside of a traction set. The threshold range can optionally include temperatures
below 33°F. The traction set can optionally include a carpet texture. Method 750 can
further include determining, based on environmental information 651 (FIG. 29J), the
topography of an area surrounding selected staircase 643A (FIG. 29J), and generating
an alert if the topography is not flat. Method 750 can still further optionally include
accessing a set of extreme circumstances.
[0264] Referring now primarily to FIG. 29J, automated navigation of stairs can be enabled
by stair processor 605C for enabling the MD to navigate stairs. Sensors 147 (FIG.
29A) on the MD can determine if any environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A) includes
at least one staircase 643. In conjunction with any automatic determination of a location
of at least one staircase 643, UI data 633 can include the selection of stair mode
215 (FIG. 22B) which can invoke an automatic, semi-automatic, or semi-manual stair-climbing
process. Either automatic location of at least one staircase 643 or reception of UI
data 633 can invoke stair processor 605C for enhanced stair navigation functions.
Stair processor 605C can receive data from obstacle processor 607 such as, for example,
at least one obstacle 623, distance 621 to at least one obstacle 623, situation 624,
navigation information 653, and geometry information 649 for the MD. Navigation information
can include, but is not limited to including, a possible path for the MD to traverse.
At least one obstacle 623 can include, among other obstacles, at least one staircase
643. Stair processor 605C can locate at least one staircase 643, and can either automatically
or otherwise determine selected staircase 643A based on, for example, but not limited
to, navigation information 653 and/or UI data 633 and/or MD geometry information 649.
Characteristics 645 of selected staircase 643A, such as, for example, riser information,
can be used to determine a first stair and distance to next stair 640. Stair processor
605C can determine movement commands 630 of the MD based on, for example, but not
limited to, characteristics 645, distance 621, and navigation information 647. Movement
processor 603 can move the MD based on movement commands 630, and distance to next
stair 640, and can transfer control to sensor processing 661 after a stair from selected
staircase 643A has been traversed. Sensor processing 661 can either proceed with navigating
selected staircase 643A or can continue following the path set out by navigation information
653, depending upon whether the MD has completed traversing selected staircase 643A.
While the MD is traversing selected staircase 643A, obstacle processor 607 can detect
obstacles 623 on selected staircase 643A and stair processor 605C can provide movement
commands 630 to avoid obstacles 623. Locations of obstacles 623 can be stored for
future use locally to the MD and/or external to the MD.
[0265] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 29J, stair processor 605C can include, but
is not limited to including, staircase processor 641B receiving at least one stair
command included in UI data 633, and staircase locator 641A receiving environmental
information 651 (FIG. 29A) from sensors 147 (FIG. 29A) mounted on the MD through obstacle
processor 607 (FIG. 29A). Staircase locator 641A can further locate, based on environmental
information 651 (FIG. 29A), at least one of staircases 643 within environmental information
651 (FIG. 29A), and can receive the choice of selected staircase 643A from at least
one of staircases 643. Selected staircase 643A can be stored in storage 643B for possible
future use. Stair characteristics processor 641C can measure at least one of characteristics
645 of selected staircase 643A, and can locate, based on environmental information
651, at least one obstacle 623, if any, on selected staircase 643A. Stair movement
processor 641D can locate, based on environmental information 651, a last stair of
selected staircase 643A, and provide to movement processor 603 movement commands 630
for the MD to move on selected staircase 643A based on the measured at least one of
characteristics 645, the last stair, and at least one obstacle 623, if any. Staircase
locator 641A can optionally locate at least one of staircases 643 based on GPS data,
and can build and save a map of selected staircase 643A using SLAM. The map can be
saved for use locally to the MD, and/or for use by other devices. Staircase processor
641B can optionally access geometry 649 of the MD, compare geometry 649 to at least
one of characteristics 645 of selected staircase 643A, and can modify the navigation
of the MD based on the comparison. Staircase processor 641B can optionally generate
an alert if the surface temperature of the risers of selected staircase 643A falls
outside of a threshold range and the surface texture of selected staircase 643A falls
outside of a traction set. Stair movement processor 641D can optionally determine,
based on environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A), the topography of an area surrounding
selected staircase 643A, and can generate an alert if the topography is not flat.
Stair movement processor 641D can optionally access a set of extreme circumstances.
[0266] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 29K-29L, method 850 for negotiating door 675 (FIG.
29M) while maneuvering the MD, where door 675 (FIG. 29M) can include a door swing,
a hinge location, and a doorway, can include, but is not limited to including, receiving
and segmenting 1351 (FIG. 29K) environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A) from sensors
147 (FIG. 29A) mounted on the MD. Environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A) can include
geometry of the MD. Method 850 can include identifying 1353 (FIG. 29K) at least one
plane within the segmented sensor data, and identifying 1355 (FIG. 29K) door 675 (FIG.
29M) within the at least one plane. Method 850 can further include measuring 1357
(FIG. 29K) door 675 (FIG. 29M) to provide door measurements. Method 850 can also include
determining 1361 (FIG. 29K) the door swing. Method 850 can further include providing
1363 (FIG. 29L) at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29M) to move the MD for access
to a handle of door 675 (FIG. 29M), and providing 1365 (FIG. 29L) at least one movement
command 630 (FIG. 29M) to move the MD away from door 675 (FIG. 29M), as door 675 (FIG.
29M) opens, by a distance based on the door measurements. If door 675 (FIG. 29M) swings
in, method 850 can include providing at least one movement command to move the MD
against door 675 (FIG. 29M), thus positioning door 675 (FIG. 29M) for movement of
the MD through the doorway. Method 850 can also include providing 1367 (FIG. 29L)
at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29M) to move the MD forward through the doorway,
the MD maintaining door 675 (FIG. 29M) in an open position, if the door swing is towards
the MD.
[0267] Referring now to FIG. 29M, sensor processing 661 can determine, through information
from sensors 147 (FIG. 29A), the hinge side of door 675, and the direction, angle,
and distance of door. Movement processor 603 can generate commands to the MD such
as start/stop turning left, start/stop turning right, start/stop moving forward, start/stop
moving backwards, and can facilitate door mode 605A by stopping the MD, cancelling
the goal that the MD can be aiming to complete, and centering joystick 70007 (FIG.
12A). Door processor 671B can determine whether door 675 is, for example, push to
open, pull to open, or a slider. Door processor 671B can determine the width of door
675 by determining the current position and orientation of the MD, and determining
the x/y/z location of the door pivot point. If door processor 671B determines that
the number of valid points in the image of door 675 derived from obstacles 623 and/or
PCL data 655 (FIG. 29A) is greater than a threshold, door processor 671B can determine
the distance from the MD to door 675. Door processor 671B can determine if door 675
is moving based on successive samples of PCL data 655 (FIG. 29A) from sensor processor
661. In some configurations, door processor 671B can assume that a side of the MD
is even with the handle side of door 675, and can use that assumption, along with
the position of the door pivot point, to determine the width of door 675.
[0268] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 29M, if the movement of door 675 is towards
the MD, door movement processor 671D can generate and provide movement commands 630
to movement processor 603 to move the MD backward by a pre-determined or dynamically-determined
percentage of the amount door 675 is moving. Movement processor 603 can provide movement
commands 630 to the MD, and the MC can accept GUI data 633A and provide GUI data 633A
to movement processor 603. If door 675 is moving away from the MD, door movement processor
671D can generate movement commands 630 to direct the MD to move forward by a pre-determined
or dynamically-determined percentage of the amount that door 675 moves. The amount
the MD moves either forward or backward can be based on the width of door 675. Door
processor 671B can locate the side of door 675 that provides the open/close function
for door 675 based on the location of the door pivot point. Door processor 671B can
determine the distance to the plane in front of sensors 147 (FIG. 16B). Door movement
processor 671D can generate movement commands 630 to direct the MD to move through
door 675. Door movement processor 671D can wait a pre-selected amount of time for
the move of the MD to complete, and door movement processor 671D can generate movement
commands 630 to adjust the location of the MD based on the position of door 675. Door
processor 671B can determine the door angle and the door pivot point. Door processor
671B can determine if door 675 is stationary, can determine if door 675 is moving,
and can determine the direction door 675 is moving. When door mode 605A is complete,
door movement processor 671D can generate movement commands 630 that can direct the
MD to discontinue movement.
[0269] Continuing to still further refer primarily to FIG. 29M, door mode 605A for negotiating
door 675 while maneuvering the MD, where door 675 can include a door swing, a hinge
location, and a doorway, can include, but is not limited to including, sensor processing
661 receiving and segmenting environmental information 651 from sensors 147 (FIG.
29A) mounted on the MD, where environmental information 651 can include geometry 649
of the MD. Door mode 605A can also include door locator 671A identifying at least
one plane within the segmented sensor data, and identifying door 675 within the at
least one plane. Door processor 671B can include measuring door 675 to provide door
measurements 645A. Door movement processor 671D can provide at least one movement
command 630 to move the MD away from door 675 if door measurements 645A are smaller
than geometry 649 of the MD. Door processor 671B can also include determining the
door swing, and door movement processor 671D can provide at least one movement command
630 to move the MD forward through the doorway. The MD can open door 675 and maintain
door 675 in an open position if the door swing is away from the MD. Door movement
processor 671D can provide at least one movement command 630 to move the MD for access
to a handle of door 675, and can provide at least one movement command 630 to move
the MD away from door 675, as door 675 opens, by a distance based on door measurements
645A. Door movement processor 671D can provide at least one movement command 630 to
move the MD forward through the doorway. The MD can maintain door 675 in an open position
if the door swing is towards the MD.
[0270] Referring now to FIG. 29N, the MD can automatically negotiate using rest room facilities.
The MD can automatically locate a door to a rest room, and to a rest room stall, if
there are multiple doors, can automatically generate movement commands 630 (FIG. 29O)
to move the MD through the door(s), and can automatically position the MD relative
to rest room fixtures. After use of the rest room fixtures is complete, the MD can
automatically locate the door(s) and automatically generate movement commands 630
(FIG. 29O) to move the MD through the door(s) to exit the rest room stall and/or rest
room. Method 950 for negotiating, in the MD, a rest room stall in a rest room, where
the rest room stall can have door 675 (FIG. 29O), and door 675 (FIG. 29O) can have
a door threshold and a door swing, can include, but is not limited to including, providing
1451 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to cause the MD to traverse the
door threshold entering the rest room. Method 950 can also include providing 1453
at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to position the MD for accessing an egress
handle of the door, and providing 1455 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O)
to move the MD away from door 675 (FIG. 29O), as door 675 (FIG. 29O) closes, if the
door swing is towards the MD. Method 950 can also include providing 1457 at least
one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to move the MD (FIG. 100) toward door 675 (FIG.
29O), as door 675 (FIG. 29O) closes, if the door swing is away from the MD, and providing
1459 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to position the MD alongside a first
rest room fixture. Method 950 can include providing 1461 at least one movement command
630 (FIG. 29O) to stop the MD, and can include providing 1463 at least one movement
command 630 (FIG. 29O) to position the MD near a second rest room fixture. Method
950 can include providing 1465 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to traverse
the door threshold to exit the rest room stall.
[0271] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 29N, automatically traversing the door threshold
can optionally include, but is not limited to including, receiving and segmenting
1351 (FIG. 29K) environmental information 651 (FIG. 29A) from sensors 147 (FIG. 29A)
mounted on the MD. Environmental information 651 (FIG. 10) can include geometry of
the MD. Automatically traversing the door threshold can also optionally include identifying
1353 (FIG. 29K) at least one plane within the segmented sensor data, and identifying
1355 (FIG. 29K) door 675 (FIG. 29M) within the at least one plane. Automatically traversing
the door threshold can further optionally include measuring 1357 (FIG. 29K) door 675
(FIG. 29M) to provide door measurements, and providing 1359 (FIG. 29K) at least one
movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to move the MD away from door 675 (FIG. 29M) if the
door measurements are smaller than geometry 649 (FIG. 29M) of the MD. Automatically
traversing the door threshold can also optionally include determining 1361 (FIG. 29K)
the door swing, and providing 1363 (FIG. 29K) at least one movement command 630 (FIG.
29O) to move the MD forward through the doorway, the MD opening door 675 (FIG. 29M)
and maintaining door 675 (FIG. 1A) in an open position, if the door swing is away
from the MD. Automatically traversing the door threshold can further optionally include
providing 1365 (FIG. 29L) at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to move the
MD for access to a handle of the door, and providing 1367 (FIG. 29L) at least one
movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to move the MD away from door 675 (FIG. 29M), as door
675 (FIG. 29M) opens, by a distance based on the door measurements. Automatically
traversing the door threshold can also optionally include providing 1369 (FIG. 29L)
at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to move the MD forward through the doorway,
the MD maintaining door 675 (FIG. 29M) in an open position, if the door swing is towards
the MD. Method 950 can optionally include automatically locating the rest room, and
automatically driving the MD to the rest room. SLAM techniques can optionally be used
to locate a destination, for example, a rest room. The MD can optionally access a
database of frequently-visited locations, can receive a selection one of the frequently-visited
locations, and can provide at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29O) to move the
MD to the selected location which can include, for example, but not limited to, a
rest room.
[0272] Referring now to FIG. 29O, rest room mode 605B for negotiating, in the MD, a rest
room stall in a rest room, where the rest room stall can have a door, and the door
can have a door threshold and a door swing, can include, but is not limited to including,
door mode 605A providing at least one movement command 630 to cause the MD to traverse
the door threshold entering the rest room. The rest room can also include fixtures
such as for example, but not limited to, toilets, sinks, and changing tables. Entry/exit
processor 681C can provide at least one movement command 630 to position the MD for
accessing an egress handle of the door, and can providing at least one movement command
630 to move the MD away from the door, as the door closes, if the door swing is towards
the MD. Entry/exit processor 681C can provide at least one movement command 630 to
move the MD toward door 675, as door 675 closes, if the swing of door 675 is away
from the MD. Fixture processor 681B can provide at least one movement command 630
to position the MD alongside a first rest room fixture, and can provide at least one
movement command to stop the MD. Fixture processor 681B can also provide at least
one movement command 630 to position the MD near a second rest room fixture. Entry/exit
processor 681C can provide at least one movement command 630 to traverse the door
threshold to exit the rest room stall.
[0273] Referring now to FIGs. 29P and 29Q, method 1051 for automatically storing the MD
in a vehicle, such as, for example, but not limited to, an accessible van, can assist
a user in independent use of the vehicle. When the user exits the MD and enters the
vehicle, possibly as the vehicle's driver, the MD can remain parked outside of the
vehicle. If the MD is to accompany the user in the vehicle for later use, mobile park
mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can provide movement commands 630 (FIG. 29R) to the MD to cause
the MD to store itself either automatically or upon command, and to be recalled to
the door of the vehicle as well. The MD can be commanded to store itself through commands
received from external applications 140 (FIG. 16B), for example. In some configurations,
a computer-driven device such as a cell phone, laptop, and/or tablet can be used to
execute external application 140 (FIG. 16B) and generate information that could ultimately
control the MD. In some configurations, the MD can automatically proceed to mobile
park mode 605E after the user exits the MD when the MD has been placed in park mode
by, for example, the user. Movement commands 630 (FIG. 29R) can include commands to
locate the door of the vehicle at which the MD will enter to be stored, and to direct
the MD to the door. Mobile park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can determine error conditions
such as, for example, but not limited to, if the door is too small for the MD to enter
and can alert the user of the error condition through, for example, but not limited
to, an audio alert through audio interface 150A (FIG. 16B) and/or a message to external
application 140 (FIG. 16B). If the door is wide enough for the MD to enter, mobile
park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can provide vehicle control commands to command the vehicle
to open the door. Mobile park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can determine when the vehicle
door is open and whether or not there is space for the MD to be stored. Mobile park
mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can invoke obstacle processing 607 (FIG. 29M) to assist in determining
the status of the vehicle door and if there is room in the vehicle to store the MD.
If mobile park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) determines that there is enough room for the MD,
mobile park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can provide movement commands 630 (FIG. 29R) to move
the MD into the storage space in the vehicle. Mobile park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can
provide vehicle control commands to command the vehicle to lock the MD into place,
and to close the vehicle door. When the MD is again needed, external application 140
(FIG. 16B), for example, can be used to invoke mobile park mode 605E. Mobile park
mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can recall the status of the MD and can begin processing by providing
vehicle control commands to command the vehicle to unlock the MD and open the door
of the vehicle. Mobile park mode 605E (FIG. 29R) can once again locate the door of
the vehicle, or can access the location of the door from, for example, local storage
607H (FIG. 29M) and/or cloud storage 607G (FIG. 29M). Mobile park mode 605E (FIG.
29R) can provide movement commands 630 (FIG. 29R) to move the MD through the vehicle
door and to the passenger door to which it had been summoned by, for example, external
application 140 (FIG. 16B). In some configurations, the vehicle can be tagged in places
such as, for example, the entry door for storage of the MD. Mobile park mode 605E
can recognize the tags, such as, for example, but not limited to, fiducials, bar codes,
and/or QR CODES
® tags, and can execute the method described herein as a result of recognizing the
tags. Other tags can be included, such as tags within the storage compartment to indicate
the proper storage location and tags on vehicle passenger doors. The tags can be RFID
enabled, for example, and the MD can include an RFID reader.
[0274] Continuing to refer primarily to FIGs. 29P and 29Q, method 1051 for automatically
storing the MD in a vehicle can include, but is not limited to including, providing
1551 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29R) to locate the door of the vehicle
at which the MD will enter to be stored in a storage space in the vehicle, and providing
1553 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29R) to direct the MD to the door. If
1555 the vehicle door is wide enough for the MD to enter, method 1051 can include
providing 1557 at least one vehicle control command to command the vehicle to open
the door. If 1559 the door is open and if 1561 there is room in the vehicle to store
the MD, method 1051 can include providing 1563 at least one movement command 630 (FIG.
29R) to move the MD into the storage space in the vehicle. Method 1051 can include
providing 1565 at least one vehicle control command to command the vehicle to lock
the MD into place, and to close the door of the vehicle. If 1555 the vehicle door
is not wide enough, or if 1559 the vehicle door is not open, or if 1561 there is no
space for the MD, method 1051 can include alerting 1567 the user, and providing 1569
at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29R) to return the MD to the user.
[0275] Continuing to refer primarily to FIGs. 29P and 29Q, the at least one movement command
630 (FIG. 29R) to store the MD can be received from external application 140 (FIG.
16B) and/or automatically generated. Method 1051 can optionally include alerting the
user of error conditions through, for example, but not limited to, an audio alert
through audio interface 150A (FIG. 16B) and/or a message to external application 140
(FIG. 16B). Method 1051 can optionally invoke obstacle processing 607 (FIG. 29M) to
assist in locating the door of the vehicle, to determine if there is enough room in
the vehicle to store the MD, and to locate any locking mechanism in the vehicle. When
the MD is again needed, that is, when the user has arrived at a destination in the
vehicle, external application 140 (FIG. 1A), for example, can be used to invoke the
MD. Method 1051 can include recalling the status of the MD and can include providing
vehicle control commands to command the vehicle to unlock the MD and open the door
of the vehicle. Method 1051 can include locating the door of the vehicle, or can include
accessing the location of the vehicle door from, for example, local storage 607H (FIG.
29M) and/or cloud storage 607G (FIG. 29M). Method 1051 can include providing movement
commands 630 (FIG. 29R) to move the MD through the vehicle door and to the passenger
door to which it had been summoned by, for example, but not limited to, external application
140 (FIG. 16B).
[0276] Referring now to FIG. 29R, mobile park mode 605E can include, but is not limited
to including, vehicle door processor 691D that can provide at least one movement command
630 to locate door 675 of the vehicle at which the MD will enter to be stored in a
storage space in the vehicle. Vehicle door processor 691D can also provide at least
one movement command 630 to direct the MD to door 675. If door 675 is wide enough
for the MD to enter, vehicle command processor 691C can provide at least one vehicle
control command to command the vehicle to open door 675. If door 675 is open and if
there is room in the vehicle to store the MD, space processor 691B can provide at
least one movement command 630 to move the MD into the storage space in the vehicle.
Vehicle command processor 691C can provide at least one vehicle control command to
command the vehicle to lock the MD into place, and to close door 675 of the vehicle.
If door 675 is not wide enough, or if door 675 is not open, or if there is no space
for the MD, error processor 691E can alert the user, and can provide at least one
movement command 630 to return the MD to the user.
[0277] Continuing to refer to FIG. 29R, vehicle door processor 691D can optionally recall
the status of the MD, and vehicle command processor 691C can provide vehicle control
commands to command the vehicle to unlock the MD and open door 675 of the vehicle.
Vehicle door processor 691D can once again locate door 675 of the vehicle, or can
access the location of door 675 from, for example, local storage 607H (FIG. 29M) and/or
cloud storage 607G (FIG. 29M), and/or door database 673B. Vehicle door processor 691D
can provide movement commands 630 to move the MD through door 675 and to the passenger
door to which it had been summoned by, for example, external application 140 (FIG.
16B).
[0278] Referring now primarily to FIG. 29S, method 1150 for storing/recharging the MD can
assist the user in storing and possibly recharging the MD. For example, the MD could
be recharged when the user sleeps. After the user exits the MD, commands can be initiated
at, for example, external application 140 (FIG. 16B), to move perhaps riderless the
MD to a storage/docking area. In some configurations, a mode selection by the user
while the user occupies the MD can initiate automatic storage/docking functions after
the user has exited the MD. When the MD is again needed, commands can be initiated
by external application 140 (FIG. 16B) to recall the MD to the user. Method 1150 can
include, but is not limited to including, locating 1651 at least one storage/charging
area, and providing 1655 at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29T) to move the
MD from a first location to the storage/charging area. Method 1150 can include locating
1657 a charging dock in the storage/charging area and providing 1663 at least one
movement command 630 (FIG. 29T) to couple the MD with the charging dock. Method 1150
can optionally include providing at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29T) to move
the MD to the first location when the MD receives an invocation command. If 1653 there
is no storage/charging area, or if 1659 there is no charging dock, or if 1666 the
MD cannot couple with the charging dock, method 1150 can optionally include providing
1665 at least one alert to the user, and providing 1667 at least one movement command
630 (FIG. 29T) to move the MD to the first location.
[0279] Referring now to FIG. 29T, static storage/charging mode 605F can include, but is
not limited to including, storage/charging area processor 702A that can locate at
least one storage/charging area, and can provide at least one movement command 630
to move the MD from a first location to storage/charging area. Coupling processor
702D can locate a charging dock in storage/charging area, and can provide at least
one movement command 630 to couple the MD with the charging dock. Return processor
702B can optionally provide at least one movement command 630 to move the MD to the
first location when the MD receives an invocation command. If there is no storage/charging
area, or if there is no charging dock, or if the MD cannot couple with the charging
dock, error processor 702E can optionally provide at least one alert to the user,
and can providing at least one movement command 630 to move the MD to the first location.
[0280] Referring now to FIG. 29U, method 1250 for negotiating an elevator while maneuvering
the MD can assist a user in getting on and off elevator 685 (FIG. 29V) in the MD.
Sensor processing 661 can be used to locate elevator 685 (FIG. 29V), for example,
or elevator location 685A (FIG. 29V) can be determined from local storage 607H (FIG.
29M) and/or storage cloud 607G (FIG. 29M). When elevator 685 (FIG. 29V) is located,
and when the user selects the desired elevator direction, and when elevator 685 (FIG.
29V) arrives and the door opens, elevator mode 605D (FIG. 29V) can provide movement
commands 630 (FIG. 29V) to move the MD into elevator 685 (FIG. 29V). The geometry
of elevator 685 (FIG. 29V) can be determined and movement commands 630 (FIG. 29V)
can be provided to move the MD into a location that makes it possible for the user
to select a desired activity from the elevator selection panel. The location of the
MD can also be appropriate for exiting elevator 685 (FIG. 29V). When the elevator
door opens, movement commands 630 (FIG. 29V) can be provided to move the MD to fully
exit elevator 685 (FIG. 29V). Method 1250 can include, but is not limited to including,
locating elevator 685 (FIG. 29V), where elevator 685 (FIG. 29V) has an elevator door
and an elevator threshold associated with the elevator door. Method 1250 can include
providing at least one movement command 630 (FIG. 29V) to move the MD through the
elevator door beyond the elevator threshold. Method 1250 can also include determining
the geometry of elevator 685 (FIG. 29V), and providing at least one movement command
630 (FIG. 29V) to move the MD into a floor selection/exit location relative to the
elevator threshold. Method 1250 can also include providing at least one movement command
630 (FIG. 29V) to move the MD across and beyond the elevator threshold to exit elevator
685 (FIG. 29V).
[0281] Referring now primarily to FIG. 29V, elevator mode 605D can include, but is not limited
to including, elevator locator 711A that can locate elevator 685 having an elevator
door and an elevator threshold associated with the elevator door. Elevator locator
711A can save obstacles 623, elevators 685, and elevator locations 685A in elevator
database 683B, for example. Elevator database 683B can be located locally or remotely
from MD 120. Entry/exit processor 711B can provide at least one movement command 630
to move the MD through the elevator door beyond the elevator threshold to either enter
or exit elevator 685. Elevator geometry processor 711D can determine the geometry
of elevator 685. Entry/exit processor 711B can provide at least one movement command
630 to move the MD into a floor selection/exit location relative to the elevator threshold.
[0282] Referring now primarily to FIG. 30A, SSB 143 (FIG. 16B) can provide communications
through use of, for example, a CANbus protocol. Devices connected to SSB 143 (FIG.
16B) can be programmed to respond/listen to specific messages received, processed,
and transmitted by SSB messaging 130F (FIG. 16B). Messages can include packets, which
can include, but are not limited to including, data and a CANbus device identification
that can identify the source of the packet. Devices receiving CANbus packets can ignore
invalid CANbus packets. When an invalid CANbus packet is received, the received device
can take alternative measures, depending on, for example, the current mode of the
MD, the previous CANbus messages, and the receiving device. The alternate measures
can, for example, maintain stability of the MD. The bus master of SSB 143 (FIG. 16B)
can transmit master sync packet 901 to establish a bus alive sequence on a frame basis
and synchronize the time base. PBP A1 43A (FIG. 18C), for example, can be designated
the master of SSB 143 (FIG. 16B), and PBP B1 43C (FIG. 18D), for example, can be designated
as the secondary master of SSB 143 (FIG. 16B) if PBP A1 43A (FIG. 18C) is no longer
transmitting on the bus. The master of SSB 143 (FIG. 16B) can transmit master sync
packet 901 at a periodic rate, for example, but not limited to, every 20 ms +/- 1%.
Devices communicating using SSB 143 (FIG. 16B) can synchronize the transmitting of
messages to the beginning of master sync packet 901. PSC packets 905 can include data
originated by PSC 11 (FIG. 16B), and PBP packets 907 can include data originated by
PBP 100 (FIG. 16B).
[0283] Referring now primarily to FIG. 30B, user control packets 903 can include header,
message ID, and data for messages traveling primarily to and from external applications
140 (FIG. 16B) wirelessly, for example, but not limited to, using a BLUETOOTH
® protocol. User control packets 903 (FIG. 30A) can include, for example, packet format
701. Packet format 701 can include, but is not limited to including, status 701A,
error device identification 701B, mode requested 701C, control out 701D, commanded
velocity 701E, commanded turn rate 701F, seat control 701G, and system data 701H.
Status 701A can include, but is not limited to including, possibilities such as, for
example, self test in progress, device okay, non-fatal device failure (data OK), and
fatal device failure in which receiving devices can ignore the data in the packet.
If UC 130, for example, receives a device failure status, UC 130 can post an error
to, for example, a graphical user interface (GUI) on UC 130 (FIG. 12A). Error device
ID 701B can include the logical ID of the device for which received communications
has been determined to be erroneous. Error device ID 701B can be set to zero when
no errors are received.
[0284] Referring now primarily to FIG. 30C, mode requested code 701C (FIG. 30B) can be defined
such that a single bit error may not indicate another valid mode. For example, mode
codes can include, but are not limited to including, self-test, standard, enhanced
or 4-wheel, stair, balance, docking, remote, calibration, update, power off, power
on, fail safe, recovery, flasher, door, mobile storage, static storage/charging, rest
room, elevator, and enhanced stair, the meanings of which are discussed herein. Mode
requested code 701C can indicate if the mode being requested should be processed to
(1) either maintain the current mode or execute an allowed mode change or (2) enable
situation-dependent processing. In some configurations, special situations can require
automatic control of the MD. For example, the MD can transition from stair mode 100-4
(FIG. 22B) automatically to enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B) when the MD has reached
a top landing of a staircase. In some configurations, the MD can, for example, but
not limited to, modify the response of the MD to commands from joystick 70007 (FIG.
12A), for example, by setting the MD to a particular mode. In some configurations,
the MD can automatically be set to a slow driving mode when the MD is transitioned
out of stair mode 100-4 (FIG. 22B). In some configurations, when the MD transitions
from stair mode 100-4 (FIG. 22B) automatically to enhanced mode 100-2 (FIG. 22B),
joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be disabled. When a mode is selected through, for example,
but not limited to, user entry, mode availability can be determined based at least
in part on current operating conditions.
[0285] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 30C, in some configurations, if a transition
is not allowed to a user-selected mode from the current mode, the user can be alerted.
Certain modes and mode transitions can require user notification and possibly user
assistance. For example, adjustments to the seat can be needed when positioning the
MD for a determination of the center of gravity of the MD along with the load on the
MD. The user can be prompted to perform specific operations based on the current mode
and/or the mode to which the transition can occur. In some configurations, the MD
can be configured for, for example, but not limited to, fast, medium, medium dampened,
or slow speed templates. The speed of the MD can be modified by using, for example,
speed template 700 (25A) relating output 703 (25A) (and wheel commands) to joystick
displacement 702 (25A).
[0286] Referring now to FIG. 30D, control out 701D (FIG. 30B) can include, but is not limited
to including, indications such as, for example, but not limited to, OK to power down
801A, drive selection 801B, emergency power off request 801C, calibration state 801D,
mode restriction 801E, user training 801F, and joystick centered 801G. In some configurations,
OK to power down 801A can be defined to be zero if power down is not currently allowed,
and drive selection 801B can be defined to specify motor drive 1 (bit 6 = 0) or motor
drive 2 (bit 6 = 1). In some configurations, emergency power off request 801C can
be defined to indicate if an emergency power off request is normal (bit 5 = 0), or
an emergency power off request sequence is in process (bit 5 = 1), and calibration
state 801D can be defined to indicate a request for user calibration (bit 4 = 1).
In some configurations, mode restriction 801E can be defined to indicate whether or
not there are restrictions for entering a particular mode. If the mode can be entered
without restriction, bit 3 can be zero. If there are restrictions to entering a mode,
for example, but not limited to, balance-critical modes can require certain restrictions
to maintain the safety of the passenger of the MD, bit 3 can be one. User training
801F can be defined to indicate if user training is possible (bit 2 = 1), or not (bit
2 = 0), and joystick centered 801G can be defined to indicate if joystick 70007 (FIG.
12A) is centered (bits 0-1 = 2), or not (bits 0-1 = 1).
[0287] Referring again primarily to FIG. 30B, commanded velocity 701E can include, for example,
a value representing forward or reverse speed. Forward velocity can include a positive
value and reverse velocity can be a negative value, for example. Commanded turn rate
701F can include a value representing a left or right commanded turn rate. A left
turn can include a positive value and a right turn can include a negative value. The
value can represent the differential velocity between the left and right of wheels
21201 (FIG. 1A) equivalently scaled to commanded velocity 701E.
[0288] Referring again primarily to FIG. 30D, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can include multiple
redundant hardware inputs. Signals such as, for example, commanded velocity 701E (FIG.
30B), commanded turn rate 701F (FIG. 30B), and joystick-centered 801G can be received
and processed. Commanded velocity 701E (FIG. 30B) and commanded turn rate 701F (FIG.
30B) can be determined from a first of the multiple hardware inputs, and joystick-centered
801G can be determined from a second of the hardware inputs. Values of joystick-centered
801G can indicate when a non-zero of commanded velocity 701E (FIG. 30B) and a non-zero
of commanded turn rate 701F (FIG. 30B) are valid. Fault conditions for joystick 70007
(FIG. 12A) in, for example, the X and Y directions can be detected. For example, each
axis of joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be associated with dual sensors. Each sensor
pair input (X (commanded velocity 701E (FIG. 30B)) and Y (command turn rate 701F (FIG.
30B)) can be associated with an independent A/D converter, each with a voltage reference
channel check input. In some configurations, commanded velocity 701E (FIG. 30B) and
commanded turn rate 701F (FIG. 30B) can be held to zero by the secondary input to
avoid mismatch. If joystick-centered 801G is within a minimum deadband, or joystick
70007 (FIG. 12A) is faulted, joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can be indicated as centered.
A deadband can indicate the amount of displacement of joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) that
can occur before a non-zero output from joystick 70007 (FIG. 12A) can appear. The
deadband range can set the zero reference region to include an electrical center position
that can be, for example, but not limited to, 45% to 55% of the defined signal range.
[0289] Referring now primarily to FIG. 30E, seat control 701G (FIG. 30B) can convey seat
adjustment commands. Frame lean command 921 can include values such as, for example,
invalid, lean forward, lean rearward, and idle. Seat height command 923 can include
values such as, for example, invalid, lower seat down, raise seat up, and idle.
[0290] Referring now to FIG. 31A, remote control of the MD can be enabled by secure communications
between control device 5107 and controlled device 5111, a configuration of which can
include the MD (also referred to as mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D). Control device
5107 can include, but is not limited to including, a cell phone, a personal computer,
and a tablet-based device, and is also referred to herein as an external device, a
configuration of which can include external application 5107A (FIG. 31D). In some
configurations, UC 130 (FIG. 12A) can include support for wireless communications
to/from mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D). Mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D) and external
application 5107A (FIG. 31D) can accommodate virtual joystick software that can, for
example, override the commands generated by joystick 70007 (FIG. 121). Control device
5107 can include voice recognition that can be used to control controlled device 5111.
Control device 5107 and controlled device 5111 can communicate using a first protocol,
a second protocol, and, for example, a wireless protocol such as, for example, but
not limited to, the BLUETOOTH
® Low Energy protocol.
[0291] Referring now to FIG. 31B, the first protocol can support communications between
control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) that can be physically remote from control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A). In some configurations, the first protocol can include the RIS protocol
in which each message can include header 5511, payload 5517, and data check 5519.
Messaging systems executing on control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) and control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A) can parse header 5511 and verify data check section 5519. Header 5511
can include, but is not limited to including, length of payload 5501, command 5503,
sub-command 5515, and sequence number 5505. Sequence number 5505 can be incremented
for each new message sent. Data check section 5519 can include, but is not limited
to including, a cyclic redundancy check of header 5511 and payload 5517. The first
protocol can include, but is not limited to including, messages that can vary in length.
Messages can include header 5511, payload 5517, and CRC 5519. Control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A) can require that certain messages be available in the first protocol
to support remote control of controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A). The first protocol
can transparently tunnel messages formatted in a second protocol and encapsulated
within messages formatted according to the first protocol for transmission and reception
over, for example, wireless link 5136. Devices that communicate using the second protocol
can be compatible with any updates that might happen in the wireless protocol and/or
first protocol and can require no changes to operate seamlessly.
[0292] Continuing to refer primarily to FIG. 31B, communications device drivers can provide
driver bytes 5513 before message header 5511 that can be used by, for example, a serial
peripheral interface (SPI) and remote communications drivers. Sub-command 5515 can
include a response bit that can indicate that the message is a response to command
5503. In some configurations, a maximum message length can be imposed that may not
include driver bytes 5513. If controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A) is a medical device,
messages can include therapy commands that can include therapy number 5613 (FIG. 32A)
in payload 5517. In some configurations, a next therapy number can be provided in
either a status message or a response. Therapy commands can be rejected if controlled
device 5111 (FIG. 31A) has not been configured for therapy. In some configurations,
sequence number 5505 of the response message must match sequence number 5505 of the
original message. Control device interface 5111 (FIG. 31A) and controlled device interface
5103 can detect and react to communications issues such as, for example, but not limited
to, CRC inconsistencies, timeouts, and therapy number inconsistencies.
[0293] Continuing to still further refer to FIG. 31B, first protocol CRC 5519 can be computed
over header 5511 and payload 5517. When a message is received that has passed CRC
validation, a response message can be sent. In some configurations, if the message
does not include a valid command 5503, or command 5503 cannot currently be processed
by the system, the response can include a negative acknowledgement that can have a
code that can indicate the reason the message is considered invalid or inoperable.
Messages that fail CRC validation or unexpected message responses can be dropped and
treated the same as any message lost during transport. Controlled device interface
5103 (FIG. 31A) and control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) can both perform source
node functions because they can each be the originator of and/or conduit for source
messages. Whichever of controlled device interface 5103 (FIG. 31A) or control device
interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) sends the message can generate a timeout if necessary, perform
message send retries, if necessary, and self-generate a dropped message negative acknowledgement
response if a dropped message is detected.
[0294] Referring now to FIG. 31C, controlled device interface 5103 (FIG. 31A) and control
device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) can manage the extraction of messages formatted according
to the second protocol from first protocol messages and vice versa. Communications
message management can include identifying first protocol messages and extracting
tunneled second protocol messages as needed. First protocol messages that include
second protocol messages can be processed separately from other messages. First protocol
messages can be prepared and queued for transmission separately depending on whether
second protocol messages are included. Messages formatted according to the second
protocol can include control byte, message ID, data, and a CRC computed over control
byte, message ID, and data. Control byte 5521 can be used for message addressing and
can include a message sequence number that can be generated by controlled device interface
5103 (FIG. 31A) and can be echoed back by control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A).
The sequence number can be used by controlled device interface 5103 (FIG. 31A) to
match a received response message to a sent request message. In some configurations,
sequence numbers can begin at 0h, can be incremented after a message is sent, and
roll to 0h after Fh. Control byte 5521 can indicate the identification from where
a response to the message can be expected. Control byte 5521 can include a processor
ID that can identify the processor for which the message is intended.
[0295] Continuing to refer to FIG. 31C, message ID 5523 can provide a command and/or an
indication of the identity of message data 5525. In some configurations, message ID
5523 can take on the exemplary values in Table I. In some configurations, the sender
of the message having message ID 5523 can expect an exemplary response as shown in
Table I.
TABLE I
ID |
Message |
Expected Response |
Payload |
00h |
No Message |
|
|
01h |
Initialize |
02h |
Protocol version # and application ID |
02h |
Confirm Initialize |
N/A |
Initialization results and version numbers |
03h |
Status |
N/A |
Status code and previous message ID |
04h |
Resend Last Message |
All Msgs |
|
05h |
Communication Complete |
03h |
|
06h |
Get Application CRC |
07h |
|
07h |
Send Application CRC |
N/A |
CRC value |
10h-2Ah |
Controlled device-specific messages |
|
|
2Bh |
Set Event Log Status |
2Ch |
|
2Ch |
Send Current Event Log Status |
N/A |
# event log entries |
2Dh |
Get Event Segment |
33h |
Event index, segment # |
2Eh |
Clear Events |
03h |
|
2Fh |
Set Alarm Log Status |
30h |
|
30h |
Send Current Alarm Log Status |
N/A |
# of alarm log entries |
31h |
Get Alarm Segment |
33h |
Alarm index, segment # |
32h |
Clear Alarms |
03h |
|
33h |
Send Log Segment |
N/A |
Alarm segment |
34h-41h |
Controlled device-specific messages |
|
|
42h |
Get Real Time Clock |
44h |
Clock type ID |
44h |
Send Real Time Clock - Integer |
03h |
Real time clock integer value and clock type ID |
45h |
Get Serial Number |
46h |
Of controlled device |
46h |
Send Serial Number |
46h |
Serial number of controlled device |
47h |
Get Service Flag |
48h |
|
48h |
Send Service Flag |
48h |
Equipment service flag to indicate issues with controlled device |
49h-FFh |
Controlled device-specific messages |
|
|
[0296] Continuing to refer to FIG. 31C, second protocol messages that can be exchanged can
include, but are not limited to including, an initialization message that can be sent
from control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) to controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A), and an initialization
response message that can be sent from controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A) to control
device 5107 (FIG. 31A). The initialization message can include, but is not limited
to including, a protocol map, an application ID, a communication timeout value, and
padding. Second protocol messages can include a joystick command that can be sent
from control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) to controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A), and that
can include the X-deflection of the joystick (a virtual joystick), the Y-deflection
of the joystick (a virtual joystick), and padding. Second protocol messages can include
commands used to interface with a wireless protocol such as, for example, the BLUETOOTH
® protocol, that can enable communications between control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) and
controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A). The commands can kick off actions such as, for
example, scanning for peripherals, discontinuing the scan, retrieving names of peripherals,
connecting a peripheral such as, for example, controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A) operating
as a peripheral with control device 5107 (FIG. 31A), and canceling the peripheral
connection. The commands can interrogate peripherals, for example, by discovering
services and characteristics of the peripherals, reading and setting values of the
characteristics. Responses to the commands can include, but are not limited to including,
status updates with respect to peripherals, connections, services, and characteristics.
[0297] Referring now primarily to FIGs. 31B and 31C, first protocol commands can include
disabling wireless communications in which control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A)
can continue operating without control device 5107 (FIG. 31A), and in which control
device 5107 (FIG. 31A) can reactivate if an alarm is received from control device
interface 5115 (FIG. 31A). Second protocol commands can include commands such as,
for example, but not limited to, echo, set/get system events, erase logs, get data,
force alarm, set log record on control device 5111 (FIG. 31A), force reset of control
device 5111 (FIG. 31A), startup test for control device 5111 (FIG. 31A), integration
test commands, and radio service commands. Second protocol commands can include commands
such as, for example, but not limited to, set an identification of control device
5111 (FIG. 31A), setting of calibration and measurement options, executing of manufacturing
tests, and providing a list of events.
[0298] Referring now to FIG. 31D, wireless communications system 100P can enable control
of controlled device 5111 (FIG. 31A), for example, but not limited to, mobility device
5111A, through, for example, but not limited to, external application (EA) 5107A executing
on control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) (a cell phone, a PC, or a tablet, for example).
Wireless communications system 100P can include, but is not limited to including,
mobility device 5111A and external application 5107A that can decode and use the messages
moving between them. Wireless communications system 100P can include, but is not limited
to including, protocol conversion processes 5317, input queues 5311/5335, output queues
5309/5333, state machines 5305E and 5305M, and wireless processors 5325/5330. Mobility
device state machine 5305M can manage the process of communicating wirelessly from
the perspective of mobility device 5111A. External application state machine 5305E
can manage the process of communicating wirelessly from the perspective of external
application 5107A. In particular, both mobility device state machine 5305M and external
application state machine 5305E can manage the entry and exit of states from which
messages can be generated and sent and/or received according pre-selected protocols.
The messages can, for example, direct mobility device 5111A and/or external application
5107A to respond to a status of dradio 5349. External application wireless processor
5325 can execute on control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) and can communicate with external
application 5107A. Mobility device wireless processor 5330 can execute on mobility
device 5111A and can communicate with components of mobility device 5111A.
[0299] Continuing to refer to FIG. 31D, both external application wireless processor 5325
and mobility device wireless processor 5330 can include a processor, for example,
but not limited to, ARM processor 5329, that can execute wireless control code, termed
herein, for convenience, dradio 5349. Dradio 5349 executing on control device 5107
(FIG. 31A) can include at least one external application radio state machine 5337E,
and dradio 5349 executing on mobility device 5111A can include at least one mobility
device radio state machine 5337M. At least one radio state machine can manage the
states of I/O to soft device 5347. Soft device 5347 can include a wireless protocol
processor such as, for example, but not limited to, a processor that communicates
using the BLUETOOTH
® Low Energy protocol. Both external application radio state machine 5337E and mobility
device radio state machine 5337M can manage the states of radios 5331, and can provide
information about radios 5331 to external application 5107A and mobility device 5111A.
Dradio 5349 can include general-purpose functionality and customized services to support
mobility device 5111A, for example. The communication means between mobility device
5111A and control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) can support digital communication between
processors that are internal to mobility device 5111A. External applications 5107
can execute on control devices 5107 (FIG. 31A) such as, for example, but not limited
to, personal computers and mobile devices. The communications means can enable customizing
mobility device 5111A for users of varying abilities and physical characteristics,
configuring training mode for new users, remote control of the device for stowage,
and downloading parametric and performance data. In some configurations, UC 130 (FIG.
12A) can include wireless processor 5325. When mobility device 5111A enters a wireless-enabled
mode, external application 5107A can send commands to mobility device 5111A and can
receive the corresponding responses. External application 5107A can create, for example,
but not limited to, messages formatted according to a first protocol such as, for
example, but not limited to, the RIS protocol (see FIG. 31C), to communicate information
to processors of mobility device 5111A, and vice versa. External application 5107A
can create, for example, but not limited to, messages formatted according to a second
protocol such as, for example, but not limited to, the SCA protocol (see FIG. 31B),
to communicate control commands and data to processors of mobility device 5111A. The
second protocol can be extensible to accommodate various types of controlled devices
5111 (FIG. 31A) and various functions available through external application 5107A.
For example, a radio-control application executing on an IPOD
® device can establish communications by using, for example, but not limited to, messages
following the RIS protocol (see FIG. 31C), and can send virtual joystick commands
to mobility device 5111A by using, for example, but not limited to, messages following
the SCA protocol (see FIG. 31B).
[0300] Continuing to refer to FIG. 31D, at the user's command, dradio 5349 can, through
state machines 5337E/M and soft device 5347, cooperate to scan for peripheral radios,
choose one that is advertising its readiness to communicate, and initiate a wireless
session with the desired peripheral radio, for example, but not limited to, the peripheral
radio of mobility device 5111A. If BLUETOOTH
® communications are used, radio 5331 and soft device 5347 can provide BLUETOOTH
® central radio functionality required to set up and maintain communications between
mobility device 5111A and control device 5107 (FIG. 31A). In some configurations,
external applications 5107A executing on ANDROID
® and iOS devices can use a wireless mechanism internal to ANDROID
® or iOS to communicate with mobility device 5111A. External application state machine
5305E can set up, control, and monitor wireless chip 5325 in a particular mode, such
as, for example, central radio mode.
[0301] Continuing to refer to FIG. 31D, dradio 5349 can manage radio 5331 through functionality
such as, for example, but not limited to, sending messages and responses to command
and interrogate radio 5331, sending data over wireless link 5136, securely pairing
remote radios 5331, encrypting radio traffic, filtering pre-selected devices from
the list of advertising peripheral radios, and white listing the last-paired remote
radios 5331, which can assist with the scan/pair/connect sequence. With respect to
mobility device 5111A, state machine 5337M can manage radio 5331, serial I/O processor
5339 can provide low-level, thread-safe serial I/O support, and RIS-SCA process 5317
can extract/embed SCA messages from/in RIS protocol payloads. In some configurations,
RIS-only messages that are transmitted/received by radio 5331 can be discarded by
external application wireless state machine 5305E or controlled device interface 5103.
Encapsulated SCA messages, for example, but not limited to, commands and status requests,
can be placed upon SCA output queue 53190 for transfer to output queue 5309. To support
various types of controlled devices 5115 (FIG. 31A), RIS messages specific to a particular
of controlled devices 5115 (FIG. 31A) can augment a basic set of RIS messages. For
incoming data packets, SCA messages can be extracted from incoming RIS messages, and
the messages can be dispatched to thread-safe, circular queues for consumption by
external application 5107A or mobility device 5111A. Outgoing messages can be queued
separately depending on whether they are RIS or SCA messages. RIS messages that originate
with external application 5107A can be placed on RIS output Q 5303O and moved to output
queue 5309 when a queue slot is available. RIS-SCA process 5317 can retrieve SCA messages
from RIS messages and vice versa to maintain transparency to SCA-aware software in
system 100P.
[0302] Continuing to refer to FIG. 31D, in some configurations, the encapsulation of messages
formatted in the second protocol within messages formatted in the first protocol can
enable flexible communications between mobility device 5111A and external application
5107A. External application 5107A can receive information from, for example, a user,
and the information can be translated into second protocol messages which can then
be encapsulated in first protocol messages and transmitted to mobility device 5111A.
Wireless state machines 5305E/M can include software constructs that can manage the
states of wireless processors 5325/5330. State machines 5305E/M can maintain the synchronization
of peripheral and central radio states of mobility device 5111A and external application
5107A.
[0303] Referring now primarily to FIG. 31E, external application state machine 5305E (FIG.
31D) can recognize states such as, for example, but not limited to idle state 3001
in which radio 5331 experiences no activity, and start-up state 3003 in which radio
5331 is started up. In start-up state 3003, external application state machine 5305E
(FIG. 31D) is set up to listen for a status message from radio 5331 (FIG. 31D) that
tells external application state machine 5305E (FIG. 31D) that radio 5331 (FIG. 31D)
is ready to begin. In check state 3005 in which external application state machine
5305E (FIG. 31D) awaits the ready-to-begin status message. Other states can include
send state 3007 in which external application state machine 5305E (FIG. 31D) requests
information about dradio 5349 (FIG. 31D), for example, but not limited to, its software
version number, sends a start radio command to dradio 5349 (FIG. 31D), sends a command
to dradio 5349 (FIG. 31D) to open up pairing with mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D),
and informs dradio 5349 (FIG. 31D) about which of possible mobility devices 5111A
(FIG. 31D) the user has selected. Wait for acknowledgement state 3009 sets external
application state machine 5305E (FIG. 31D) in a state awaiting a response from the
last sent message, for example, but not limited to, acknowledgements concerning radio
version number, radio start, pairing, start scan, and parse data. With respect to
the parse data acknowledgement, wait for acknowledgement state 3009 informs dradio
5349 (FIG. 31D) that a response was received and loops back to the previous state
until a pairing is selected or until scanning is stopped. Other responses that can
be awaited can include responses to connect messages and connect status messages in
which the state is awaiting the successful connection of mobility device 5111A (FIG.
31D) with external application 5107A (FIG. 31D). Wait to scan state 3011 awaits a
command to begin the pairing process and listens for responses from available mobility
devices 5111A (FIG. 31D). Start scan state 3013 sends a command to dradio 5349 (FIG.
31D) to start scanning for available mobility devices 5111A (FIG. 31D) and sets up
a state machine to enable the connection in which external application state machine
5305E (FIG. 31D) enters connected state 3015. If wireless link 5136 (FIG. 31D) is
lost, or if message responses time out, or at an external request, external application
state machine 5305E (FIG. 31D) can enter start reset state 3017 from which radio reset
state 3019 can be entered in which a reset command is sent to dradio 5349 (FIG. 31D),
followed by a wait for a response 3017 to the reset command. Stop state 3021 can set
up external application state machine 5305E (FIG. 31D) to clean up and return to idle
state 3001.
[0304] Referring now to FIG. 31F, mobility device state machine 5305M (FIG. 31D) can include
states such as, for example, but not limited to, idle state 3101 in which there is
no radio activity, start-up state 3103 in which radio 5331 (FIG. 31D) is enabled,
advertise go-ahead state 3105 in which mobility device 5111A (FIG. 32) receives the
go-ahead to advertise the availability of mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D) for radio
communication, and advertise state 3107 in which mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D)
identifying information is made available to listening radios such as, for example,
radio 5331 (FIG. 31D) associated with external application 5107A (FIG. 31D). States
can further include waiting for connect request state 3109, accepting a connect request
state, connected state 3111 in which mobility device 5111A (FIG. 31D) can communicate
with the desired central radio, and waiting state 3113 in which mobility device 5111A
(FIG. 31D) awaits the end of a wireless session, whether by user action, or loss of
radio signal. States can further include reset request state 3117 from which radio
5331 (FIG. 31D) can be placed in reset state 3119, and auto-reconnect state 3115 in
which radio 5331 (FIG. 31D) can attempt to automatically reconnect to the wireless
session, depending on how the wireless session ended.
[0305] Referring now to FIG. 31G, external application 5107A (FIG. 31D) can provide the
interface between user interface 5107B executing on an external device and a wireless
communications means. In some configurations, the wireless communications means can
be based upon the BLUETOOTH
® Low Energy protocol, and can include configuring communications between mobility
device 5111A and external application 5107A, initiating the sending of messages between
mobility device 5111A and external application 5107A, breaking up of large messages,
and enabling virtual joystick commands that are initiated by a user of the external
device and are transmitted to mobility device 5111A. Messages that can be exchanged
can include, but are not limited to including, scan for devices, stop scan, and retrieve
devices, where devices can include mobility device 5111A. Mobility device 5111A and
external application 5107A can communicate with wireless processors 5325/5330 that
can manage the transmission and reception of messages from between external application
5107A and mobility device 5111A. External application 5107A can generate create message
2001 using, for example, but not limited to, an applications program interface that
can communicate with external application wireless processor 5325, which can receive
create message 2001, and use the information from create message 2001 to build and
send advertising information 2003 to mobility device wireless processor 5330. Advertising
information 2003 can include, but is not limited to including, company identification,
project identification, and customer identification. Mobility device wireless processor
5330 can use advertising information 2003 to build and send advertising data 2005
through external application wireless processor 5325 to external application 5107A,
which can build and send device information to user interface 5107B to display on
the external device. External application 5107A can send connect request 2007 to external
application wireless processor 5325, which can build and send a connect request to
mobility device wireless processor 5330. Mobility device wireless processor 5330 can
respond to the connect request through external application wireless processor 5325
to external application 5107A, which can react to the response by sending service
request 2009 to external application wireless processor 5325, which can respond by
sending services 2011 to external application 5107A. Connect request 2007 can include
commands to connect mobility device 5111A and/or cancel the connection to mobility
device 5111A. The response to connect request 2007 can include success or failure
notifications. External application 5107 can receive services 2011 and notify external
device user interface 5107B that the device is connected. As communications start-up
is in progress, a central manager within external application wireless processor 5325
can update the state of external application wireless processor 5325 and send the
updated state information to external application 5107A. A disconnect request and
response could be exchanged while communications are in progress, and external application
wireless processor 5325 can provide the disconnect request to external application
5107A. As communications start-up is in progress, external application 5107A can query
mobility device 5111A by sending messages such as, for example, but not limited to,
discovering the services and characteristics of mobility device 5111A, and requesting
reading and writing values from/to mobility device 5111A. The query can be answered
by a response that can provide data and status of mobility device 5111A.
[0306] Referring now to FIG. 31H, following communications start-up, external application
5107A can initiate communications with mobility device 5107A by commanding external
application wireless processor 5325 to send initialization message 2013, send joystick
enable message 2027, and send heartbeat message 2025 to mobility device wireless processor
5330. Mobility device wireless processor 5330 can receive joystick enable message
2027 and notify mobility device 5111A that the virtual joystick of external application
5107A is enabled. External application wireless processor 5325 can request, through
mobility device wireless processor 5330, a status of mobility device 5111A. Mobility
device 5111A can receive the status request, access the status, and send status message
2119 through mobility device wireless processor 5330 and external application wireless
processor 5325 to external application 5107A, which can provide the status to external
device user interface 5107B. External application wireless processor 5325 can request,
through mobility device wireless processor 5330, a log from mobility device 5111A.
Mobility device 5111A can receive the log request, access the log, and send log message
2121 through mobility device wireless processor 5330 and external application wireless
processor 5325 to external application 5107A, which can provide the log to an external
storage device.
[0307] Referring to FIG. 32A, there can be several ways that the security of the MD can
be compromised. External communications and internal controls can be explicitly or
accidently exploited causing minor to catastrophic results. External communications
can be put at risk through, for example, but not limited to, malicious modification
5603 of message traffic, eavesdropping and replay 5601, and co-opting control 5621
of control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A). Internal control compromises can include,
but are not limited to including, malicious and/or erroneous applications 5617 that
can cause intended and/or unintended results that can compromise security of the MD.
In-flight modification 5603 of message traffic can be detected by standard procedures
that can be available in commercial wireless products 5607 such as, for example, but
not limited to, products that adhere to the BLUETOOTH
® Low Energy standard in which a secure link can be established using Elliptic Curve
Diffie-Hellman key exchange and AES-128 encryption. CRC protection 5605 can also be
used to deter in-flight threats.
[0308] Continuing to refer to FIG. 32A, with respect to man-in-the-middle (MitM) threats
5601, when wireless devices are first paired, an attacker can place itself "in the
middle" of the connection. Two valid but separate wireless encrypted connections can
be established with a bad actor placing itself in the middle and reading or modifying
unencrypted clear text that can be available between the two encrypted connections.
MITM attacks 5601 can include an attacker's monitoring messages, and altering and/or
injecting messages into a communication channel. One example is active eavesdropping,
in which the attacker makes independent connections with the victims and relays messages
between them to make them believe they are talking directly to each other over a private
connection, when in fact the entire conversation is controlled by the attacker. The
attacker can intercept messages passing between the two victims and inject new ones.
The victim(s) can also be subject to a replay attack in which the MitM records traffic
and inserts new messages containing the same text, and then continually plays the
messages back. Standard security features of commercial wireless protocols 5607, such
as, for example, authentication, confidentiality, and authorization, can thwart some
types of MitM attacks 5601. Authentication can include verifying the identity of communicating
devices based on their device addresses. Confidentiality can include protecting information
from eavesdropping by ensuring that only authorized devices can access and view transmitted
data. Authorization can include insuring that a device is authorized to use a service.
MITM threats 5601 can be thwarted by using a passkey entry pairing method, an out
of band pairing method, or a numeric comparison method.
[0309] Continuing to refer to FIG. 32A, PIN protection 5609 from MitM threats 5601 can include
the exchange of a code, for example a six-digit code, between control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A) and control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) using a short-term key. The six-digit
code can be exchanged one bit at a time, and both sides must agree on the bit setting
before another bit can be exchanged. At pairing time, control device 5107 (FIG. 31A)
can request entry of a six-digit code that can be physically located on control device
interface 5115 (FIG. 31A), and control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) can respond
with the same six-digit code. MitM threats 5601 have no access to the six-digit code
physically located on control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) and can therefore not
assume control of control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) from control device 5107
(FIG. 31A). The pairing mechanism is the process in which control device 5107 (FIG.
31A) and control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) exchange identity information that
paves the way for setting up encryption keys for future data exchange.
[0310] Continuing to refer to FIG. 32A, anyone who buys a complete system can know the controlled
device PIN and can stage MitM attacks 5601. The MitM can operate the system and figure
out the first protocol. Or the MitM could grab the message traffic between control
device 5107 (FIG. 31A) and control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) and learn first
protocol. Or the MitM could examine internal electrical busses of control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A) to capture the first protocol traffic and figure out the first protocol.
Clear text obfuscation 5611 can thwart these types of threats. Clear text obfuscation
5611 can include randomizing clear text so that even if the same message is sent over
and over, the eavesdropped version varies randomly. Either of control device 5107
(FIG. 31A) or control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) can obfuscate the clear text
in the message before transmitting the message, and either of control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A) or control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) can deobfuscate the clear text.
Once obfuscated, the messages appear to be random lengths and appear to contain random
data and the clear text cannot be seen outside of the control device interface 5115
(FIG. 31A) or control device 5107 (FIG. 31A). The obfuscation algorithm on control
device 5107 (FIG. 31A) can be kept secret through a security feature such as, for
example, Licel's DexProtector tool. The obfuscation algorithm can be kept secret on
control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) by setting the radio processor in control
device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) to disallow readback of the code and access to debugging
features. In some configurations, the obfuscation algorithm can be "stateless" in
that transmitted messages can be recovered independently of any previous message traffic,
obviating the need to maintain any shared state between the sender and the receiver.
In some configurations, even for clear text that is a series of messages of the same
length, the length of the obfuscated messages can vary randomly. In some configurations,
a first number of bytes of every message can be random. In some configurations, the
algorithm can execute without ROM for data tables and with a relatively small amount
of RAM, code, and compute cycles.
[0311] Referring now to FIG. 32B, method 5150 for obfuscating plain text can include, but
is not limited to including, generating 6151 a random byte and using the random byte
as a random key, transforming 6153 the random key into a count of random bytes in
a known range, generating 6155 the number of random bytes that equals the count, and
transforming 6157 several of the random bytes into a linear feedback shift register
(LFSR) seed value. Method 5150 can include whitening 6159 an input counted string
using the LFSR seed value.
[0312] Referring now to FIG. 32C, method 5160 for deobfuscating the clear text can include,
but is not limited to including, transforming 6161 the random key into the count of
random bytes in the known range, transforming 6163 several of the random bytes into
the LFSR Seed value, dewhitening 6165 the original counted string bytecount value,
dewhitening 6167 the counted string using the byte count value.
[0313] Referring again to FIG. 32A, the MitM can record a message between control device
5107 (FIG. 31A) and control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) and can replay it incessantly.
If control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) is a medical device, a random therapy
message number transmitted by controlled device can thwart replay attacks because
control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) must reiterate the random therapy message number with
a next command message. If control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) does not include the random
therapy message number, controlled device can reject the message, thereby preventing
replaying the same message over and over. In some configurations, trust boundaries
5619 can be established between control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) and the operating system
environment. The trust boundary means can include, but is not limited to including,
the use of pre-selected keys, sandboxing, file encryption entitlements, and file system
encryption tied to the pre-selected keys.
[0314] Referring now to FIG. 32D, since anybody who has a wireless device that can communicate
according to the wireless protocol used between control device 5107 (FIG. 31A) and
control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) can hack in between control device interface
5115 (FIG. 31A) and control device 5107 (FIG. 31A), challenge/response process 5615
can be used to thwart malicious actors. For example, if a third party application
becomes readily available, for example, for sale on mobile devices in application
stores, control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A) or control device 5107 (FIG. 31A),
either acting as sender, can present a challenge to control device 5107 (FIG. 31A)
or control device interface 5115 (FIG. 31A), either acting as receiver, and the receiver
must present the correct response. The method, from the point of view of the sender,
for thwarting security threats by challenge/response can include, but is not limited
to including, picking 7701 a large random number, sending 7703 the large random number
to a receiver, and transforming 7705/7709, by the sender and the receiver, the large
random number in the same secret way. The method can include hashing or encrypting
7707/7711, by the sender and the receiver, the transformed number in a cryptographically-secure
way, receiving 7713, from the receiver, the hashed or encrypted number, and checking
7715 that the number hashed or encrypted by the sender and the number hashed or encrypted
by the receiver are equal. The challenge/response process can rely on both sender
and receiver using the same secret transform algorithm. At no time does the transformed
number travel over the radio in an unencrypted fashion, protecting the secret transform.
To keep the algorithm secret, a controller can use commercially-available tools such
as, for example, but not limited to, Licel DEXProtector, that can provide, for example,
string, class, and resource encryption, integrity control, and hiding of application
programming interfaces.
[0315] Referring now to FIG. 33, event handing, including handling of error and fault conditions,
can include dynamic, flexible, and integrated event management among UC 130, PSCs
98/99, and processors 39/41. Event handling can include, but is not limited to including,
event receiver 2101, event lookup processor 2103, and event dispatch processor 2105.
Event receiver 2101 can receive event 2117 from any parts of the MD including, but
not limited to, UC 130, PSC 98/99, and PB 39/41. Event lookup processor 2103 can receive
event 2117 from event receiver 2101, and can transform event 2117 to event index 2119.
Event lookup process 2103 can use means such as, for example, but not limited to,
table lookup and hashing algorithms to create a means to locate event information.
Event lookup process 2103 can provide event index 2119 to event dispatch processor
2105. Event dispatch processor 2105 can determine, based at least in part on event
index 2119, event entry 2121. Event entry 2121 can include information that can be
relevant to responding to event 2117. Events can be processed by UC 130, PSC 98/99,
and PB 39/41, each of which can include, but is not limited to including, status level
processor 2107, filter processor 2109, action processor 2111, and indications processor
2115. Status level processor 2107 can extract a status level, for example, but not
limited to, a fault category, from event entry 2121, and can provide indications based
on the status level. In some configurations, status levels, for example, a range of
values, can accommodate conditions ranging from transient to severe, and can provide
indications ranging from possible audible tones to flashing lights and automatic power
down. UC 130 can audibly and visually notify the user when, for example, but not limited
to, a potential failure condition is detected, and can allow the user to disable alerts,
such as, for example, audible alerts. UC 130 can request user confirmation for events
such as, for example, but not limited to, powering off, and powering off can be disabled
at certain times, for example, but not limited to, in 4-Wheel mode 100-2 (FIG. 22A),
balance mode 100-3 (FIG. 22A), and stair mode 100-4 (FIG. 22A).
[0316] Continuing to refer to FIG. 33, filter processor 2109 can extract from event entry
2121 an indication of when the event 2117 is to be handled. In some configurations,
event 2117 can be handled immediately, or can be handled after an elapsed number of
times event 2117 has been reported. In some configurations, the reports can be non-consecutive.
In some configurations, events 2117 can be reported at a first rate and can be processed
at a second rate. In some configurations, event 2117 can be handled when reported,
instead of deferring the handling for batch processing, when event 2117 is detected
at pre-selected times or for pre-selected types of errors. Each of UC 130, PSC 98/99,
and PB 39/41 can include a particular event count threshold. In some configurations,
event handling can be latched if a pre-selected number of events 2117 has occurred.
In some configurations, the latching can be maintained until a power cycle.
[0317] Continuing to still further refer to FIG. 33, action processor 2111 can extract from
event entry 2121 an indication of what action is associated with event 2117. In some
configurations, actions can include commanding the MD to discontinue motion and placing
data in an event log and/or alarm log. In some configurations, event and/or alarm
log data from PB 39/41, UC 130, and PSC 98/99 can be managed by PSC 98/99. In some
configurations, an external application can retrieve event and/or alarm log data from
PSC 98 and PSC 99 and synchronize the data. The data can include a list of alarms
and reports that can be associated with particular events and status identifications
such as, for example, but not limited to, controller failure and position sensor fault.
Controller failures can be associated with an explicit reason for failure that can
be logged. In some configurations, event 2117 can be escalated, where escalation can
include reporting events 2117 that can be associated with the reported event. In some
configurations, event entry 2121 can specify an accumulator to be incremented when
event 2117 is detected. In some configurations, the accumulators in all of PB 39/41,
UC 130, and PSC 98/99 can be managed by PSC 98/99 and accessed by an external application.
In some configurations, event entry 2121 can include a specification of a service-required
indication associated with event 2117, which can also be managed by PSC 98/99 and
retrieved by an external application as described herein. In some configurations,
event entry 2121 can include a black box trigger name to be used when event 2117 is
detected. Restriction processor 2113 can extract from event entry 2121 information
about immediate and downstream effects of event 2117. In some configurations, immediate
effects can include user notifications, for example, audible and visible notifications
can be made available when the battery needs to be charged, when the temperature of
the MD exceeds a pre-selected threshold, and when the MD needs service. Immediate
effects can also include notifying the user of the severity of event 2117. In some
configurations, downstream effects can include restricting operational modes based
on events 2117. In some configurations, entry can be restricted into enhanced, balance,
stair, and remote modes. In some configurations, downstream effects can include effects
on the operation of the MD, for example limiting speed, disabling motion, transitioning
into certain modes automatically, restricting MD lean, restricting power off, and
blocking external application communication. In some configurations, a return to 4-wheel
mode can be automatic under certain pre-selected conditions such as, for example,
but not limited to, the transition to balancing on two wheels has failed, the pitch
of the MD has exceeded the safe operating limit for balance mode, and/or the wheels
have lost traction in balance mode.
[0318] Continuing to refer to FIG. 33, indications processor 2115 can extract from event
entry 2121 any indications that should be raised as a result of event 2117. In some
configurations, indications can be raised when there is a loss of communications between
components of the MD, for example, between PSC 98/99 and UC 130, and between PB 39
and PB 41, and when battery voltage is below a pre-selected threshold. In some configurations,
event entry 2121 can provide communications between processes, for example, status
flags can provide the status of seat, cluster, yaw, pitch, and IMU indicators.
[0319] Configurations of the present teachings are directed to computer systems for accomplishing
the methods discussed in the description herein, and to computer readable media containing
programs for accomplishing these methods. The raw data and results can be stored for
future retrieval and processing, printed, displayed, transferred to another computer,
and/or transferred elsewhere. Communications links can be wired or wireless, for example,
using cellular communication systems, military communications systems, and satellite
communications systems. Parts of the system can operate on a computer having a variable
number of CPUs. Other alternative computer platforms can be used.
[0320] The present configuration is also directed to software for accomplishing the methods
discussed herein, and computer readable media storing software for accomplishing these
methods. The various modules described herein can be accomplished on the same CPU,
or can be accomplished on a different computer. In compliance with the statute, the
present configuration has been described in language more or less specific as to structural
and methodical features. It is to be understood, however, that the present configuration
is not limited to the specific features shown and described, since the means herein
disclosed comprise preferred forms of putting the present configuration into effect.
[0321] Methods can be, in whole or in part, implemented electronically. Signals representing
actions taken by elements of the system and other disclosed configurations can travel
over at least one live communications network. Control and data information can be
electronically executed and stored on at least one computer-readable medium. The system
can be implemented to execute on at least one computer node in at least one live communications
network. Common forms of at least one computer-readable medium can include, for example,
but not be limited to, a floppy disk, a flexible disk, a hard disk, magnetic tape,
or any other magnetic medium, a compact disk read only memory or any other optical
medium, punched cards, paper tape, or any other physical medium with patterns of holes,
a random access memory, a programmable read only memory, and erasable programmable
read only memory (EPROM), a Flash EPROM, or any other memory chip or cartridge, or
any other medium from which a computer can read. Further, the at least one computer
readable medium can contain graphs in any form, subject to appropriate licenses where
necessary, including, but not limited to, Graphic Interchange Format (GIF), Joint
Photographic Experts Group (JPEG), Portable Network Graphics (PNG), Scalable Vector
Graphics (SVG), and Tagged Image File Format (TIFF).
[0322] While the present teachings have been described above in terms of specific configurations,
it is to be understood that they are not limited to these disclosed configurations.
Many modifications and other configurations will come to mind to those skilled in
the art to which this pertains, and which are intended to be and are covered by both
this disclosure and the appended claims. It is intended that the scope of the present
teachings should be determined by proper interpretation and construction of the appended
claims and their legal equivalents, as understood by those of skill in the art relying
upon the disclosure in this specification and the attached drawings.
[0323] The present application is a divisional application of
EP17730984.6.
EP17730984.6 is a European regional phase application originating from
PCT/US2017/033705. The original claims of
PCT/US2017/033705 are presented as statements below so that the subject-matter of those claims is included
in its entirety in the present application.
[0324] Statement 1. A powered balancing mobility device comprising:
a powerbase assembly processing movement commands for the mobility device;
at least one cluster assembly operably coupled to the powerbase assembly, the at least
one cluster assembly being operably coupled to a plurality of wheels, the plurality
of wheels supporting the powerbase assembly, the plurality of wheels and the at least
one cluster assembly moving the mobility device based at least on the processed movement
commands; and
an active stabilization processor estimating the center of gravity of the mobility
device, the active stabilization processor estimating at least one value associated
with the mobility device required to maintain balance of the mobility device based
on the estimated center of gravity,
wherein the powerbase processor actively balances the mobility device on at least
two of the plurality of wheels based at least on the at least one value.
[0325] Statement 2. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase assembly comprises:
redundant motors moving the at least one cluster assembly and the plurality of wheels;
redundant sensors sensing sensor data from the redundant motors and the at least one
cluster assembly; and
redundant processors executing within the powerbase assembly, the redundant processors
selecting information from the sensor data, the selecting being based on agreement
of the sensor data among the redundant processors, the redundant processors processing
the movement commands based at least on the selected information.
[0326] Statement 3. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
an anti-tipping controller stabilizing the mobility device based on stabilization
factors, the anti-tipping controller executing commands including computing a stabilization
metric, computing a stabilization factor, determining movement commands information
required to process the movement commands, and processing the movement commands based
on the movement command information and the stabilization factor if the stabilization
metric indicates that stabilization is required.
[0327] Statement 4. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
a stair-climbing failsafe means forcing the mobility device to fall safely if stability
is lost during stair climbing.
[0328] Statement 5. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
a caster wheel assembly operably coupled with the powerbase assembly;
a linear acceleration processor computing mobility device acceleration of the mobility
device based at least on the speed of the wheels, the linear acceleration processor
computing the inertial sensor acceleration of an inertial sensor mounted upon the
mobility device based at least on sensor data from the inertial sensor;
a traction control processor computing the difference between the mobility device
acceleration and the inertial sensor acceleration, the traction control processor
comparing the difference to a pre-selected threshold; and
a wheel/cluster command processor commanding the at least one cluster assembly to
drop at least one of the plurality of wheels and the caster assembly to the ground
based at least on the comparison.
[0329] Statement 6. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor uses field weakening to provide bursts of speed to motors associated
with the at least one cluster assembly and the plurality of wheels.
[0330] Statement 7. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor estimates the center of gravity of the mobility device, the powerbase
processor measuring data including a pitch angle required to maintain balance of the
mobility device at a pre-selected position of the at least one wheel cluster and a
pre-selected position of the seat, moving the mobility device/user pair to a plurality
of points, repeats step at each of the plurality of points, verifying that the measured
data fall within pre-selected limits, and generating a set of calibration coefficients
to establish the center of gravity during operation of the mobility device, the calibration
coefficients based at least on the verified measured data.
[0331] Statement 8. The mobility device as in Statement 7 wherein the powerbase processor
comprises a closed loop controller maintaining stability of the mobility device, the
closed loop controller automatically decelerating forward motion and accelerating
backward motion under pre-selected circumstances, the pre-selected circumstances being
based on the pitch angle of the mobility device and the center of gravity of the mobility
device.
[0332] Statement 9. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 comprising:
an all-terrain wheel pair including an inner wheel having at least one locking means
accessible by an operator of the mobility device while the mobility device is operating,
the inner wheel having at least one retaining means, the all-terrain wheel pair including
an outer wheel having an attachment base, the attachment base accommodating the at
least one locking means and the at least one retaining means, the at least one retaining
means operable by the operator while the mobility device is in operation to connect
the inner wheel to the outer wheel.
[0333] Statement 10. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 comprising:
a powerbase processor board including at least one inertial sensor, the at least one
inertial sensor being mounted on an inertial sensor board, the at least one inertial
sensor board being flexibly coupled with the powerbase processor board, the at least
one inertial sensor board being separate from the powerbase processor board, the at
least one inertial sensor being calibrated in isolation from the powerbase processor
board.
[0334] Statement 11. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 comprising:
at least one inertial sensor including a gyro and an accelerometer.
[0335] Statement 12. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a mobility device wireless processor enabling communications with an external application
electronically remote from the mobility device, the mobility device wireless processor
receiving and decoding incoming messages from a wireless radio, the powerbase processor
controlling the mobility device based at least one the decoded incoming messages.
[0336] Statement 13. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a secure wireless communications system including data obfuscation and challenge-response
authentication.
[0337] Statement 14. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
an indirect heat dissipation path between the powerbase processor board and the chassis
of the mobility device.
[0338] Statement 15. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
a seat support assembly enabling connection of a plurality of seat types to the powerbase
assembly, the powerbase assembly having seat position sensors, the seat position sensors
providing seat position data to the powerbase processor.
[0339] Statement 16. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 11 wherein the
seat support assembly comprises:
seat lift arms lifting the seat; and
a shaft operably coupled with the seat lift arms, the shaft rotation being measured
by the seat position sensors, the shaft rotating through < 90°, the shaft being couple
to the seat position sensor by a one-stage gear train causing the seat position sensor
to rotate > 180°, the combination doubling the sensitivity of the seat position data.
[0340] Statement 17. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 11 wherein the
powerbase assembly comprises:
a plurality of sensors fully enclosed within the powerbase assembly, the plurality
of sensors including co-located sensor groups sensing substantially similar characteristics
of the mobility device.
[0341] Statement 18. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase assembly comprises:
a manual brake including internal components, the internal components including a
hard stop and a damper, the manual brake including a brake release lever replaceable
separately from the internal components.
[0342] Statement 19. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
user-configurable drive options limiting speed and acceleration of the mobility device
based on pre-selected circumstances.
[0343] Statement 20. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
a user control device including a thumbwheel, the thumbwheel modifying at least one
speed range for the mobility device.
[0344] Statement 21. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
a drive lock element enabling operable coupling between the powerbase assembly and
a docking station; and
a skid plate having a pop-out cavity accommodating the drive lock element, the skid
plate enabling retention of oil escaping from the powerbase assembly.
[0345] Statement 22. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 further comprising:
a seat,
wherein the powerbase processor receiving an indication that the mobility device is
encountering a ramp between the ground and a vehicle, the powerbase processor directing
the clusters of wheels to maintain contact with the ground, the powerbase processor
changing the orientation of the at least one cluster assembly according to the indication
to maintain the center of gravity of the mobility device based on the position of
the plurality of wheels, the powerbase processor dynamically adjusting the distance
between the seat and the at least one cluster assembly to prevent contact between
the seat and the plurality of wheels while maintaining the seat as close to the ground
as possible.
[0346] Statement 23. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
an obstacle system including:
receiving obstacle data;
automatically identifying the at least one obstacle within the obstacle data;
automatically determining at least one situation identifier;
automatically maintaining a distance between the mobility device and the at least
one obstacle based on the at least one situation identifier;
automatically accessing at least one allowed command related to the distance, the
at least one obstacle, and the at least one situation identifier;
automatically accessing at least one automatic response to at least one movement command;
receiving at least one movement command;
automatically mapping the at least one movement command with one of the at least one
allowed commands; and
automatically moving the mobility device based on the at least one movement command
and the at least one automatic response associated with the mapped allowed command.
[0347] Statement 24. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a stair processor including:
receiving at least one stair command;
receiving sensor data from sensors mounted on the mobility device;
automatically locating, based on the sensor data, at least one staircase within the
sensor data;
receiving a selection of a selected staircase of the at least one staircase;
automatically measuring at least one characteristic of the selected staircase; automatically
locating, based on the sensor data, obstacles, if any, on the selected staircase;
automatically locating, based on the sensor data, a last stair of the selected staircase;
and
automatically navigating the mobility device on the selected staircase based on the
measured at least one characteristic, the last stair, and the obstacles, if any.
[0348] Statement 25. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a rest room processor including:
automatically locating a rest room stall door;
automatically moving the mobility device through the rest room stall door into the
rest room stall;
automatically positioning the mobility device relative to rest room fixtures;
automatically locating the rest room stall door; and
automatically moving the mobility device through the rest room stall door exiting
the rest room stall.
[0349] Statement 26. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a door processor including:
receiving sensor data from sensors mounted on the mobility device;
automatically identifying the door within the sensor data;
automatically measuring the door;
automatically determining the door swing;
automatically moving the mobility device forward through the doorway, the mobility
device opening the door and maintaining the door in an open position, if the door
swing is away from the mobility device; and automatically positioning the mobility
device for access to a handle of the door, moving the mobility device away from the
door, as the door opens, by a distance based on the width of the door, and moving
the mobility device forward though the doorway, the mobility device maintaining the
door in an open position, if the door swing is towards the mobility device.
[0350] Statement 27. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a door processor including:
receiving sensor data from sensors mounted on the mobility device;
automatically identifying the door within the sensor data;
automatically measuring the door, including the width of the door;
automatically generating an alert if the door is smaller than the a pre-selected size
related to the size of the mobility device;
automatically positioning the mobility device for access to the door, the positioning
being based on the width of the door;
automatically generating a signal for opening the door; and
automatically moving the mobility device though the doorway.
[0351] Statement 28. The powered balancing mobility device as in Statement 1 wherein the
powerbase processor comprises:
a docking processor including:
automatically locating a transfer point at which a patient transfers out of the mobility
device;
automatically positioning the mobility device in the vicinity of the transfer point;
automatically determining when the patients transfers out of the mobility device;
automatically locating a docking station;
automatically positioning the mobility device at the docking station; and operably
connecting the mobility device to the docking station.
[0352] Statement 29. A method for controlling the speed of a mobility device, the mobility
device including a plurality of wheels, the mobility device including a plurality
of sensors, the method comprising:
receiving terrain and obstacle detection data from the plurality of sensors;
mapping terrain and obstacles, if any, in real time based at least on the terrain
and obstacle detection data; computing collision possible areas, if any, based at
least on the mapped data;
computing slow-down areas if any based at least on the mapped data and the speed of
the mobility device; receiving user preferences, if any, with respect to the slow-down
areas and desired direction and speed of motion; computing wheel commands to command
the plurality of wheels based at least on the collision possible areas, the slow-down
areas, and the user preferences; and
providing the wheel commands to the plurality of wheels.
[0353] Statement 30. A method for moving a balancing mobility device on relatively steep
terrain, the mobility device including clusters of wheels and a seat, the clusters
of wheels and the seat separated by a distance, the distance varying based on pre-selected
characteristics, the method comprising:
receiving an indication that the mobility device will encounter the steep terrain;
directing the clusters of wheels to maintain contact with the ground; and
dynamically adjusting the distance between the seat and the clusters of wheels based
on maintaining the balance of the mobility device and the indication.